home *** CD-ROM | disk | FTP | other *** search
Text File | 1989-12-14 | 638.9 KB | 15,619 lines |
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- D'Bridge EMAIL System
-
- User's Guide and Technical Reference
-
- Version 1.30 - 15 December 1989
-
-
-
-
-
- Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin
-
- ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
-
-
-
-
-
- ------------------------------------------------------------
- D'Bridge Software 800-762-4197 Credit card orders
- Suite 208 305-232-5245 Technical Support
- 15321 South Dixie Highway 305-232-9365 Data (EMAIL/BBS)
- Miami, Florida 33176 305-255-6460 FAX
-
- 1:1050/0 D'BridgeNet
- 1:18/68 Fidonet
- 7:48/2010 Alternet
- ------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- "This manual may be freely copied and distributed in its original
- form only. Distribution of modified copies shall be considered
- copyright infringement. This document is the complete User's Guide
- and Technical Reference for D'Bridge EMAIL system. ALL RIGHTS RESERVED.
- We distribute this material on an "as-is" basis only. The current
- releases of this manual and/or software may be obtained free-of-charge
- anytime from any of the D'Bridge Support Systems located world-wide.
-
- "This is a strictly COMMERCIAL product, but a 30-day demonstration
- period is granted to all who request it. Copying and/or distribution
- of license-keys is strictly prohibited. (Except, of course for backup
- or archival purposes.)"
- D'Bridge Electronic Mail System TABLE OF CONTENTS
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Table of Contents
- -----------------
-
- 0.0 Forward - a note from the author 1
- 0.1 Hardware/software requirements 2
-
- 1.0 D'Bridge - an overview 3
- 1.1 Specific features and capabilities 4
-
- 2.0 Installation from floppy disk 5
- 2.1 Installation of "demo" copy 7
- 2.2 The "X00" FOSSIL driver 10
- 2.3 Initial configuration 11
- 2.4 Design philosophy, basic concepts 18
- 2.5 Basic EMAIL/FAX setup, scheduling 22
- 2.6 Basic ECHOmail setup 26
- 2.7 Using D'Bridge EMAIL System 31
-
- 3.0 The SETUP menu 35
- 3.1 EDITOR: Setup editor parameters 36
- 3.2 EDITOR: Local/ECHOmail areas 40
- 3.3 EDITOR: Keyboard macros 47
- 3.4 EDITOR: Translation table 48
- 3.5 CONFIG: Basic configuration 49
- 3.6 CONFIG: Directory paths 56
- 3.7 CONFIG: Install new modem 60
- 3.8 CONFIG: Comm/Modem setup 61
- 3.9 CONFIG: FAX configuration 66
- 3.10 CONFIG: Schedule maintenance 69
- 3.11 CONFIG: Nodelist configuration 85
- 3.12 CONFIG: Packet/Mail control 91
- 3.13 CONFIG: XMAIL control 97
- 3.14 ADVANCED: Function keys 100
- 3.15 ADVANCED: BBS configuration 101
- 3.16 ADVANCED: Security/Miscellaneous 105
- 3.17 ADVANCED: Disk space minimums 112
- 3.18 ADVANCED: Output configuration 114
- 3.19 ADVANCED: Accounting/Translation 115
- 3.20 ADVANCED: New support system 121
- 3.21 ADVANCED: ZMODEM parameters 122
-
- 4.0 DBMAILER: General operation 124
- 4.1 MAIL: Hold all mail 129
- 4.2 MAIL: View/modify queue 130
- 4.3 MAIL: Rebuild queue 133
- 4.4 MAIL: Poll a node 134
- 4.5 MAIL: Transmit file(s) 135
- 4.6 MAIL: File-request 136
- 4.7 MAIL: Information display 137
- 4.8 MAIL: Select alias 138
- 4.9 EDIT: Read/edit EMAIL 139
- D'Bridge Electronic Mail System TABLE OF CONTENTS
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 4.10 UTILITIES: History display 140
- 4.11 UTILITIES: Request ECHOmail link 143
- 4.12 UTILITIES: New ECHOmail link 145
- 4.13 UTILITIES: Terminal mode 147
- 4.14 UTILITIES: Force nodelist compile 155
- 4.15 UTILITIES: Process ECHOmail 156
- 4.16 UTILITIES: Display schedule 158
- 4.17 Single-key commands 159
-
- 5.0 DBEDIT: The EMAIL message editor 160
- 5.1 DBEDIT: Using "edit" mode 166
- 5.2 DBEDIT: Using "read" mode 175
- 5.3 DBEDIT: Advanced features 178
-
- 6.0 Understanding the queue 181
- 6.1 Creating a private nodelist 186
- 6.2 Duties of a network administrator 188
- 6.3 Public amateur networks 189
-
- 7.0 DBUTIL: The utility program 190
- 7.1 Storage: Fido, QuickBBS 193
- 7.2 Using the scripting language 194
- 7.3 Example script file 199
-
- 8.0 Bulletin board systems 200
- 8.1 Using Wildcat 204
- 8.2 Using TBBS 208
- 8.3 Using Opus 211
- 8.4 Using QuickBBS 213
- 8.5 Using PC-Board 215
-
- 9.0 D'Bridge technical information 219
- 9.1 Parameter file 221
- 9.2 Message storage structures 222
- 9.3 D'Bridge file structures 225
- 9.4 Disk-based queue 236
-
- 10.0 Trouble? 240
-
-
- Appendix "A" Glossary of EMAIL terms 241
-
- Appendix "B" Credits / Acknowledgements 259
- D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Forward - A note from the author 0.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Greetings!
-
- Thank you for selecting D'Bridge, a state-of-the-art electronic mail
- system for the IBM PC. In the coming years, the ability to send and
- receive data electronically will become as common as the telephone for
- business. More and more companies are realizing that the most efficient
- and cost-effective way to move data is digital. FAX is fine for printed
- documents and voice is the most direct way to convey a thought; but data
- is the best way for businesses to communicate when the information sent
- and received becomes routine.
-
- I firmly believe that ten years from now, it will be commonplace for
- companies to have a "data" number, just like they have "voice" and "FAX"
- numbers now. In fact, it is possible that given current technologies,
- the "FAX" number may be replaced with a combined "Data/FAX" number if
- such standards can be firmly established.
-
- What can D'Bridge do? Simple - it can move data, programs, documents,
- spreadsheets, pictures, drawings and sounds between continents in just
- seconds or minutes, depending on the size. Anything that can be stored
- in your computer can be automatically transmitted anywhere in the world
- that uses a compatible EMAIL system.
-
- D'Bridge isn't alone; there are many other programs out there that can
- communicate with it. We chose to implement the most widely used point-
- to-point EMAIL system in the world, Fidonet. This means that you can
- communicate with anyone using the programs: AirMail, FrontDoor, Fido,
- Opus, SEAdog, BinkleyTerm and many others.
-
- Also, one feature about D'Bridge that you may find unique to software
- products, is that your license entitles you to obtain the most recent
- version for free - anytime. Since we use the "License Key" concept,
- we are able to allow our software to be freely circulated without the
- worry of "software pirates" stealing our wares.
-
- D'Bridge is just a beginning; look for our release of many innovative
- products that use our EMAIL system as a "hub." The possibilities of
- how D'Bridge can be used are virtually limitless. Worry-free, automated
- communications is the key to many new applications: Shared databases,
- unattended data collection and automatic order processing to name a few.
- I would be happy to discuss your custom application; after all, I am
- still a consultant too...
-
-
- Sincerely,
-
- Chris Irwin
- 1:1050/0 D'BridgeNet
- 1:18/68 Fidonet
- 7:48/2010 Alternet
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 1D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Hardware/Software requirements 0.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 0.1 HARDWARE/SOFTWARE REQUIREMENTS
- -----------------------------------
-
-
- HARDWARE
-
- COMPUTER
-
- - IBM PC, XT, AT, PS/2 or compatible
- - 512K RAM (640K recommended)
- - Monochrome, CGA, EGA, VGA, PGA adaptor and monitor
- - Serial port (if an external modem is used)
- - Printer (optional)
-
- STORAGE
-
- - A hard disk or other storage with at least 2.5 megabytes
- available before installation
-
- MODEM
-
- - Hayes-compatible modem
- The modem used MUST be capable of using both the
- DTR (Data Terminal Ready) and the CD (Carrier Detect)
- signals.
- - Modem cable (if external)
-
- FAX CARD (optional)
-
- - JT-FAX 4800 / JT-FAX 9600 by QuadRAM
-
- TELEPHONE LINE
-
- - A normal telephone line
- - A "cellular" phone (with a compatible modem)
- - Most PBX systems (check with your vendor)
-
-
- SOFTWARE
-
- OPERATING SYSTEM
-
- - D'Bridge requires DOS 2.1 or higher (DOS 3.1 suggested)
- - A FOSSIL communications driver such as X00 by Ray Gwinn.
- The X00 driver is provided with D'Bridge and is the only
- driver officially supported. (BNU also works, we hear...)
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 2D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge - an overview 1.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 1.0 D'BRIDGE - AN OVERVIEW
- ---------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge is one of the most flexible EMAIL systems on the market today
- and its menu-driven operation makes it one of the easiest-to-use. The
- communications between D'Bridge systems uses the powerful ZMODEM proto-
- col, ensuring that your data arrives as quickly and accurately as
- possible.
-
- In its simplest form, D'Bridge acts like a messenger between two or more
- points; at its best and most complex, it can be a multi-tiered network
- connecting hundreds (or thousands) of cities using a "hub and spoke"
- topology (much like our major airlines.)
-
-
- MESSAGES D'Bridge can send messages (text) from one location to
- (EMAIL) another automatically. Messages can be prepared by using
- DBEDIT, the D'Bridge Message Editor. Messages are a simple
- and cost-effective way for offices to communicate with each
- other. It is usually more cost-effective to send EMAIL
- messages between offices than to use FAX or TELEX. With a
- high-speed modem, D'Bridge can transfer hundreds of messages
- in just a minute or two. If your computer has a compatible
- FAX card, D'Bridge can also send your EMAIL messages and
- scanned images to any of over 3 million FAX machines.
-
- FILES Along with messages, D'Bridge can send files. Word processor
- files, spreadsheets, Database files, graphic images are just
- a few of the types of files that D'Bridge can transfer. Any
- file that can be put on a standard DOS diskette can be sent
- anywhere in the world within minutes using D'Bridge. The
- exception to this is special files and programs that have
- copy-protection of some kind. (You can't send your Flight
- Simulator disk using D'Bridge, but that's OK - if you can't
- send it, it's probably illegal.)
-
- FILE- As well as sending files, D'Bridge is capable of requesting
- REQUESTS them. What this means is that you give your D'Bridge system
- a list of files that you wish to receive from a remote site.
- D'Bridge calls the system and "asks" for the specified files.
- If you are authorized to receive them and they exist on the
- remote system, they will be immediately transmitted to you.
-
- FUNCTION- A Feature to unique to D'Bridge and other UltraTek EMAIL
- REQUESTS systems is the ability to request that various functions be
- performed by a remote site. This one's just a bit harder to
- explain but basically it allows the sending system to request
- that DOS services or programs be executed by the remote
- system. It's primary purpose is to support online database
- searches, but there are many more uses possible.
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 3D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Specific features 1.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- 1.1 SPECIFIC FEATURES
- ----------------------
-
-
- For comparison to other EMAIL systems, this "feature list" has been
- included:
-
-
- - Completely menu-driven -- no "text" files to edit
- - Sends and receives FAX, EMAIL and DATA completely unattended
- - Full screen editor to enter and read EMAIL messages
- - Fully compatible with UltraTek<tm>, Fidonet<tm>, WaZOO<tm> EMAIL
- - Can act as a "front-end" for most popular bulletin board systems
- - Uses the new EMSI handshaking protocol for maximum flexibility
- - Allows mail pickup for all aliases (with compatible EMAIL systems)
- - Fully supports Fido and QuickBBS message storage formats
- - Supports most Hayes-compatible 300-38400 baud modems
- - Communicates with XMODEM, TELINK and ZMODEM protocols
- - 32-bit CRCs and interruption-recovery are used in ZMODEM transfers
- - Supports WaZOO-style file and update requests
- - Complete file-request limit system, enforces limits for 24-hours
- - Processes "raw" nodelists directly - no other programs needed
- - Complete scripting language for PC-Pursuit, etc. / Script diagnostics
- - Flexible routing language - supports zones and points
- - Weekly schedule for MAIL EVENTS and DOS commands/programs
- - XMAIL (compressed mail capability) supporting ARC, LHARC, PAK and ZIP
- - Disk-based queue for file transfer and XMAIL
- - Full ECHOmail support including ZONES and POINTS
- - Built-in AREAFIX capability for remote link-requests
- - Complete password-security for mail sessions and file-requests
- - Terminal mode with ANSI support and ZMODEM autodownload
- - Compatible with most multi-taskers such as DESQview<tm>
- - Direct memory or BIOS screen I/O
- - Complete cost-accounting that estimates and tracks actual costs
- - Inbound, outbound, ECHOmail and AREAFIX history
- - Automatic shutdown if disk space becomes critical
- - Capable of a network of virtually any size
- - Can act as the "front-end" for external EMAIL receivers (UUCP, etc.)
- - Unique FUNCTION REQUEST feature
- - No batch files required; all processing can be internal
- - DOS commands may be run directly or by swapping to disk or EMS.
- - FREE software updates available electronically
- - Support systems located worldwide
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 4D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Installation from floppy disk 2.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 2.0 INSTALLATION FROM FLOPPY DISK
- ----------------------------------
-
-
- Installation of D'Bridge has been simplified so that almost anyone
- can do it by following these few instructions:
-
-
- 1) Make sure that you have at least 2.5 megabytes free on the hard
- disk where you intend to install D'Bridge.
-
- 2) Locate the diskette labeled "D'Bridge - 1 of 2" and put it in the
- diskette drive. (Drive "A")
-
- 3) Assuming that you are at a "C>" prompt, type:
-
- A:INSTALL (then press ENTER)
-
- 4) The following screen should appear:
-
- /--------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge Universal Installation Program |
- | Version 1.30 -- Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin |
- |--------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | /--------------------------------------------------------------\ |
- | | | |
- | | Directory to install D'Bridge: C:\DB | |
- | | | |
- | \--------------------------------------------------------------/ |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | /-----\ /-----\ |
- | | ESC | Abort installation | F10 | Proceed with installation |
- | \-----/ \-----/ |
- | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The FIRST thing to remember is that at any time during this process,
- you may cancel it and start over simply by pressing the ESC key. If
- you get lost or confused, pressing ESC is always the way out.
-
- The cursor should appear in the INSTALL DIRECTORY field. Assuming
- that you want to install D'Bridge in the directory C:\DB, simply
- press the F10 key to start. If you want, select another directory
- before pressing the F10 key.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 5D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Installation from floppy disk 2.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- The program will ask you to change disks; after copying all the
- information from BOTH diskettes, the following screen should be
- displayed:
-
-
- /--------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge Universal Installation Program |
- | Version 1.30 -- Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin |
- |--------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | /----------------------------\ |
- | | Testing software integrity | |
- | | DBRIDGE1.130 | |
- | \----------------------------/ |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- During this phase of installation, all the information has been
- copied from the diskettes and is being tested to make sure it is
- completely valid.
-
- Be patient, D'Bridge is a large program and will take a few minutes
- to install. On the diskettes, it is stored in a compressed format
- and the installation program has to "unsqueeze" all of the files.
- Once installed, you will only need to repeat this process when you
- want to install a newer version of the software.
-
- When the installation program is done, re-boot your computer to
- install the supplied FOSSIL driver, X00. Start D'Bridge by typing
- "DB" while in D'Bridge root directory. (C:\DB)
-
- C> CD \DB
- C> DB
-
- Proceed to section 2.3 for continued installation instructions.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 6D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Installation of "demo" copy 2.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 2.1 INSTALLATION OF "DEMO" COPY
- --------------------------------
-
- If you have downloaded a DEMO COPY of D'Bridge from a bulletin board
- system, there are a few things that you should know:
-
- - D'Bridge is a commercial product; it is NOT FREE.
- - You may have a 30-day demonstration by getting a "demo key."
- - Demos keys are available from our support systems worldwide.
- - It will cost you the price of one long-distance call to get a key.
-
-
- To install the demo copy:
-
- 1) Make sure that you have at least 2.5 megabytes free on the hard
- disk where you intend to install D'Bridge.
-
- 2) Create a "root directory" for D'Bridge. (usually C:\DB)
-
- 3) Unpack the install program INSTALL.EXE from the ZIP file
- DBINST13.ZIP.
-
- 4) Assuming that you have the release files (2 "ZIP") files on your
- hard disk, type:
-
- INSTALL (then press ENTER)
-
- 5) The following screen should appear:
-
- /--------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge Universal Installation Program |
- | Version 1.30 -- Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin |
- |--------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | /----\ |
- | | F1 | Install D'Bridge for the first time |
- | \----/ |
- | |
- | /----\ |
- | | F3 | Upgrade to a newer version |
- | \----/ |
- | |
- | /----\ |
- | | F5 | Test integrity of the current version |
- | \----/ |
- | |
- | /-----\ |
- | | ESC | Exit install program |
- | \-----/ |
- | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 7D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Installation of "demo" copy 2.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 6) Select option F1; install D'Bridge for the first time.
-
- 7) The following screen will appear:
-
- /--------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge Universal Installation Program |
- | Version 1.30 -- Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin |
- |--------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | /--------------------------------------------------------------\ |
- | | | |
- | | Directory to install D'Bridge: C:\DB | |
- | | Directory that contains release files: C:\DB | |
- | | "ZIP" file unpack command: PKUNZIP -O | |
- | | | |
- | \--------------------------------------------------------------/ |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | /-----\ /-----\ |
- | | ESC | Abort installation | F10 | Proceed with installation |
- | \-----/ \-----/ |
- | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- 8) You may have to change one of the fields:
-
- A) Directory to install D'Bridge
-
- This directory is the final destination (the root directory)
- for the D'Bridge software. Make sure you specify the full
- path of the directory you want. (This is normally C:\DB)
-
- B) Directory that contains release files
-
- This is the directory that contains the two ZIP files of
- the actual software release. (DB130A.ZIP and DB130B.ZIP)
- It is advisable to allow the install program to unZIP the
- releases so that installation goes smoothly.
-
- C) "ZIP" file unpack command
-
- This specifies the actual command used to unpack (unZIP)
- the release files. If you are installing a "demo" copy,
- it is assumed you have an unZIP* program already as none
- is provided with D'Bridge. The default is (PKUNZIP -O)
-
-
- * PKUNZIP available from PKWARE, Inc.
- 7545 N. Port Washington Road
- Glendale, WI 53217
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 8D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Installation of "demo" copy 2.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 9) When you are ready, press the F10 key to begin installation.
- This process takes a few minutes, so be patient.
-
- 10) When the install process is complete, you will be returned to
- the "C>" prompt.
-
- 11) Make sure that you have a FOSSIL driver (such as X00.SYS) installed
- in your CONFIG.SYS file. If you do not understand what a FOSSIL
- driver is, see SECTION 2.2 for more information.
-
- 12) After the install process is complete, you may start D'Bridge by
- typing DB from the D'Bridge root directory.
-
- DB (then press ENTER)
-
- 13) The following screen should appear:
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge EMAIL System / Version 1.30 | "DEMO" Software License Agreement |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | TERMS and CONDITIONS: This is NOT SHAREWARE - It's a commercial product. |
- | |
- | You may evaluate this demo version of D'Bridge |
- | for a period of thirty (30) days. After that time, |
- | you must either purchase a copy or stop using the |
- | software. This "DEMO" program must be activated by |
- | obtaining a "DEMO LICENSE KEY" from a D'Bridge |
- | support system. THIS IS NOT FREE! (Your phone |
- | company will charge you about $0.30 for a call to |
- | one of our support systems. (Overseas users, this |
- | will probably cost more.) In addition, you MUST |
- | provide us with your name, address and phone number |
- | in order to receive a "DEMO LICENSE KEY." |
- | |
- | Type "AGREE" if you understand and accept these demo terms: _____ |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- 11) If you agree that D'Bridge is allowed to make the phone call to
- get a 30-day "demo license key," type AGREE on this screen.
-
- 12) If you can't agree to the simple terms and conditions required
- to operate D'Bridge, please do not use it.
-
- 13) Proceed to section 2.3 for continued installation instructions.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 9D'Bridge Electronic Mail System The "X00" FOSSIL driver 2.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- 2.2 THE "X00" FOSSIL DRIVER
- ----------------------------
-
-
- If you have installed D'Bridge from diskettes, the X00 FOSSIL driver
- has been installed on your computer automatically. This section is
- for your information only; you shouldn't have to install anything.
-
- In order for D'Bridge to communicate with your modem, it is required
- that a FOSSIL driver be installed. FOSSIL is an acronym meaning "Fido-
- Opus-SEAdog Standard Interface Layer." This has become a standard
- among PC-based communication programs to provide high-speed, buffered
- communications using the RS-232 serial port.
-
- Provided for use with D'Bridge is the X00 FOSSIL driver by Ray Gwinn.
- Ray was kind enough to allow the distribution of his X00 driver with
- D'Bridge; therefore it is the only "officially" supported FOSSIL driver.
- There are others that work, but only X00 is suggested because we know
- that it is a stable piece of software.
-
- To install X00 on your computer, you must have a line in your CONFIG.SYS
- file that says:
-
- DEVICE=X00.SYS E
-
- With this line installed, the X00 communications driver will be loaded
- at the time DOS is loaded. Make sure that the X00.SYS file is located
- in the root directory of your "C" drive.
-
- There are many advanced ways that X00 may be configured; you may control
- the size of both the inbound and outgoing data buffers as well as define
- non-standard communication boards. See X00.DOC, the user's manual for
- X00, for complete information.
-
- If you need a copy of X00.SYS, contact one of our support systems; we
- always have it available for download.
-
-
- ------------------------------------------------------------------
- Make sure that the version of X00 that you use is 1.10 or greater.
- ------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 10D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Initial configuration 2.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 2.3 INITIAL CONFIGURATION
- --------------------------
-
-
- When "DB" is first run, you will be shown a license agreement screen.
- This screen contains the basic license agreement between YOU and D'Bridge
- Software. If you agree with this license, type the word "AGREE" and
- press ENTER. If not, simply return the software to where you purchased
- it for a full refund.
-
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge EMAIL System / Version 1.30 | Software License Agreement |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | TERMS and CONDITIONS: D'Bridge Software assumes ABSOLUTELY NO LIABILITY |
- | for loss of data or accidental telephone charges |
- | caused by D'Bridge, whether directly or indirectly. |
- | |
- | USE THIS SOFTWARE AT YOUR OWN RISK ONLY! |
- | |
- | With D'Bridge, we have tried to create a package with |
- | excellent reliability and security, but there may be |
- | "bugs" yet undetected that could (in theory) cause |
- | DATA LOSS or ACCIDENTAL PHONE CHARGES. WE CANNOT BE |
- | RESPONSIBLE FOR THESE PROBLEMS. However, we will |
- | gladly work with you to resolve any real "bugs." |
- | |
- | TO USE THIS SOFTWARE, YOU MUST AGREE TO THESE TERMS |
- | UNCONDITIONALLY! |
- | |
- | Type "AGREE" if you understand and accept these terms and conditions: _____ |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- By your acceptance of this license agreement, you are understanding:
-
- - D'Bridge CAN and DOES make long-distance telephone calls using
- your MODEM or FAX CARD.
-
- - YOU, NOT D'BRIDGE SOFTWARE, are responsible for all charges from
- your long-distance carrier.
-
- - D'Bridge is a well-tested program, but "bugs" could exist that
- could cause accidental phone charges or loss-of-data.
-
- - D'Bridge Software cannot be responsible for such problems; the USER
- assumes full responsibility.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 11D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Initial configuration 2.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- Assuming that you are using a COLOR DISPLAY ADAPTOR, the following screen
- will be displayed:
-
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge EMAIL System / Version 1.30 | INSTALLATION: Screen colors |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | D'Bridge has detected that you are using a color display adaptor! |
- | |
- | There are well over a BILLION possible color combinations which may |
- | be used for the screen. Since it would be impossible to list them |
- | all here, we'll start with four basic choices. Using the WINDOW |
- | COLORS menu, you may configure D'Bridge for any combination you |
- | desire. Here's your initial choices: |
- | |
- | Standard Colored backgrounds, colorful text |
- | Wild Colored backgrounds, CRAZY colors! |
- | Conservative Black backgrounds, mild colors |
- | Mono Completely monochrome (Black and white) |
- | |
- | |
- | Your choice? (S/W/C/M) |
- | |
- | |
- | Press ESC to abort the installation procedure |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- This one's easy - just choose from STANDARD, WILD, CONSERVATIVE and
- MONO. Whatever you choose, you can always change your mind later.
- With the WINDOW COLORS menu, you can select from the billions of possible
- combinations...
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 12D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Initial configuration 2.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- Next, you will get a screen that allows you to specify what "support
- system" you would like to use. A "support system" is where you can call
- to request a "DEMO" key or a free software-update. The following screen
- will be displayed:
-
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge EMAIL System / Version 1.30 | INSTALLATION: Support Systems |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | The following support systems are available as of 12/15/89: |
- | |
- | 0) D'Bridge Sales and Support Miami/FL 1-305-232-9365 |
- | 11) D'Bridge Sales/West U.S. Portland/OR 1-503-292-7233 |
- | 12) D'Bridge Sales/West U.S. Portland/OR 1-503-292-7237 |
- | 13) D'Bridge Sales/East U.S. Philadelphia/PA 1-215-879-3310 |
- | 14) D'Bridge Sales/Canada Ontario/Canada 1-412-823-4521 |
- | 21) D'Bridge Sales/Europe Arnhem/Holland 31-85-459034 |
- | 22) D'Bridge Sales/Italy Civitavecchia/Italy 39-766-540-899 |
- | 23) D'Bridge Sales/UK London/UK 44-1-351-7262 |
- | 24) D'Bridge Sales/Germany Hamm/Deutschland 49-2381-460077 |
- | 25) D'Bridge Sales/Belgium Borgerhout/Belgium 32-3-8770709 |
- | 26) D'Bridge Sales/Sweden Kalmar/Sweden 46-480-14302 |
- | 31) D'Bridge Support/Australia Melborne, Australia 61-3-848-3331 |
- | 32) D'Bridge Support/Australia Melborne, Australia 61-3-563-2496 |
- | |
- | Which one would you like to use as your primary support system? 0 |
- | What phone number would you need to dial to reach it? 1-305-232-9365 |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- Press F1 for the previous screen or ESC to abort the installation
-
-
-
-
- Select your support node from the list of valid choices. D'Bridge will
- then give you the chance to edit the phone number that will be dialed.
- This is necessary because of differences in international dialing methods
- and the possibility that calling a support node might be a local call.
- Make sure that the phone number can be dialed exactly as entered - no
- further translation will be done to your primary support system's phone
- number.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 13D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Initial configuration 2.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- Next, you need to tell D'Bridge about your modem. Obviously, you know
- that an EMAIL system needs a dedicated modem in order to function. It
- is highly recommended that you use a HAYES-compatible modem. I'll use
- that term rather loosely, because most modems "claim" to be HAYES-
- compatible even though most aren't. It doesn't matter whether your modem
- is internal or external, just so it meets the following criteria:
-
- 1) It must be able to dial the phone automatically.
- 2) It must be capable of answering the phone.
- 3) It must respond to the DTR (Data Terminal Ready) signal.
- 4) It must provide D'Bridge with the CD (Carrier Detect) signal.
-
- Odds are, your modem can do all these things, but it's possible that
- you will need to change some switch settings or do some "NRAM" changes
- before using D'Bridge.
-
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge EMAIL System / Version 1.30 | INSTALLATION: Modem Selection |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | D'Bridge requires a HAYES-COMPATIBLE modem to operate properly. |
- | It is important that you have all switch settings and controls |
- | set properly; see your modem manual for more information. There |
- | are really only two special requirements that must be met: |
- | |
- | 1) Your modem must be able to use the CARRIER DETECT signal. |
- | 2) It must hang-up the phone (and not answer) when the DATA |
- | TERMINAL READY (DTR) signal is "low." |
- | |
- | What COM port does your modem use? COM1 |
- | Use TOUCH-TONE dialing? Yes |
- | |
- | Modem type: |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- Press F1 for the previous screen or ESC to abort the installation
-
-
- First, enter which COM PORT your modem uses. If you aren't sure, use
- COM1. Most modems are configured as either COM1 or COM2, but if you have
- a special system configuration, you might need a different port.
-
- Next, you must specify whether your phone line accepts TOUCH-TONE
- dialing. It's obviously a lot faster to answer "YES" to this field,
- but some older phone systems might require PULSE dialing, so you might
- have to answer "NO."
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 14D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Initial configuration 2.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Finally, select your modem type from the list of standard modems. If
- your particular modem is not in the list, choose one of the "generic"
- modems at the end of the list. (Make sure that you pick the right baud-
- rate...)
-
- If this screen confuses you, I would suggest that you read SECTION 3.7 in
- this manual; it will further describe modem selection. If you just can't
- figure it out, feel free to call customer support in Miami, Florida at
- 305-232-5245; we will be more than happy to assist you.
-
-
-
- The next screen lets you define your system address. An address is very
- much like a phone number; it identifies your system with a unique set of
- numbers used when communicating via Fidonet EMAIL. A Fidonet address
- consists of four numbers: ZONE, NET, NODE and POINT. These numbers are
- normally assigned by your NETWORK ADMINISTRATOR. If you don't have a
- administrator, or are setting up a private network, I would suggest first
- reading SECTION 6.1 about being a NETWORK ADMINISTRATOR. Here's the
- screen that D'Bridge uses to define your network address:
-
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge EMAIL System / Version 1.30 | INSTALLATION: Fidonet address |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | D'Bridge is a Fidonet-based EMAIL system. Similar to a telephone number |
- | Fidonet uses a 4-part "address" to define each system. An address |
- | consists of four numbers: ZONE, NET, NODE and POINT. They are used |
- | as follows: |
- | |
- | ZONE Usually defines a continent (1=America, 2=Europe, 3=Australia) |
- | NET Usually represents a local calling area (city) |
- | NODE Specifies an individual system within a NET |
- | POINT For most systems, use zero (see documentation) |
- | |
- | Do not pick a number at random; contact your network administrator |
- | for the correct assignment. If you are setting up a private network, |
- | please read the user documentation for further information. |
- | |
- | |
- | ZONE: ______ NET: _______ NODE: ______ POINT: ______ |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- Press F1 for the previous screen or ESC to abort the installation
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 15D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Initial configuration 2.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- On this screen you specify your Fidonet address with four separate
- numbers. When using the MESSAGE editor, you will refer to these
- addresses in the format:
-
- ZONE:NET/NODE.POINT
-
- ie. 1:18/68.5
-
- Again, if you don't know what to use for this screen, contact your
- NETWORK ADMINISTRATOR or read SECTION 6.1 if you're setting up a private
- network. As with all these parameters, your Fidonet address may be
- easily changed later by using the BASIC CONFIGURATION menu.
-
- The next screen simply tells D'Bridge your COUNTRY CODE and AREA CODE.
- For systems in the U.S., this is quite simple: Your country code is 1 and
- your area code should be obvious. D'Bridge needs this information so that
- it can distinguish local calls from long-distance. The following screen
- will be displayed:
-
-
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge EMAIL System / Version 1.30 | INSTALLATION: Country/Area code |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | D'Bridge already knows how to dial long-distance calls in most cases. |
- | What it doesn't know is which phone numbers are within your local |
- | calling area. To do this, you must specify what "prefix" to remove |
- | from phone numbers in order to place local calls. |
- | |
- | In most countries, you can simply specify your COUNTRY CODE and AREA |
- | CODE. For example, in Miami, Florida I use "1" as my country code |
- | (meaning US/Canada) and "305" as my area code. This means that for |
- | any phone number beginning with 1-305, I will usually place as a local |
- | call. Of course, there are always exceptions to this; most area codes |
- | cover more than one local calling area an (in the US) I'll need to dial |
- | a "1" before the number, but you'll need to read the user documentation |
- | for a complete explanation of that... |
- | |
- | What is your COUNTRY CODE? 1 |
- | AREA CODE? |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- Press F1 for the previous screen or ESC to abort the installation
-
-
-
- This screen should be completely self-explanatory unless you live in
- another country but the U.S. If you don't know your COUNTRY CODE, look in
- your DOS manual or call your phone company. Again, your area code should
- be obvious.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 16D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Initial configuration 2.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | D'Bridge EMAIL System / Version 1.30 | INSTALLATION: Final recap |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | To summarize, here's the information that you have specified: |
- | |
- | |
- | Color choice: Standard |
- | |
- | COMM port: COM1 |
- | Modem baud rate: 1200 |
- | Dialing: Touch-tone |
- | Modem type: U.S. Robotics Courier 2400 |
- | |
- | Fidonet address: 1:18/68 |
- | |
- | Local "prefix": 1-305 |
- | |
- | |
- | Is this information completely accurate? (Yes/No) |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- Press F1 for the previous screen or ESC to abort the installation
-
-
-
-
- This screen simply recaps all the information that you have entered. If
- it's wrong, you may go back and change it. Don't worry - you can always
- change any of this information later by using the configuration menus.
- Once you say YES to this screen, D'Bridge is installed - congratulations.
- These parameters barely "scratch the surface" of the capabilities of
- D'Bridge. There are HUNDREDS of different parameters that you may change
- by using one of the menu configuration screens. You can customize your
- D'Bridge installation to exactly suit your needs.
-
- Good luck.
-
- Call Technical Support from 9:00 AM to 5:00 PM EST at 305-232-5245
- for assistance.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 17D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Design philosophy, basic concepts 2.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 2.4 DESIGN PHILOSOPHY, BASIC CONCEPTS
- --------------------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge is complex program that allows a user complete control over
- its operation. There are just four programs involved in the routine
- operation of the EMAIL system:
-
- DB.EXE This is the "shell" program that runs DBMAILER.EXE
- and DBEDIT.EXE. Normally, this is the program to
- run to start the system.
-
- DBMAILER.EXE This is the MAILER portion. It controls your modem
- both answering and originating calls; it can control
- your FAX card at the same time. Think of the MAILER
- as a fancy timer/clock that allows you to program
- different "events" to happen using a weekly schedule.
- EMAIL is transmitted only when the schedule permits;
- mail schedules can be set up to send all the mail at
- the least-expensive overnight rates.
-
- DBEDIT.EXE This is the EDITOR portion. It is very much like a
- word-processor in operation, but instead of documents,
- there are EMAIL messages. DBEDIT allows you to enter,
- read and reply to messages.
-
- DBUTIL.EXE This is the utility program. It allows for additional
- functions such as SEND FILE or POLL to be executed from
- a batch file so that nightly data transmissions can be
- automated. With the PURGE option, DBUTIL will purge the
- message base.
-
-
-
-
- There are some basic terms that are important to understand when
- dealing with D'Bridge. There is also a complete glossary located
- in appendix A, but here's the ones that you'll need to get started:
-
-
- EMAIL Electronic mail, or in D'Bridge terms, messages that
- are sent directly between systems or routed through
- a host. EMAIL messages may be public or private and
- may be sent in normal or compressed form. (XMAIL)
-
- NETMAIL NETmail or network mail is the name of the EMAIL message
- area for messages sent directly between systems. Each
- NETmail message has an ORIGIN and a specific DESTINATION
- where it is to be sent.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 18D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Design philosophy, basic concepts 2.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- ECHOmail ECHOmail is a form of conferencing. When an ECHOmail
- message is entered on your system, it is automatically
- "echoed" to all other systems participating in the given
- conference. ECHOmail messages are generally not private
- since they can be read by the system operator of each
- node receiving it.
-
- ECHOmail conferences are generally topic-specific. For
- example, there may be an ECHOmail conference about SKIING
- and one about SCUBA_DIVING. This provides a means of
- linking lots of people throughout the world in a common
- forum for discussion.
-
- XMAIL In D'Bridge terms, XMAIL simply means compressed mail.
- Compression is done by common compression/archival
- programs that store a series of files inside a single
- archive. By default, ARC by System Enhancement Associates
- is used to store and compress the mail so that telephone
- costs may be cut. ZIP, PAK and LHARC are also supported
- as standard compression methods.
-
- If you wish to use the XMAIL features of D'Bridge, you
- will need to get one of these supported archive programs:
-
- ARC System Enhancement Associates
- 21 New Street
- Wayne, NJ 07470
-
- PKZIP PKWARE, Inc.
- 7545 N. Port Washington Rd.
- Glendale, WI 53217
-
- PAK NoGate Consulting
- P.O. Box 88115
- Grand Rapids, MI 49518-0115
-
- LHARC Copyright by Haruyasu Toshizaki
-
-
- NETWORK A NETWORK is a group of computer systems that have the
- ability to send EMAIL on a scheduled or continuous basis.
- In D'Bridge, NETWORKS are defined by a NODELIST file.
-
- NODELIST A NODELIST is a text file that contains a list of EMAIL
- systems in a given NETWORK. The list is in a structured
- form known as the "St. Louis" format. D'Bridge needs to
- compile the raw list(s) into its database before a new
- nodelist file may be used. If you are joining a public
- NETWORK, you will need to obtain a copy of their NODELIST
- from a "network administrator." If you are setting up a
- private NETWORK, you will need to create your own
- NODELIST file; see SECTION 6.0 for more information.
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 19D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Design philosophy, basic concepts 2.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- MESSAGE A MESSAGE is the basis of EMAIL communications. A user
- enters a MESSAGE in the editor and ADDRESSES it to any
- other system in the NODELIST.
-
- ADDRESS Each EMAIL MESSAGE has two addresses: the ORIGIN and
- DESTINATION ADDRESS. The ORIGIN is simply the ADDRESS
- of the system that wrote the message and the DESTINATION
- is the ADDRESS of the system where the message is being
- sent. In D'Bridge, addresses are broken up into four
- segments: ZONE, NET, NODE and POINT. Each of these
- segments is a number between 0 and 32767. The normal
- format for an EMAIL ADDRESS is ZONE:NET/NODE.POINT or
- ZONE:NET/NODE.FAXNAME for a FAX DESTINATION.
-
- ZONE The ZONE ADDRESS is a number between 1 and 32767 that
- designates a NETWORK or geographic region. In the case
- of public NETWORKS, different ZONES have been used to
- designate completely separate NODELISTS.
-
- NET The NET ADDRESS is a number between 1 and 32767 that
- designates LOCAL NETWORKS. A LOCAL NETWORK consists
- of a HOST NODES and BOSS NODES and POINTS.
-
- NODE The NODE ADDRESS is a number between 0 and 32767 that
- designates the ADDRESS of an individual system. If the
- NODE number is 0, the system is a HOST NODE.
-
- POINT The POINT ADDRESS is a number between 0 and 32767 that
- designates the ADDRESS of an individual system acting as
- a POINT. If the POINT number is 0, the system is a
- BOSS NODE; otherwise, the system uses its BOSS NODE to
- receive and sometimes send EMAIL.
-
- BOSS NODE A BOSS NODE is any system operating with a point address
- of zero. The difference between a BOSS NODE and a POINT
- is that BOSS NODES are listed in the NODELIST of a
- NETWORK and POINTS are not. A BOSS NODE will HOLD and
- FORWARD EMAIL and files to its POINTS.
-
- HOST NODE A HOST NODE acts as a collecting point for EMAIL and
- files that are HOST-ROUTED. When a message and/or file
- is ROUTED, it is FORWARDED for the appropriate NODES
- automatically.
-
- EVENT An EVENT is a scheduled item that controls EMAIL routing
- or executes a series of DOS commands at preprogrammed
- time. The SCHEDULE consists of from 1 to 64 EVENTS that
- tell D'Bridge what to do.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 20D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Design philosophy, basic concepts 2.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- D'Bridge has four basic modes of operation:
-
-
-
- MAILER The normal mode of operation, the MAILER mode of D'Bridge
- is normally running 24-hours/day unless you are running
- D'Bridge only at certain times. While in the MAILER mode,
- D'Bridge sends and receives EMAIL and files based on a
- preprogrammed schedule. The MAILER mode is a completely
- unattended method and scheduling a system and transferring
- data between systems.
-
- The user has the ability to control the queue of outbound
- file-transmissions and file-requests as well as XMAIL and
- standard EMAIL. No mail will be sent if the system is
- not left in MAILER mode when not in use by the operator.
-
-
-
- EDITOR The EDITOR mode allows you to enter and read EMAIL
- messages sent and received by D'Bridge. The EDITOR is
- a specialized word-processor specifically designed for
- simplicity and power. The editor can be configured to
- read hundreds of local and ECHOmail areas as well as
- standard EMAIL.
-
-
-
- TERMINAL The TERMINAL mode allows D'Bridge to act as a ANSI
- terminal allowing the user to call other systems such
- as Bulletin Board Systems (BBS) or commercial systems
- such as CompuServe<TM>. This mode provides upload and
- download capability plus the ability to set up a
- custom dialing directory of systems frequently called.
-
-
-
- CONFIGURATION The CONFIGURATION mode of D'Bridge consists of a series
- of parameter screens that provide complete control over
- the operation of the software. There are hundreds of
- user-definable parameters that control the scheduling,
- communications and routing of the EMAIL. For added
- security, a password may be required to enter the various
- CONFIGURATION screens.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 21D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Basic EMAIL/FAX setup, scheduling 2.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 2.5 BASIC EMAIL/FAX SETUP, SCHEDULING
- --------------------------------------
-
-
- In order to gain a complete understanding of D'Bridge, we suggest that
- you follow this guideline to configuring the software initially. Using
- this section, follow along step-by-step as we setup D'Bridge initially.
-
-
- IDLE: ESC-Commands D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--------------------------------------+-ACTIVITY-------------------------\
- | | |
- | | |
- | | Friday, December 15, 1989 |
- | | |
- |11:51 D'Bridge ONLINE, 204821 bytes free | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 Scanning for outbound crashmail | |
- |11:51 0 messages scanned, 0 want out | |
- |11:51 No messages to send at this time | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 Waiting for call or event | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | -- No outbound mail currently in the queue -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- 1. When D'Bridge is first loaded, it will perform a series of self-
- tests on its environment, files and peripherals. There are several
- warning messages you may see in the LOG window. Here's a summary
- of the warnings and what they mean:
-
-
- WARNING: Unable to initialize modem
-
- This warning means that there is a modem defined but D'Bridge
- is unable to communicate with it. The software expects an "OK"
- response when the initialization string is sent to the modem.
- A number of things could cause this problem, the most likely
- being that a cable is loose, the modem is off or something is
- set wrong in the COMM/MODEM setup screen; see SECTION 3.7 for
- more information.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 22D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Basic EMAIL/FAX setup, scheduling 2.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- WARNING: Modem requires X00.SYS driver
-
- You have forgotten to install the X00.SYS device driver in your
- CONFIG.SYS file; D'Bridge need a FOSSIL driver to operate the
- modem. See SECTION 2.2 for more information.
-
-
- WARNING: 64K free RAM needed for ECHOmail
-
- If there is not at least 64K of memory free when you run
- D'Bridge, ECHOmail processing is not possible. Increase the
- environment size or lower the TOTAL MEMORY on the BASIC
- CONFIGURATION screen; see SECTION 3.5 for more information.
-
-
- WARNING: FAX software offline!
-
- You have defined a FAX card in the system but the software
- or card is not responding as it should. Check your FAX card
- or software configuration.
-
-
- WARNING: Unable to open log file
-
- The LOG FILE that is defined on the BASIC CONFIG screen is
- an invalid filename or can't be created for some reason.
- Check the drive and path; see SECTION 3.5 for more information.
-
-
- NOTE: "Demo" key has 27 days left!
-
- Your demonstration license key will expire in 27 days. This
- warning will only appear if you are running a demo copy of
- D'Bridge. This is here for two reasons: to remind you that
- the software is not free and to make sure that you order your
- copy before your key expires.
-
-
- ERROR: Insufficient disk space on C:
-
- There is not enough disk space for D'Bridge to operate. This
- is based on the values established on the DISK MINIMUMS screen.
- The solution to this problem is either to free some disk space
- on the "offending" drive or use DB SETUP to change the DISK
- MINIMUMS. (Typing "DB SETUP" from the DOS command line will
- allow you to use the configuration menus without D'Bridge
- coming online.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 23D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Basic EMAIL/FAX setup, scheduling 2.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- Main: MAIL EDITOR UTILITIES CONFIG ADVANCED QUIT D'Bridge
- /---------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-LOG-| Hold ALL mail |--------------+-ACTIVITY-------------------------\
- | | View/modify queue | | |
- | | Rebuild queue | | |
- | | Transmit file(s) | | Friday, December 15, 1989 |
- | | File-request | | |
- |11:51| Poll a node |21 bytes free | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51| Information display | crashmail | |
- |11:51\---------------------/ want out | |
- |11:51 No messages to send at this time | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 Waiting for call or event | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | -- No outbound mail currently in the queue -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \------------------------------------------+----------------------------------/
-
-
- 2. When the top-left corner of the screen says "IDLE," you may press
- the ESC key to display the main menu. Pressing the ESC key a second
- time will return to IDLE mode. Select menu items by using the ARROW
- keys to select the desired option then press ENTER. Pressing the
- first letter of any option will select that option immediately
- without any other keystrokes.
-
-
- 3. On the EDITOR menu, select the SETUP EDITOR PARAMETERS option.
- (Pressing ESC-E-S is a quick way of getting to this menu from the
- IDLE state.) Choose answers for all the fields on this screen.
- If you're not sure about a field, leave it blank or accept the pre-
- programmed "default;" refer to SECTION 3.1 for more information.
-
-
- 4. On the CONFIG menu, select each of the following options and
- fill-in all the fields with the appropriate information. Again,
- if you don't understand something, just accept the "default"
- value or leave it blank.
-
- Screen Section
-
- BASIC CONFIGURATION 3.5
- DIRECTORY PATHS 3.6
- COMM/MODEM SETUP 3.8
- FAX CONFIGURATION 3.9
- NODELIST CONFIGURATION 3.11
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 24D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Basic EMAIL/FAX setup, scheduling 2.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 5. If you run a bulletin board system (BBS,) setup the information on
- the ADVANCED MENU, BBS CONFIGURATION screen; refer to SECTION 3.15
- for more information on this screen.
-
-
- 6. Next, if there are certain mail schedules required for your
- NETWORK, you can set them up in the SCHEDULE MAINTENANCE option
- of the CONFIG menu. Typically, a NETWORK will have at least one
- MAIL EVENT each night. During these events, EMAIL and files are
- allowed to be sent; this allows EMAIL entered during the day to
- be transmitted at night, yielding the highest savings in tele-
- communication costs. See SECTION 3.9 for more information.
-
-
- 7. At this point, your system should be configured for basic EMAIL
- operation. Assuming that you defined a NODELIST on the NODELIST
- CONFIGURATION screen, it must be compiled before D'Bridge can use
- it. The NODELIST always gets compiled when the system is brought
- up and a new NODELIST exists. If you haven't left the program,
- you can force a nodelist compile by using the FORCE NODELIST
- COMPILE on the UTILITIES menu. This process takes a few minutes,
- so be patient.
-
- 8. Now EMAIL is fully configured and you may continue either by
- reading SECTION 2.6, BASIC ECHOMAIL SETUP or by proceeding to
- SECTION 2.7, USING D'BRIDGE EMAIL SYSTEM.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 25D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Basic ECHOmail setup 2.6
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 2.6 BASIC ECHOMAIL SETUP
- -------------------------
-
-
- It is assumed that you've completed the previous section and setup most
- of the parameters on all the menus listed. If you haven't please go
- back an read SECTION 2.5 as you configure D'Bridge.
-
- Before you configure the ECHOmail subsystem, it is a good idea to have
- a general understanding of what it and how it works. The D'Bridge
- ECHOmail processor is completely automatic in operation once properly
- configured.
-
-
- - What is ECHOmail?
-
- The facility to allow for EMAIL-based conferencing in any number of
- message areas (SIGs) at the same. An ECHOmail message differs from
- a NETmail message only in that there is no DESTINATION ADDRESS for
- an ECHOmail message; it gets sent to ALL systems participating in
- the conference.
-
- With ECHOmail, you have the capability of sharing ideas with other
- people in SPECIAL INTEREST GROUPS or SIGS. A conference is created
- for each topic of discussion and you may participate in as few or
- as many as you wish. When you enter a message, it is automatically
- forwarded to all the other nodes you are linking to the conference.
- In turn, all the other nodes forward the message to all the nodes
- they link to; the process continues until your message has been seen
- by every system participating in the conference. Your message can
- be sent to THOUSANDS of systems if a conference is a large one!
-
- ECHOmail is a unique form of communication, new to the '80s that
- hasn't really exploded yet. People that live 3,000 miles apart can
- carry on a public discussion on any topic or interest they have
- in common.
-
- An example of some public ECHOmail conferences that anyone may
- participate in:
-
- DBRIDGE D'Bridge users conference
- HUMOR Sick jokes and humor
- POLITICS International political discussion
- SYSOP International Sysop ECHO
- ZMODEM Discussion about the ZMODEM protocol
-
-
- For more information about how to receive public ECHOmail, contact
- any of our support nodes and we'll be glad to help you.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 26D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Basic ECHOmail setup 2.6
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- - How does ECHOmail work?
-
- Each ECHOmail conference is actually an entire network within
- itself. An ECHOmail network is defined by its TOPOLOGY or the
- way in which the network interconnects. The following chart
- describes the topology of an ECHOmail conference that I
- currently use:
-
-
- -------------------
- 1:18/68 (my system)
- ---------+---------
- |
- |
- |
- /-----------+------------+-----+-----+-------------+-------------\
- | | | | | |
- ---+--- ----+---- ----+---- ---+----- ----+----- ----+----
- 1:105/3 1:107/150 1:150/613 1:3601/22 2:512/1006 1:18/68.1
- ---+--- --------- --------- ---+----- ----+----- ---------
- | | |
- +-----------+------------\ | +-------\
- | | | | | |
- ---+---- ---+---- ----+---- ---+----- ---+----- |
- 1:105/10 1:105/50 1:105/300 1:3601/14 2:280/280 |
- -------- -------- ----+---- --------- --------- |
- | |
- +----------------\ |
- | | |
- -----+------ -----+------ -----+------
- 1:105/300.14 1:105/300.68 2:512/1006.1
- ------------ ------------ ------------
-
-
- To understand what topology is and how messages get to all the
- systems in the conference, let's take an example of a message
- entered on 1:105/300.68 that is a reply to a message from
- 2:512/1006.1 ---
-
- The message would pass through the following systems to make it
- to its final destination:
-
- 1:105/300.68, 1:105/300, 1:105/3, 1:18/68, 2:512/1006, 2:512/1006.1
-
- This could take anywhere from a few hours to a few days depending
- on the events running on the different systems; the message must
- be forwarded through four different systems before making it to
- 2:512/1006.1!
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 27D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Basic ECHOmail setup 2.6
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- You will notice that the topology (interconnection) is in the form
- of a tree starting with my address at the top. ECHOmail topology is
- different from every system's point-of-view. In the above network,
- there may be links that I don't know exist. For example, I have no
- way of knowing what points 1:105/300 is sending the ECHOmail. The
- tree looks completely different from his point-of-view.
-
- The main thing to remember is never to have more than once "source"
- of an ECHO. It is fine to forward an echo to several other systems,
- but make sure that all topology follows this tree structure and
- never causes any loops.
-
- Most networks have an ECHOmail coordinator whose job it is to ensure
- that the topology for the local network is correct. If you are a
- member of a public network, you should always contact the ECHOmail
- coordinator before setting up ECHOmail links.
-
-
-
- IMPROPER TOPOLOGY ACCEPTABLE TOPOLOGY
-
- /-----------\ /-----------\
- | | | |
- ---+--- ---+--- ---+--- ---+---
- 1:134/2 1:134/5 1:134/2 1:134/5
- ---+--- ---+--- ---+--- ---+---
- | | | |
- ---+--- ----+---- ---+--- ----+----
- 1:134/3 1:134/150 1:134/3 1:134/150
- ---+--- ----+---- ------- ---------
- | |
- \-----------/
-
-
-
-
- OPTIMUM TOPOLOGY
- System FORWARD TO a
- ------ ---------- -------
- 1:134/2 1:134/3 1:134/5 1:134/150 1:134/2
- 1:134/3 1:134/2 ---+---
- 1:134/5 1:135/2 |
- 1:134/150 1:135/2 /-----------+-----------\
- b | c | d |
- ---+--- ---+--- ----+----
- 1:134/3 1:134/5 1:134/150
- ------- ------- ---------
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 28D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Basic ECHOmail setup 2.6
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- To configure basic ECHOmail capabilities, follow the following
- sequence of instructions to gain a greater understanding of
- D'Bridge.
-
-
- 1. From the CONFIG menu, select the PACKET/MAIL CONTROL screen.
- Using this screen, set the ECHOmail-related parameters like
- this:
-
- Unpack mail? Yes
- Kill null msgs? Yes
- Process ECHOmail? Yes
- Save ECHOmail AREA line? No
- Save ECHOmail SEENBYs? No
- Save duplicate messages? No
- Auto-add ECHOmail areas? No (for now)
- Accept AREAFIX requests? Yes
-
- See SECTION 3.12 for more information.
-
-
- 2. Next, select the XMAIL CONTROL screen. Here, you should
- already have defaults displayed for each of the compression
- commands. If you are using different archive programs than
- the ones specified, change them as appropriate, but remember
- that the formats of the ARC, PAK, ZIP or LHARC files must
- be the same.
-
- Specify "YES" to "Unpack inbound XMAIL."
-
- XMAIL uses the ARC program by default, but you may specify
- which compression methods to use for which systems on this
- screen.
-
- See SECTION 3.13 for more information.
-
-
- 3. On the ADVANCED menu, select the DISK SPACE MINIMUMS screen.
- D'Bridge comes preprogrammed with suggested minimum disk
- space criteria. If you plan to use more than one hard-drive
- to store the message bases or queue directory, make sure that
- you specify minimums for all drives used.
-
- See SECTION 3.17 for more information.
-
-
- 4. On the EDITOR menu, select the LOCAL/ECHOMAIL AREAS screen.
- Following the directions listed in SECTION 3.2, create all
- the ECHOmail areas that you will be using. In the FORWARD
- TO fields, list the addresses of the systems that you want
- to setup ECHOmail links for.
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 29D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Basic ECHOmail setup 2.6
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- 5. That's all there is to it. For ECHOmail to work, you must
- verify the following things:
-
- a. D'Bridge reports at least enough free memory as it takes to
- run the compression and decompression programs specified on
- the XMAIL CONTROL screen. When D'Bridge first comes online,
- it says how many bytes of memory are available. Typically,
- this must be around 100K, depending on the compression
- programs that you are using.
-
- b. The compression programs specified must exist in the current
- default path.
-
- c. There is enough free disk space; there will be a warning
- at the bottom of the screen if disk space is too low to
- unpack or forward ECHOmail.
-
- 6. Next, proceed with SECTION 2.7, USING D'BRIDGE EMAIL SYSTEM.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 30D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using D'Bridge EMail System 2.7
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 2.7 USING D'BRIDGE EMAIL SYSTEM
- --------------------------------
-
-
- The operation of D'Bridge can be broken down into three modes:
-
- MAILER Sends/receives EMAIL and files automatically
- EDITOR Specialized word-processor to read and enter EMAIL
- TERMINAL Terminal emulator to access remote data systems manually
-
-
- MAILER
-
- The MAILER mode is the normal mode of operation for D'Bridge. While
- running, it answers incoming calls as well as placing outbound calls
- to other EMAIL systems. The first thing that you need to understand
- is the operation is the STATUS indications.
-
- The upper-right corner of your screen indicates what mode the system
- is in and what keys have what effect on the mailer operation. Here's
- the most common displays and what they mean:
-
-
- IDLE: ESC-Commands
-
- This is displayed when the system is completely IDLE and has no
- outbound calls to make at the current time. Pressing ESC displays
- the MAIN command menu.
-
-
-
- SCANNING MAIL: ESC-Abort scan
-
- When D'Bridge is SCANNING MAIL, it is creating outbound packets
- to send based on the EMAIL messages in your NETmail message base.
- Messages entered through the editor, file-transfer requests by
- DBUTIL and ECHOmail being forwarded to other systems is placed in
- the queue at the beginning of every mail event. If you press the
- ESC key and abort the mail scan, the queue will not be completely
- built and some EMAIL might not go out; you will receive the warning
- message "Mail scan aborted by operator" in the LOG window.
-
-
-
- MAIL EVENT: Next call, ESC-Commands
-
- This means that there are currently outbound calls to be placed.
- D'Bridge places calls at random time intervals, but the operator
- may force the next call to be made at any time by pressing the
- letter N. Pressing ESC displays the MAIN command menu.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 31D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using D'Bridge EMail System 2.7
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- ACTIVE CALL: Next call, ESC-Cancel call
-
- The ACTIVE CALL status means that D'Bridge has placed an outbound
- call but not yet received a CARRIER DETECT signal from the modem.
- Usually, at this point, a call may be aborted without any long-
- distance charges being incurred. (Unless something has already
- answered on the other end.) Pressing N for next call immediately
- terminates the call and move to the next item in the queue.
- Pressing ESC simply terminates the outbound call. The next call
- will not be placed immediately.
-
-
-
-
- ACTIVE SESSION: ESC-Abort session
-
- The ACTIVE SESSION status means that you are currently connected
- and transferring information. Pressing ESC at this point will
- cancel the mail session as soon as possible and abort the call.
- If it is an outbound call, D'Bridge may try again later, depending
- on how you have it configured in schedule.
-
-
-
-
- ECHOscan: Press ESC to cancel
-
- D'Bridge is scanning your message bases for outbound ECHOmail.
- You may stop this process at anytime by pressing ESC. Processing
- will stop as soon as it is possible. This could take a few seconds
- depending on what phase of the scan is in progress. If you cancel
- the ECHOscan, it will resume where it was interrupted the next time
- a scan is done.
-
-
-
-
- NODELIST COMPILE: Press ESC to cancel
-
- D'Bridge is currently compiling all your nodelists into its internal
- database. This may take anywhere from 1 to 20 minutes depending on
- the size of your nodelists and the speed of your computer. You may
- cancel the compile at any time by pressing ESC, but if you do, the
- nodelist database will not be complete and D'Bridge will not find
- some of the systems in the list.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 32D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using D'Bridge EMail System 2.7
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- MAILER MENUS
-
-
- When the system is in IDLE or MAIL EVENT mode, pressing the ESC key will
- display the MAIN MENU. There are six separate menus available in this
- mode:
-
-
-
- MAIL The MAIL menu allows you to transmit and request files
- as well as control the outbound mail queue.
-
-
- EDITOR The EDITOR menu lets enter DBEDIT, the EMAIL editor or
- change its configuration. Local and ECHOmail areas may
- also be defined using this menu.
-
-
- UTILITIES Most of the "miscellaneous" features of D'Bridge are
- found on the UTILITIES menu.
-
-
- CONFIG The CONFIG menu controls the basic configuration of the
- software. Directory paths, modem, FAX and nodelist
- setup are a few of the options.
-
-
- ADVANCED The ADVANCED menu allows you to control some of the
- more sophisticated features such as BBS, security, disk
- minimums and cost-accounting.
-
-
- QUIT The QUIT menu allows you access to DOS by leaving the
- program entirely or by PUSHING/DROPPING to DOS.
-
-
-
-
- To select a menu item, you may either move the highlight bar by using
- the UP, DOWN, LEFT and RIGHT arrow keys then pressing ENTER when the
- desired selection is highlighted. An alternate (and quicker) method is
- to press the first letter of the menu or selection that you desire.
- The main thing to remember when using D'Bridge is that pressing the ESC
- key will get you out of any screen.
-
- For more information about individual menu options, see the table of
- contents; each menu option has a chapter describing it in detail.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 33D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using D'Bridge EMail System 2.7
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- EDITOR
-
-
- The D'Bridge editor, DBEDIT, is a text-editor designed specifically for
- entering and reading EMAIL messages; think of the editor as a specialized
- word-processor. Once D'Bridge is configured, the EDITOR mode will most-
- likely be used on a daily basis to read and respond to EMAIL messages.
-
- Start EDITOR mode by pressing ALT-E or ESC-E-R when D'Bridge is in the
- IDLE or MAIL EVENT mode. It may take up to 10-15 seconds to load the
- editor, depending on the speed of your computer. An alternate way to
- start the editor is by typing "DBEDIT" at the DOS prompt. DBEDIT.EXE
- is a separate program and may be run stand-alone from DOS.
-
- The editor allows you to read, enter, reply, edit, list and kill EMAIL
- messages along with a variety of other functions that complete the
- integrated environment. For information on how to use the editor to
- read and enter EMAIL, see SECTION 5.0 for complete details.
-
-
-
-
-
- TERMINAL
-
-
- The TERMINAL mode of D'Bridge causes your PC to emulate an ANSI terminal
- allowing you to manually access remote data systems such as CompuServe,
- The Source and Bulletin Board Systems. Pressing ESC-U-T, ALT-C or ALT-D
- starts the terminal mode. ALT-Z will display a short help screen that
- describes what keys have what function.
-
- The terminal has a dialing directory that you may edit as well as the
- ability to "cycle-dial" systems from the mailer's nodelist. Uploads and
- downloads using XMODEM, TELINK or ZMODEM are also supported.
-
- It is not the intention for D'Bridge to compete with the other excellent
- terminal programs such as PROCOMM, TELIX and CROSSTALK; terminal mode
- is provided simply as a convenience. If you require advanced scripting
- or other features not provided by D'Bridge, you should look into these
- other programs.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 34D'Bridge Electronic Mail System The SETUP Menu 3.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 3.0 THE SETUP MENU
- -------------------
-
-
- Before D'Bridge is put ONLINE, it is important to have the basic setup
- correctly defined. Usually, the installation process should provide
- an up-and-running system, but you might find it necessary to change the
- configuration before going ONLINE. To facilitate this, there is a
- command-line option to run the SETUP menu without bringing up the EMAIL
- system.
-
- From your DOS prompt, (in the D'Bridge directory) type:
-
- DB SETUP
-
- i.e.
-
- C>DB SETUP
-
-
- This command will bring up the following menu:
-
- SETUP: EDITOR CONFIG ADVANCED QUIT
- /-------------------------\
- | Setup editor parameters |
- | Local/ECHOmail areas |
- | Keyboard macros |
- | Translation table |
- \-------------------------/
-
-
- Select the desired menu by using the LEFT and RIGHT arrow keys to change
- the selected category (highlighted on the top line.) You may also press
- the first letter of the desired selection to change menus. Select the
- desired menu option by moving the highlight-bar to the desired option
- and pressing ENTER. Again, you can directly select a menu option by
- pressing the first letter of the desired selection.
-
- Following is a brief description of each menu and its functions:
-
- EDITOR To change the editor configuration
- CONFIG Basic EMAIL system configuration, schedules, nodelists
- ADVANCED Configuration of more advanced features, security
- QUIT Exit SETUP
-
-
- Each of these options is also available on the main menu of D'Bridge;
- they are just provided here to give you an OFFLINE method to maintain
- the configuration. To leave this setup screen and return to DOS, use
- the QUIT/LEAVE SETUP option (or press ESC at any menu.)
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 35D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Setup editor parameters 3.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 3.1 EDITOR: SETUP EDITOR PARAMETERS
- ------------------------------------
-
-
- The SETUP EDITOR PARAMETERS option allows the operator to define certain
- options that affect the D'Bridge EMAIL editor. This screen will appear:
-
-
- /-SETUP EDITOR PARAMETERS-----------------------------------------------\
- | Editor method: DROP (DROP/PUSH) |
- | Restart crashmail? Yes |
- | Scan ECHOmail? Yes |
- | Sound effects? Yes |
- | Default private? No |
- | Kill/sent? No |
- | Archive/sent? No |
- | XMail? No |
- | Priority? Normal (Immediate/Crash/Normal/Hold) |
- | Insert? No |
- | INTL addressing? No |
- | Valid user names: Chris Irwin |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
- EDITOR METHOD
-
- The editor, DBEDIT, is a separate program. There are two ways to invoke
- the editor from within D'Bridge:
-
-
- DROP When you DROP to the editor, all program memory is written
- to the disk or EMS memory, freeing most of the memory. The
- DBEDIT program will be spawned from a "switched task."
-
- PUSH When you push to the editor, only the memory NOT used by
- D'Bridge will be available for DBEDIT. Make sure you have
- at least 220K free if you use this method. (This is no
- problem on most 640K machines.)
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 36D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Setup editor parameters 3.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- RESTART CRASHMAIL?
-
- This parameter gives you the option to automatically re-scan the
- netmail area after EMAIL has been entered or deleted. This scan
- will happen immediately after exiting the editor. If you want the
- mail scanned automatically, specify YES here.
-
-
-
- SCAN ECHOMAIL?
-
- If you want to send ECHOmail messages immediately after leaving the
- editor, specify YES here. The D'Bridge ECHOmail scanner knows what
- areas need to be scanned if any. If you don't say YES here, then
- ECHOmail will not be sent until an ECHOscan is run either in an event
- or manually with the command: UTILITIES-Process ECHOmail.
-
-
-
- SOUND EFFECTS?
-
- This specifies whether the "warning beeps" will be active in the
- editor. Answer YES, and if they bother you, just change your answer
- later.
-
-
-
- DEFAULT PRIVATE?
-
- This specifies whether the editor will default all new messages to
- private status or not. "Private" usually means that the EMAIL is
- only intended for the receiver, however you should note that mail
- can be read by all systems it passes through. (Unless mail is
- encrypted somehow)
-
-
-
- KILL/SENT?
-
- This specifies the default for the "Kill when sent" flag in the editor.
- If you have no use for a copy of outbound mail, you might want to
- specify "YES" here. Mail flagged KILL/SENT is erased after being sent
- to the next destination.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 37D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Setup editor parameters 3.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- ARCHIVE/SENT?
-
- This specifies the default for the "Archive when sent" flag in the
- editor. If you want to save a copy of the outbound mail in a text
- file "archive," answer YES here. When a message is sent, it is added
- to the text file showing the date and time of transmission; the message
- is then erased.
-
-
- XMAIL?
-
- This specifies the default for the "XMail" flag in the editor. If a
- message is flagged as "XMAIL," the mail scanner will compress the
- message packet using one of several archive formats: ARC, ZIP, PAK and
- LHARC. Once EMAIL is added to an XMAIL packet, it is considered "sent"
- in the editor; if it's marked as Kill/Sent, it will be killed.
-
-
- PRIORITY?
-
- This specifies the default priority for EMAIL messages. The priority
- determines when (if at all) the message will be transmitted from the
- system. There are four priorities listed here from highest to lowest:
-
-
- IMMEDIATE When a message is flagged as IMMEDIATE, it has the
- ultimate priority on the system. All IMMEDIATE
- messages must be transmitted before any other out-
- bound calls are possible. Using this priority is
- quite effective in getting the mail out fast, but
- has the disadvantage of slowing down outbound mail
- traffic if the IMMEDIATE systems are busy or not
- answering.
-
- CRASH Messages flagged as CRASH are allowed to be sent
- anytime, 24-hours a day. Unless a "hold" override
- is placed on a system, an EMAIL message with CRASH
- priority will be sent during the UNEVENT or any
- scheduled event. If entered during the day, CRASH-
- priority messages will most-likely be sent at the
- highest phone rates.
-
- NORMAL When a message is flagged as NORMAL, it will not
- be transmitted until a scheduled mail event. Using
- this priority (usually overnight delivery) is the
- most cost-effective way to use D'Bridge for EMAIL.
-
- HOLD When a message is flagged as HOLD, it will not be
- sent until the destination system polls or another
- non-HOLD message is entered. Use HOLD priority if
- you intend for most systems to call to pickup their
- mail.
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 38D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Setup editor parameters 3.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- INSERT?
-
- This specifies the default state of "insert mode" in the editor.
- Some people prefer to work in insert mode and other do not. If you
- want "insert" to be on in the editor by default, answer YES here.
-
-
-
- INTL ADDRESSING?
-
- This option allows you to use INTL (international) addressing on all
- messages. Most systems would answer NO to this, but if your system
- uses alias addresses in more than one zone, you should answer YES
- here.
-
-
-
- VALID USERNAMES
-
- Here, you specify a list of valid users and their "passwords." The
- correct format for a user line with a password is:
-
- Chris Irwin,password
-
- If more than one line is entered here, every time the editor is run,
- you must specify which user you are. This is for the "FROM" field in
- the message editor. If you only specify one line, you won't have to
- confirm anything (except your password, if specified.)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 39D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Local/ECHOmail areas 3.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 3.2 EDITOR: LOCAL/ECHOMAIL AREAS
- ---------------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge may have hundreds of different message areas. Each area
- consists of any number of EMAIL messages, typically grouped by subject
- matter. There are two built-in areas and any number of user-defined
- areas.
-
-
- BUILT-IN AREAS
-
-
- NETMAIL The network mail area is where direct point-to-point EMAIL
- is stored. When the editor is first started, the netmail
- area is always active. To access another area, you will
- need to use the AREA CHANGE command in DBEDIT. Each NET-
- MAIL message has both an ORIGIN and DESTINATION ADDRESS
- which controls how, where and when the message is sent.
- This area is referred to as AREA 0 or NETMAIL.
-
- BADECHO ECHOmail areas are all user-defined, but a catch-all area
- for unlisted or duplicate ECHOmail messages exists in Fido
- format. In this area, all the unwanted or unknown ECHOmail
- messages that arrive will be stored for the operator.
- This area is referred to as AREA 9999 or BADECHO.
-
-
-
- USER-DEFINED AREAS
-
-
- LOCAL A local area is one used within a LOCAL AREA NETWORK (LAN)
- or as a local message base for a bulletin board system.
- These messages are ignored completely by the mailer, only
- DBEDIT has access to them.
-
- ECHOMAIL An ECHOmail area is one that is shared by two or more
- systems all running Fidonet-compatible EMAIL systems such
- as D'Bridge. ECHOmail areas can receive hundreds of
- messages each day if a conference is large, so be careful
- not to set up more areas than you have disk space for.
- ECHOmail conferences are usually Special Interest Groups
- (SIGs) where the conference exists with a specific topic.
- There are conferences for PROGRAMMING, FLYING, SCUBA,
- POLITICS and hundreds more. An ECHOmail conference may
- be started as easily as two system operators (Sysops)
- setting up a simple ECHO link for a new conference.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 40D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Local/ECHOmail areas 3.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- The Local/ECHOmail areas screen allows you to define up to 9998 areas.
- Each area may be referred to either by AREA NUMBER or TAG. The AREA
- NUMBERS are assigned sequentially starting with 1; you may override this
- assignment and choose your own numbers, but "holes" in the numbering
- system will waste disk space. If you run a BBS, these numbers do not
- have to correspond with your BBS area numbering. TAGS are user-defined
- words or abbreviations to access an area quickly. When scanning or
- changing areas, you may always type either the number or the TAG.
-
- Upon selection of Local/ECHOmail areas, the following screen will be
- displayed:
-
- Areas: NEXT PREVIOUS SCAN ADD CHANGE DUPLICATE REMOVE D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-LOCAL/ECHOMAIL AREA MANAGER-------------------------------------------\
- | Area # 19 Highest area # 23 |
- | Tag: SYSOP135 |
- | Security level: 50 Sort group: 0 |
- | Description: NET 135 Sysop Conference |
- | Storage: Fido (Fido/QuickBBS/None) |
- | Directory path: C:\NETSYSOP\ |
- | Default private? No |
- | Area archive: C:\ARCHIVE\NETSYSOP.TXT |
- | Purge except: 100 messages Preserve: 0 messages |
- | Area type: ECHOmail (ECHOmail/Local) |
- | Conference tag: NETSYSOP |
- | Origin line: D'Bridge Sales and Support/MIAMI |
- | Alias address: 1:135/968 |
- | Tiny SEEN-BYs? No |
- | Default priority: Crash (Immediate/Crash/Normal/Hold) |
- | Forward to: 1:135/14 |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
- Use the ARROW keys to select the option; press ENTER to select; ESC-Exit
-
-
-
- The area manager maintains the area files which contain one screen of
- data for each area defined. When you first select the Local/ECHOmail
- areas screen, the cursor is at the top highlighting the NEXT option.
- To select the desired option, either press the first letter of the
- option "A for ADD" or highlight the desired option using the RIGHT and
- LEFT arrow keys and press ENTER. Pressing ESC will exit this screen.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 41D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Local/ECHOmail areas 3.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- From the "command level," the following commands are available:
-
- NEXT Advance to the next area record.
- PREVIOUS Move to the previous area record.
- SCAN Select from a list of areas already defined.
- ADD Add a new area.
- CHANGE Edit the currently displayed area record.
- DUPLICATE Copy the displayed area to a new record.
- REMOVE Eliminate an area permanently.
-
- ADD, CHANGE and DUPLICATE all use the same edit screen to define the
- area information. Following is a detailed description of each field:
-
-
- AREA #
-
- The AREA NUMBER field may only be assigned when ADDING or DUPLICATING
- an area. The area number is assigned automatically by the computer,
- but you may change this assignment if you wish. Once an AREA NUMBER
- has been assigned, it may not be changed. Valid AREA NUMBERS are from
- 1 to 9998. Try to assign them sequentially to save disk space.
-
-
-
- TAG
-
- The TAG is an word from 1 to 16 characters which you designate as a
- mnemonic reference to an area. It could be a word like POL for politics
- or PROG for programming conference. TAGs must be unique and both NETMAIL
- and BADECHO are predefined by the system.
-
-
- SECURITY LEVEL
-
- The SECURITY LEVEL is used by the AREAFIX subsystem to allow other
- systems to automatically add or delete themselves from ECHO links.
- Security levels are from 0 to 9999; if a system has a security level
- of 50, it has access to all areas with a SECURITY LEVEL of 50 or less.
- If you don't want anyone to have access to an area, make its level be
- 9999.
-
-
- SORT GROUP
-
- The DBUTIL program has an option to sort areas by group/tag. If you
- want to use this option, then put your message areas into logical
- groups for sorting. Sort groups may be from 0 to 9999. When the
- sort is done, areas will the same group number will all be listed
- together alphabetically by TAG.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 42D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Local/ECHOmail areas 3.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- DESCRIPTION
-
- The description is text that describes the message area. This text
- will be used in DBEDIT as an area description, but also when a remote
- system request a list of ECHOmail areas (AREAFIX request.)
-
-
-
- STORAGE
-
- There are three choices for the storage of a message base:
-
- FIDO With FIDO format, each message is stored in a separate
- file in the specified directory. This is the most
- common storage format among Fidonet-based systems, but
- has the disadvantage of being slower than the other
- formats.
-
- QuickBBS With the QUICKBBS format, messages are stored directly
- in a QuickBBS message base. This base may exist stand-
- alone or in conjunction with a QuickBBS system.
-
- NONE If NONE is specified, the area is a PASSTHROUGH for an
- ECHOmail area. The messages are not actually stored
- on this system, just forwarded to the specified systems.
-
-
-
- DIRECTORY PATH
-
- For FIDO storage, you must specify a DIRECTORY PATH for the message
- base. This must be the DOS path to a subdirectory when D'Bridge may
- store the .MSG files for this area. If the directory specified doesn't
- exist, D'Bridge will ask if you want to create it.
-
-
-
- QUICKBBS AREA #
-
- For the QUICKBBS format, you must specify what AREA NUMBER is associated
- with this area. QuickBBS areas are numbered from 1 to 200.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 43D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Local/ECHOmail areas 3.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- DEFAULT PRIVATE?
-
- If you want the editor to flag messages as PRIVATE by default, answer
- YES here. This only affects DBEDIT, the message editor when entering
- or replying to messages.
-
-
-
- AREA ARCHIVE
-
- If you want D'Bridge to save a copy of each message purged when DBUTIL
- PURGE is run, specify a text file to "archive" them in. Each area may
- write messages to a different file, or you may combine several areas
- into a single text file. If you don't want to save a copy of the
- messages, just leave AREA ARCHIVE blank.
-
-
-
- PURGE EXCEPT x MESSAGES / PURGE AFTER x DAYS
-
- In the DBUTIL PURGE program, there are two options for deciding which
- messages to erase from the system. When the cursor is on this field,
- you may press the F1 key to switch between the methods: PURGE EXCEPT
- and PURGE AFTER. With PURGE EXCEPT, DBUTIL will erase all but "x"
- messages; specify "x" in this field as how many messages to save after
- purging. With the PURGE AFTER option, DBUTIL will purge messages based
- on their age. PURGE AFTER 30 DAYS means to erase all messages over 30
- days old when the DBUTIL PURGE is run.
-
-
-
- PRESERVE x MESSAGES
-
- In DBUTIL PURGE, you may specify a certain number of messages to ignore
- while purging. These will be the lowest-numbered messages in the area
- and contain information that you don't want erased such as conference
- rules, etc.
-
-
-
- AREA TYPE
-
- As discussed earlier in this chapter, user-defined areas are either
- LOCAL or ECHOmail. The default is ECHOmail. D'Bridge ignores LOCAL
- areas except while in the editor; When an ECHOscan is done, all
- ECHOmail areas are scanned for outbound mail.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 44D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Local/ECHOmail areas 3.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- CONFERENCE TAG (ECHOmail only)
-
- Each ECHOmail area must have a unique CONFERENCE TAG. This may be the
- same as or differ from the TAG specified above, but must reflect the
- actual ECHOmail name or conference tag used for the specified conference.
- The conference tag may be up to 54 characters and may not contain any
- spaces; when creating a new ECHOmail conference, it is suggested that
- your CONFERENCE TAG not exceed 16 characters if at all possible to
- maintain compatibility with other EMAIL systems.
-
-
-
- ORIGIN LINE (ECHOmail only)
-
- The ORIGIN LINE defaults from your SYSTEM NAME (specified on the BASIC
- CONFIGURATION screen) and will be added to the bottom of all ECHOmail
- messages that originate from your system. Typically, sysops use the
- name of their system and the city where it is located.
-
-
-
- ALIAS ADDRESS (ECHOmail only)
-
- If you are a member of more than one network, it might be necessary to
- use an "alias" address on an ECHOmail area. This means that the address
- put on the ORIGIN-LINE of the messages will be different that your
- primary system address. For most systems, this would be blank.
-
-
-
- TINY SEEN-BYs? (ECHOmail only)
-
- If you say YES to TINY SEEN-BYs, then only the systems that you are
- forwarding a conference to will appear on the SEEN-BY lines. This
- is fine if you are a "leaf node" or a local ECHO hub; PLEASE NOTE THAT
- USING THIS OPTION IS FORBIDDEN IN SOME NETWORKS-CONTACT YOUR LOCAL ECHO-
- MAIL COORDINATOR FOR MORE INFORMATION.
-
-
-
- DEFAULT PRIORITY (ECHOmail only)
-
- For each conference, you specify a DEFAULT PRIORITY for forwarding of
- ECHOmail. Choose either IMMEDIATE, CRASH, NORMAL or HOLD; This default
- may be overridden for any specific system.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 45D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Local/ECHOmail areas 3.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- FORWARD TO (ECHOmail only)
-
- The FORWARD TO fields allow you to specify a list of systems to whom
- you wish to forward this ECHOmail conference. You may specify as many
- systems as will fit on the 5 lines available; the systems should be
- separated by spaces and have the format:
-
- ZONE:NET/NODE.POINT[,PRIORITY]
-
- Here's an example:
-
- 1:18/0 1:105/3 1:135/69,C .5,H
-
- In this example, 135/69 has CRASH priority as an override and .5 has
- HOLD priority specified. Please note that you may only forward ECHOmail
- to nodes or your own points. You may not send EMAIL directly to a point
- of another system.
-
- With this example, if I enter an ECHOmail message in this area, it will
- automatically be forwarded to these four systems, who will in turn send
- my message on to all the other systems participating in the conference.
-
-
- When you're done with "edit mode," press ESC to get to the "save menu."
- This menu has three options: SAVE, CHANGE or ABORT. Select the desired
- option and press ENTER. ABORT cancels the changes you just made or the
- addition of a new area.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 46D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Keyboard macros 3.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 3.3 EDITOR: KEYBOARD MACROS
- ----------------------------
-
-
- The KEYBOARD MACROS option allows the operator to define "macros" that
- cause keys, ALT F1-F10 and CONTROL F1-F10, to substitute preprogrammed
- text while editing. This might be handy for "canned" introductions,
- signatures or whatever you can think of. Twenty keys may be defined and
- each key can have any amount of text desired. Note: This limit is RAM-
- based, so check the memory status in the BASIC CONFIGURATION screen if
- in question. The following allows you to define the KEYBOARD MACROS:
-
-
-
- /-KEYBOARD MACROS-------------------------------------------------------\
- | ALT-F1: Chris Irwin, 1:18/68 |
- | ALT-F2: Sincerely, |
- | ALT-F3: *FLAME ON* |
- | ALT-F4: *FLAME OFF* |
- | ALT-F5: |
- | ALT-F6: |
- | ALT-F7: |
- | ALT-F8: |
- /--CTL-F1:--------------------------------------------------------------\
- | Chris Irwin |
- | 15805 SW 103 Place |
- | Miami, FL 33157 |
- |\----------------------------------------------------------------------/
- | CTL-F5: |
- | CTL-F6: |
- | CTL-F7: |
- | CTL-F8: |
- | CTL-F10: |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- The above example shows the definition for the CONTROL-F1 key as being
- my mailing address. Each key is defined in its own window. All vertical
- pipe characters "|" are translated to hard-returns in the editor.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 47D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Translation table 3.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 3.4 EDITOR: TRANSLATION TABLE
- ------------------------------
-
-
- The TRANSLATION TABLE screen allows you to redefine how certain char-
- acters will be displayed. This may be used to allow line-drawing or
- foreign character sets to be used in DBEDIT. The ALT-keys (a-z) may
- be defined as displaying any character and transmitting it as a normal
- printable character in the range of 33-126.
-
- This is an advanced option and is not normally needed, so if you have
- no need for foreign character sets, skip this section.
-
-
- /-TRANSLATION TABLE-----------------------------------------------------\
- | Key Display as Transmit as Key Display as Transmit as |
- | ALT-A 131 a^ 125 } ALT-N |
- | ALT-B ALT-O |
- | ALT-C ALT-P |
- | ALT-D ALT-Q |
- | ALT-E ALT-R |
- | ALT-F ALT-S |
- | ALT-G ALT-T |
- | ALT-H ALT-U |
- | ALT-I ALT-V |
- | ALT-J ALT-W |
- | ALT-K ALT-X |
- | ALT-L ALT-Y |
- | ALT-M ALT-Z |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- In the above example, pressing ALT-A in the editor would display a
- circumflex "A" and transmit a right brace instead. This allows you to
- redefine part of the printable character set as translating to non-
- standard characters. Pressing the LEFT and RIGHT arrow keys scans
- through the characters, helping you to locate the proper ASCII code.
- Press ESC when you are finished with this screen.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 48D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Basic configuration 3.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 3.5 CONFIG: BASIC CONFIGURATION
- --------------------------------
-
-
- Selecting the "Basic configuration" option will display the following
- window:
-
-
- /-BASIC CONFIGURATION---------------------------------------------------\
- | Total memory: 320 (in K) Overlay buffer: 127568 |
- | WorkRAM: 45 (in K) Free WorkRAM: 12958 |
- |Exploding windows? Yes |
- | Screen output: Memory |
- | Log filename: C:\DB\DBRIDGE.LOG |
- | Log level: Terse |
- | Diagnostics? No |
- | Transfer speed: kpm |
- | Primary address: 1:18/68 |
- | Alias addresses: 1:1050/0 |
- | Automatic alias? Yes |
- | Offset from GMT: 5 |
- | System name: D'Bridge support |
- | Operator's name: Chris Irwin |
- | Audio alarm? Yes |
- | Alarm hours: 08:00 until 22:00 |
- | Call alarm: |
- | Special alarms: |
- | Config password: |
- | Keep history for: 7 (days |
- | Video timer: 1 (minutes) |
- |Blankout graphics? Yes |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
- TOTAL MEMORY
-
- This field controls how much memory (RAM) D'Bridge actually occupies.
- The "default" value is 300k, but this value may be changed at anytime
- so that more room is allowed for parameters or overlay. Increasing this
- number increases the size of the overlay buffer, making D'Bridge run
- faster.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 49D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Basic configuration 3.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- WORKRAM
-
- This field controls how much memory (RAM) D'Bridge may use for its
- parameters. This number defaults to 32K, but must be raised as you
- have more events, parameters and ECHOmail areas. The amount of free
- WorkRAM bytes is displayed in the upper-right corner of this screen.
- Make sure that there is at least 12000 bytes available at all times.
- If you must raise the WorkRAM setting, you probably raise the TOTAL
- MEMORY setting by the same amount; if you raise WorkRAM and leave the
- TOTAL MEMORY the same, then the overlay buffer will be smaller resulting
- in slower system performance.
-
-
-
- SCREEN OUTPUT
-
- D'Bridge gives you two options for display output: Memory and BIOS. If
- you're not sure what this means, then use the "Memory" option. The
- difference between the two options is that "Memory" causes D'Bridge to
- write directly to the memory of your display card and "BIOS" makes all
- output go through the standard MS-DOS "interrupt calls." Following are
- guidelines for selecting this option:
-
- MEMORY If you desire fast screen output and DO NOT use a multi-tasking
- program that REQUIRES BIOS, use this option.
-
- BIOS This is REQUIRED if you plan to use D'Bridge with a multi-tasker
- that requires BIOS. Check the manual of your multi-tasking
- program for details. DESQview does NOT require the BIOS option,
- but most other multi-taskers do.
-
- NO SNOW If you have an old-style CGA card where "snow" is a problem,
- use this option. It is just like MEMORY, but checks for the
- vertical retrace signal before writing to screen.
-
-
-
-
- LOG FILENAME
-
- D'Bridge normally keeps a "log" of all activity so that you may review
- its performance. Here, you specify the name of the file (including the
- directory if you wish) to which D'Bridge will write its log. The log
- contains the information displayed in the upper-left window and contains
- such data as incoming and outgoing calls, file-transfer statistics and
- event activation.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 50D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Basic configuration 3.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- LOG LEVEL
-
- D'Bridge allows three different options here: Verbose, Terse and None.
- It is highly recommended that you keep a log until you are totally
- familiar and comfortable with the way D'Bridge operates. Here's a brief
- description of the levels available:
-
- VERBOSE Writes ALL information displayed in the upper-left window to
- the specified log file.
-
- TERSE Writes only the important data, such as calls made and
- received and file-transfer information.
-
- NONE Creates NO log whatsoever.
-
-
-
- DIAGNOSTICS?
-
- Currently, the DIAGNOSTICS flag only affects whether the "Script file"
- debugging window is displayed. If you don't use "scripts" then it
- doesn't matter how you answer this question. If you select "Yes," then
- a debugging window that displays all "Script" commands and communication
- is displayed every time D'Bridge makes an outbound call with a script.
-
-
-
- TRANSFER SPEED
-
- D'Bridge has three methods that you may choose to measure the speed of
- a file-transfer: BPS (Bits/Second,) CPS (Characters/Second,) or KPM
- (Kilobytes/Minute.) By default, D'Bridge uses KPM, but you may change
- this unit if you wish; it has no effect on system performance.
-
-
-
- PRIMARY ADDRESS
-
- This specifies your primary system address. This (like all addresses)
- must be in the format ZONE:NET/NODE.POINT. If you are the member of
- an already-existing network, contact your network coordinator for an
- address assignment. If you're not sure, just pick arbitrary numbers
- for now and change them later.
-
- ZONE Continent code (1=North America, 2=Europe, 3=Australia, etc.)
- NET Usually represents a local calling area (1..32767)
- NODE Like a phone number within a NET (0..32767)
- POINT Usually 0 unless you are running a "point" system.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 51D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Basic configuration 3.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- ALIAS ADDRESSES
-
- It is possible (and common) for one system to exist with more than one
- Fidonet address. This field allows you to designate ANY number of
- alternate addresses and system names:
-
- <ADDRESS> <SYSTEM NAME>
-
-
-
- AUTOMATIC ALIAS?
-
- If you answer YES to the AUTOMATIC ALIAS question, D'Bridge will choose
- from your listed alias addresses based on ZONE when it makes or receives
- an EMAIL call. This automatic alias feature only works with other WaZOO-
- based mailers like D'Bridge. Your system will "YOOHOO" with the alias
- address and system name as specified in the ALIAS ADDRESSES field.
-
-
-
- OFFSET FROM GMT
-
- Here, you specify the offset (in hours) from Greenwich mean time. This
- actually changes twice a year here in the U.S. for daylight savings time,
- but it is not critical that you do this. It is used only by the ZMODEM
- file transfer routines to properly "stamp" the date and time of a file.
- The purpose is to automatically translate these "stamps" between time
- zones using Greenwich mean time as a standard. Correct specifications
- in the U.S. are as follows:
-
- Time zone Standard time Daylight savings time
- --------- ------------- ---------------------
- Eastern 5 4
- Central 6 5
- Mountain 7 6
- Pacific 8 7
-
-
-
-
- SYSTEM NAME
-
- When D'Bridge "talks" to another system, the SYSTEM NAME is displayed on
- the screen and entered into the log file. You may specify any name you
- wish for your system; typically, a company name and city is used in a
- corporate environment.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 52D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Basic configuration 3.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- OPERATOR'S NAME
-
- This field is not really used by D'Bridge, but the "WaZOO" mail standard
- requires an operator name as well as a system name. This will appear in
- the log files of some other mail systems, such as Opus and BinkleyTerm.
- This should be the name of the primary system operator.
-
-
-
-
- AUDIO ALARM?
-
- Many system operators want to know when an incoming call is received.
- By answering "YES" to AUDIO ALARM, D'Bridge will sound a brief alarm
- (a series of tones) when a call comes in. This allows the operator to
- see what is happening when mail is being received and alerts him to the
- fact that there may be new messages to read.
-
-
-
- ALARM HOURS
-
- For systems that are run in the home, you may want to restrict the times
- that the D'Bridge caller alarms are active so that you may get a good
- night's sleep. If desired, specify the hours (FROM and TO) that the
- alarms should be active; the times must be specified in 24-hour format.
- This field has no effect if the AUDIO ALARM is turned off.
-
-
-
- CALL ALARM
-
- D'Bridge has a built-in caller alarm, but if you don't like it and would
- like to program your own, specify the ANSI-MUSIC string here. For those
- of you who aren't familiar with ANSI-MUSIC notation, here's a brief
- description of the characters used and their meaning:
-
-
- A .. G The musical notes A thru G. A note may be followed
- by an accidental ('#' or '+' for sharp and '-' for
- flat.) Additionally, a note (With optional sharp or
- flat) may also be followed by a number denoting the
- note length (1 for a whole note thru 64 for a 64th
- note.) The note, with optional accidental and
- length, may also be followed by one or more dots
- ("."), each of which extends the note by one half
- of its existing value. For example, two dots produce
- a length of 9/4 the original value, and three dots
- a length of 27/8 the original value.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 53D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Basic configuration 3.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- Ln Specifies the default length of the notes following
- ("n" must be 1 for a whole note thru 64 for a 64th
- note.) The initial default value is 4 (quarter note.)
-
- Mz Specifies the fraction of the note length that the
- note is actually sounding. "z" is one of the letters
- "S", "N", or "L", which have these meanings:
-
- MS Music staccato (3/4 of note length)
- MN Music normal (7/8 of note length)
- ML Music legato (all of note length)
-
- On Specifies the octave in which the notes following
- are to be played (0 thru 7). The initial default
- octave is 3, which is the octave which begins at
- middle C.
-
- Pn Specifies that no sound is to be made for an
- interval. "n" (optional) is the note length (1
- for a whole note thru 64 for a 64th note.) If "n"
- is omitted, the current default note length is used.
- One or more dots may follow, each of which extends
- the rest by one half of its existing value.
-
- Tn Specifies the tempo in beats per minute (32 thru
- 255.) The initial default value is 120.
-
-
-
-
- SPECIAL ALARMS
-
- If you would like to be notified about specific systems calling using
- custom alarm sounds, you may program any number here using the same
- ANSI-MUSIC format described above. The SPECIAL ALARMS field is in
- the format: <ADDRESS> <MUSIC NOTATION>
-
- For example, the following special alarms are valid:
-
- 135/ALL T180L8O4GGGAAA
- 135/14 T180L4O4CDE
- ALL T200O3L8GGGL2D#.PL8FFFL2D.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 54D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Basic configuration 3.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- CONFIG PASSWORD
-
- In a corporate environment where there may be several people using the
- EMAIL system, it may be desirable to put a "lock" on the configuration
- menu to prevent accidental changes of the D'Bridge configuration. If
- a password is specified here, then it must be entered when any of the
- SETUP menu options are selected. It only needs to be entered once for
- each time D'Bridge is run.
-
-
-
- KEEP HISTORY FOR x (days)
-
- D'Bridge automatically maintains history files for INBOUND and OUTBOUND
- EMAIL calls as well as ECHOmail and AREAFIX requests. These files are
- automatically purged every night at midnight. This field defines how
- many days of history to keep before purging it. The default for this
- is 7, providing one week's history.
-
-
-
- VIDEO TIMER
-
- D'Bridge has a built-in "screen-saver" that will blank your video screen
- after a specified period of inactivity. The VIDEO TIMER parameter
- specifies the number of MINUTES of inactivity before the screen goes
- blank. If a call comes in, a scheduled event starts, or you press any
- key, the screen will re-display and the timer starts over. When the
- screen is blank, D'Bridge is still fully-functional - just waiting for
- something to happen! If you do not want the screen to ever go blank,
- enter a zero ("0") and the video timer will be disabled.
-
-
-
- BLANKOUT GRAPHICS?
-
- When the D'Bridge screen is blanked due to inactivity, you have the
- option to display "blankout graphics." If you answer YES to this
- question, there will be a bouncing pattern of dots that will tell you
- at a glance that D'Bridge is still running and you haven't had a system
- crash or something terrible like that. Most computers hate to be bored
- and do nothing all day; blankout graphics make your system happy by
- giving it something to do when nothing else is going on...
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 55D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Directory paths 3.6
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 3.6 CONFIG: DIRECTORY PATHS
- ----------------------------
-
-
- Selecting the "Directory paths" allows you to specify the various file
- and directory names used by D'Bridge. The following window is used:
-
-
- /-DIRECTORY PATHS-------------------------------------------------------\
- | Network mail storage: Fido (Fido/QuickBBS) |
- | Network mail path: C:\DB\MESSAGES\ |
- | Inbound files path: C:\DB\FILES\ |
- | Packet path: C:\DB\PACKETS\ |
- | Disk-based queue: C:\DB\QUEUE\ |
- | Script file path: C:\DB\SCRIPTS\ |
- | Download directory: C:\DB\FILES\ |
- | Bad ECHOmail path: C:\DB\BADECHO\ |
- | New ECHO area path: C:\DB\ |
- | SJF directory path: |
- | Quick directory path: C:\QUICKBBS\ |
- | "ABOUT" file name: C:\DB\ABOUT.US |
- | "FILES" file name: C:\DB\135-68.ARC |
- | Request paths: C:\IBM\ |
- | Specific requests: ML-UPD.ARC \MEGA\ML-UPD15.ARC |
- | Outbound history file: OUTBOUND.TXT |
- | Inbound history file: INBOUND.TXT |
- | ECHOmail history file: ECHOMAIL.TXT |
- | AREAFIX history file: AREAFIX.TXT.TXT |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
- NETWORK MAIL STORAGE
-
- D'Bridge gives you the option of two storage methods for the NETMAIL
- area: Fido or QuickBBS. Choose the storage method that you would like
- to use for D'Bridge NETMAIL; the default is Fido.
-
-
- NETWORK MAIL PATH (Fido storage only)
-
- This parameter specifies the name of the directory where the actual
- EMAIL messages are stored for the NETmail area.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 56D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Directory paths 3.6
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- QUICKBBS AREA NUMBER (QuickBBS NETmail storage only)
-
- Specify the area number that you would like to use for NETMAIL within
- QuickBBS. If you are using the QuickBBS package, you should know what
- this means.
-
-
-
- INBOUND FILES PATH
-
- Since D'Bridge is capable of receiving files as well as messages, it
- needs to know what directory to put them in when they arrive. This
- is where you specify the directory path.
-
-
-
- PACKET PATH
-
- D'Bridge needs a work directory to create "packets" of outbound mail.
- This is where you specify what directory to use. MAKE SURE that you
- don't "share" this directory with other programs because D'Bridge will
- delete ALL files in it when it starts up.
-
-
-
- DISK-BASED QUEUE
-
- D'Bridge needs a work directory to store XMAIL and queued file-transfer
- requests. Make sure that this is NOT on a RAMDISK since the information
- that D'Bridge puts there is presumed to stay there until further notice.
- Make sure that there is plenty of disk-space available on the disk where
- the QUEUE directory is located.
-
-
-
- SCRIPT FILE PATH
-
- If you don't know what a script file is, then it doesn't matter what
- you put for this parameter. This specifies what directory D'Bridge
- will look for "dialing scripts." For more information about script
- files, see the section entitled "Using dialing scripts."
-
-
-
- DOWNLOAD DIRECTORY
-
- This is the default directory for downloads while in TERMINAL MODE.
- All ZMODEM auto-downloads will be stored in this directory.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 57D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Directory paths 3.6
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- BAD ECHOMAIL PATH
-
- This designates the Fido-style message directory where bad or duplicate
- messages are stored. Messages that arrive from other systems that aren't
- able to be tossed into a valid ECHOmail area will be posted here.
-
-
- NEW ECHO AREA PATH
-
- Specify the "root" directory where new Fido-style message bases should
- be created when the "Auto-add ECHO areas" option is used. (See section
- 3.12 for more complete information.)
-
-
- SJF DIRECTORY PATH (reserved for version 1.40 - unused now)
-
-
- "ABOUT" FILE NAME (optional)
-
- The ABOUT file is used mainly with the "Public Amateur Network (Fidonet)"
- to contain general information about your system. The "ABOUT" file name
- should specify the name of a text file to be transmitted when a file-
- request for "ABORT" is received. (For more information, see the section
- entitled "File-requests.")
-
-
- "FILES" FILE NAME (optional)
-
- The FILES file is also used primarily with the "Public Amateur Network"
- and contains a list of all "requestable" files on your system. The FILES
- file name should point to a this text file (or ARChive.) Again, see the
- section called "File-requests" for more information.)
-
-
- REQUEST PATHS
-
- D'Bridge has a feature that allows other systems to call in and request
- files from your system. If you wish to allow this option, you must
- specify what directories will be available for request. You may also
- specify a password that must accompany a request, but if you use no
- password, any system will have access to all directories listed here.
- The format for the request paths is:
-
- <directory_name> <password>
-
- Where password is an optional parameter. Any number of directories may
- be specified in the REQUEST PATHS WINDOW. Make sure that you use pass-
- words on any directories that contain sensitive or confidential infor-
- mation.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 58D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Directory paths 3.6
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- SPECIFIC REQUESTS
-
- This window allows you to specify any number of "magic filenames" that
- may be requested from your system. An example of this might be where
- you distribute a newsletter and the filename changes every month. You
- might have a line like:
-
- NEWS \NEWSLTR\PC-NEWS.021
-
- The above line means that when a file-request arrives for "NEWS" - the
- file \newslts\pc-news.021 will be transmitted instead of searching the
- directories specified in REQUEST PATHS. The format for this window is:
-
- <magicname> <actualfilename> <password>
-
- Once again, password is optional, but should be specified if any of this
- information is not public.
-
-
- OUTBOUND HISTORY FILE
-
- The OUTBOUND HISTORY FILE parameter specifies a text file to write an
- outbound EMAIL history log. Every outbound connection is logged to
- a the specified text file listing the date/time, address, data sent and
- received, elapsed time and total cost. If you do not want such a log,
- leave this field blank.
-
-
- INBOUND HISTORY FILE
-
- The INBOUND HISTORY FILE parameter specifies the text file to use for
- the inbound EMAIL history log. Every inbound EMAIL connection is logged
- here with the same information as above, except cost. (There is never
- a cost associated with inbound mail traffic.)
-
-
- ECHOMAIL HISTORY FILE
-
- The ECHOMAIL HISTORY FILE specifies what text file to use for the
- inbound ECHOmail history. This log lists Date/time, address, area name,
- messages and duplicates received.
-
-
- AREAFIX HISTORY FILE
-
- The AREAFIX HISTORY FILE specifies what text file to use an AREAFIX
- history log. This includes information about conferences added and
- removed either by remote AREAFIX request or New ECHOmail link, ALT-N.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 59D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Install new modem 3.7
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 3.7 CONFIG: INSTALL NEW MODEM
- ------------------------------
-
-
- Selecting the "Install new modem" options allows you to pre-program
- D'Bridge for a different modem brand/model. A screen similar to the
- following will be displayed:
-
-
- D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-LOG------/-INSTALL NEW MODEM------------------\VITY-------------------------\
- | |U.S. Robotics Courier 2400 | |
- | |U.S. Robotics Courier HST | |
- | |U.S. Robotics Courier 14400 HST Dual|riday, December 15, 1989 |
- | |Telebit TrailBlazer "Non-Plus" | |
- |11:51 D'B|Telebit TrailBlazer "Plus" | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 Sca|Telebit Trailblazer "T2500" | |
- |11:51 0 m|MultiTech MultiModem V.32 "932EH" | |
- |11:51 No |MultiTech MultiModem 2400 MNP5 "224E| 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 Wai|"Generic" 1200-baud modem | |
- |-QUEUE----|"Generic" 2400-baud modem |-----------------------------|
- | |"Generic" 9600-baud modem | |
- | | | |
- | | | |
- | | | |
- | \------------------------------------/ the queue -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- Select modem type using the arrow keys; press ENTER to select, ESC to cancel
-
-
-
- Select your modem brand and model from the list using the UP and DOWN
- arrow keys. Press the enter key to confirm your selection or the ESC
- key to cancel. If your modem is not in the list, select one of the
- "generic" settings at the bottom of the screen.
-
- We would like to greatly expand our list of pre-configured modems, but
- need your help. Please contact D'Bridge technical support if you have
- successfully installed a modem that we don't have in our list; it would
- greatly benefit our future customers!
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 60D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Comm/Modem Setup 3.8
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 3.8 CONFIG: COMM/MODEM SETUP
- -----------------------------
-
-
- Selecting the "Comm/modem setup" options allows you to specify the param-
- eters that control the communications port and modem. The following
- window is used:
-
-
- /-COMMUNICATION/MODEM SETUP---------------------------------------------\
- | Modem port: COM1 (COM1-COM7 or NONE) |
- | Baud rate: 2400 |
- | Locked? No |
- | Use RTS-CTS? No |
- | Initialize: ATM0X4Q0V1H0S0=0 |
- | Offline: |
- | Drop DTR? Yes |
- | Answer: ATA |
- | Dial 300: ATDT |
- | " 1200: ATDT |
- | " 2400: ATDT |
- | " 4800: ATDT |
- | " 9600: ATDT |
- | " 19200: ATDT |
- | Specific dial: |
- | "RING" commands: |
- | "CONNECT" commands: |
- | "ABORT" commands: |
- | Char delay: 50 (milliseconds) |
- | Modem timeout: 45 (seconds) |
- | Carrier detect mask: 128 |
- | Auto-init modem? Yes |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
-
- MODEM PORT
-
- Here, you must specify which "port" your modem is using. If you're not
- which port your modem is configured for, try COM1 or COM2; this will work
- for most installations. IT IS IMPORTANT THAT THE MODEM, CABLE AND COMM
- PORT BE ABLE TO SEND AND RECEIVE THE "DTR" AND "CD" SIGNALS. D'BRIDGE
- WILL NOT FUNCTION WITHOUT THESE SIGNALS.
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 61D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Comm/Modem Setup 3.8
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- BAUD RATE
-
- Specify the MAXIMUM baud rate which your modem supports. Specify either
- 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200 or 38400 baud. Your modem will be
- initialized at this speed.
-
-
-
- LOCKED?
-
- Usually "NO," but if desired, the communications rate may be locked at
- the highest allowed BAUD RATE. You MUST specify the corresponding modem
- command in the INITIALIZATION field. This option is usually only used
- for "high-speed" modems. Refer to your modem manual for specific
- information about the INITIALIZATION commands required.
-
-
-
- USE RTS-CTS?
-
- Again, this parameter is usually "NO," but with "high-speed" modems it
- may be desirable to answer "YES" if your modem supports hardware
- "handshaking." RTS-CTS means "Request-to-send, Clear-to-send;" these
- signals are passed between the computer to the modem to control the flow
- of the communications. For example, when I use my 9600 baud modem
- "locked at 19200," I must use the RTS-CTS handshaking, or communications
- buffers will constantly overflow. Anytime, the computer is sending more
- than the modem can buffer (or visa-versa,) CTS-RTS is required.
-
-
-
- INITIALIZE
-
- In this window, you may specify any number of initialization strings.
- For HAYES<tm>-compatible modems, each line should start with "AT" and
- should cause the modem to respond with an "OK" status. The default
- initialization (which should work for most modems) is:
-
- ATM0X1Q0V1H0S0=1
-
- This should be adequate for basic initialization. You may customize this
- string to include any settings you wish, but make sure:
-
- - The modem will not answer the phone (S0=0)
- - Verbose response codes are enabled (Q0V1)
- - The phone is placed "on-hook" (H0)
-
- IMPORTANT: Because some modems have software-control over the "CARRIER
- DETECT (CD)" and "DATA TERMINAL READY (DTR)," it may be
- necessary to include: "&C1&D1" in your initialization string.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 62D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Comm/Modem Setup 3.8
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- OFFLINE
-
- In this window, you may specify the command(s) to send to the modem to
- take it offline. If you want the telephone to ring while D'Bridge is
- offline, then no string is necessary here; DTR will drop, disabling the
- modem. However, if you desire the phone line to be busy (off-hook) when
- D'Bridge is offline, use a command like "ATH1" here. (Just make sure
- that your initialization string has an "H0" in it.)
-
-
-
- DROP DTR
-
- This is only an option if you specify an OFFLINE command string. Most
- modems, dropping DTR is a good idea, but some go back on-hook after DTR
- is dropped. If you're not sure, say "YES," drop DTR. If you find that
- your modem is going onhook, then immediately offhook, try "NO" in this
- parameter.
-
-
-
- DIAL 300 - DIAL 19200
-
- Specify the command to dial the phone when calling at various baud-
- rates. This is almost always "ATDT" unless your modem has special
- initialization required at certain baud rates. See your modem manual
- for details.
-
-
-
- SPECIFIC DIAL
-
- It may be necessary to override the dial string for a certain system;
- if you need to do this, specify: <ADDRESS> <DIAL STRING>
-
-
-
- "RING" COMMANDS
-
- Some newer modems have added other responses to mean "RING." This window
- allows you to define any number of modem responses that mean that an
- incoming RING signal is being received or a RING signal was detected
- while making a call. For most modems, this window may be empty.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 63D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Comm/Modem Setup 3.8
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- "CONNECT" COMMANDS
-
- Some newer modems have added other responses than just "CONNECT 1200" or
- "CONNECT 9600/ARQ;" D'Bridge recognizes all these. Newer modems may have
- response codes like "CONNECT FAST" meaning CONNECT 19200, etc. This
- window allows you to define those new codes and the baud rates that they
- represent. For the "CONNECT FAST" example, the following line would be
- entered in the window: 19200 CONNECT FAST
-
- The first parameter is the baud rate and then the actual response. This
- will basically translate a "CONNECT FAST" to a "CONNECT 19200" response.
- Again, with most modems, this window may be empty.
-
-
-
- "ABORT" COMMANDS
-
- Here, you can define the modem responses that will abort a call. Most
- responses, like "BUSY, NO CARRIER and NO DIAL TONE" are pre-programmed,
- but for newer modems, you might want to specify some others. For most
- installations, this window may be empty.
-
-
-
- CHAR DELAY
-
- Many HAYES<tm>-compatible modems cannot accept command strings at full-
- speed. Because of this, D'Bridge can include an inter-character delay
- for commands. In this field, specify the number of MILLISECONDS that you
- would like to delay between each character. The default value is 50, but
- most modems perform fine with 25 or less.
-
-
-
- MODEM TIMEOUT
-
- When D'Bridge is making a outbound call, your modem usually reports a
- BUSY or NO CARRIER response if no connection is made. Sometimes the
- modem gets confused or there is a communication error and these response
- codes don't get back to D'Bridge. Because of this, an overriding MODEM
- TIMEOUT is used. Here, you specify the maximum number of seconds to
- wait for a response code from the modem. Normally, this should be about
- 15 seconds longer than your modem's S7 value. (The S7 register is HAYES
- modems contains the number of seconds to wait for a connect.) If you
- do any international calling, you should set MODEM TIMEOUT to at least
- a minute, maybe more.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 64D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Comm/Modem Setup 3.8
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- CARRIER DETECT MASK
-
- For almost all IBM PCs, this value must be 128, but you have the option
- to change it here if you're running a non-standard serial interface.
- D'Bridge will not function properly if this value is not correct. If
- you're not sure, leave it as 128.
-
-
-
- AUTO-INIT MODEM?
-
- If you answer YES, D'Bridge will automatically initialize your modem
- every 10 minutes while idle. This can be handy for detecting problems
- with your modem or resetting after a brown-out has your modem "flipped-
- out."
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 65D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: FAX configuration 3.9
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 3.9 CONFIG: FAX CONFIGURATION
- ------------------------------
-
-
- Selecting the "FAX configuration" options allows you to specify the
- setup for your FAX card, if you have one installed.
-
-
- /-FAX CONFIGURATION-----------------------------------------------------\
- | FAX board installed? Yes |
- | FAX board type: JT-FAX/4800 |
- | FAX root directory: C:\FAX\ |
- | FAX ID: D'Bridge FAX |
- | Default font: Normal (Normal/Compressed) |
- | Default resolution: High (Normal/High) |
- | Touch-tone dialing? Yes |
- | Receive allowed? Yes |
- | Rings to answer: 2 |
- | Print automatically? Yes |
- | Answer when offline? Yes |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
- FAX BOARD INSTALLED?
-
- Answer YES if you have a compatible FAX-card installed in your computer.
- Currently only the JT-FAX by QuadRAM is supported; more cards will be
- added in the coming months as hardware becomes available.
-
-
-
- FAX BOARD TYPE
-
- Pressing F1 will cycle through the supported boards. Each FAX board
- is slightly different and is controlled in a different way. Make sure
- that you have the correct board selected.
-
-
-
- FAX ROOT DIRECTORY
-
- Specify the directory where the manufacturer's FAX software is resident.
- This directory contains the control and log files needed for D'Bridge to
- interface with the FAX software.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 66D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: FAX configuration 3.9
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- FAX ID
-
- Each FAX system has a 21 character ID associated with it. Select what
- ID you wish to use for your D'Bridge/FAX site. Some people list their
- dedicated FAX number in this field. This ID appears on the top line of
- each page transmitted.
-
-
-
- DEFAULT FONT
-
- Either normal (10 cpi) or compressed (16 cpi) fonts may be used when
- sending FAX messages. Normally, 10 cpi is used as is it more readable.
-
-
-
- DEFAULT RESOLUTION
-
- Most FAX cards offer both Normal- and High-resolution modes for text
- transmission. Specify the default here.
-
-
-
- TOUCH-TONE DIALING
-
- If your phone line supports touch-tone dialing, answer YES here.
-
-
-
- RECEIVE ALLOWED?
-
- If you are running the FAX on a dedicated line and wish the FAX card
- to answer incoming calls, answer YES here. You may also schedule a
- shared line between answering FAX and EMAIL calls; see CONFIG: SCHEDULE
- MAINTENANCE for more information.
-
-
-
- RINGS TO ANSWER
-
- If receive is enabled, how many rings should D'Bridge wait before
- answering a FAX call.
-
-
-
- PRINT AUTOMATICALLY
-
- If you have a compatible printer, received FAX messages may be printed
- automatically when received. If you answer YES here, make sure that
- your printer is always online with plenty of paper.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 67D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: FAX configuration 3.9
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- ANSWER WHEN OFFLINE
-
- Most supported FAX cards will answer FAX calls even when D'Bridge is
- offline. If you want FAX calls answered when D'Bridge is not running,
- answer YES here.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 68D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 3.10 CONFIG: SCHEDULE MAINTENANCE
- ----------------------------------
-
-
- Selecting the "Schedule Maintenance" option allows you to define the
- operating schedule that D'Bridge will follow. The "SCHEDULE" maintains
- a list of "EVENTS." Before going any further, let me define a few terms
- used here:
-
-
- SCHEDULE A weekly list of "things to do" that can be programmed by the
- operator is called the "schedule." It contains a list of
- EVENTS that will be executed a a programmed day/time. The
- schedule is used for MAIL EVENTS, DOS EVENTS and EXIT EVENTS.
-
- EVENT An "event" is a single entry in the schedule. Each event is
- assigned a TAG which may be up to 8 letters; this TAG serves
- only as an identifier. Up to 64 separate events may be
- programmed in D'Bridge.
-
- MAIL EVENT A "mail event" is a time-period where D'Bridge is permitted
- to send EMAIL. Depending on the ROUTING information, mail
- may or may not be sent during this time period. If no
- special ROUTING is used, all mail will be transmitted.
- D'Bridge will also answer incoming calls at this time,
- in-between the outbound calls.
-
- DOS EVENT A "DOS event" is one where a list of DOS commands are
- executed. To use this method, enough memory must be avail-
- able to "spawn" the specified commands.
-
- EXIT EVENT An "exit event" causes D'Bridge to terminate with a specified
- errorlevel.
-
-
-
- In this section, I'll demonstrate how a typical system, using the Fidonet
- amateur public network would use the schedule. In Fidonet, all systems
- in North America normally specify a one-hour "National mail window" when
- mail is normally sent and received; this happens every morning at 4:00 AM
- Eastern Standard Time.
-
-
- In this example, I am assuming that I live in Miami and it's summer, so
- daylight savings time is in effect. Following is the schedule that I
- wish to establish:
-
-
- 5:00-6:00 EDT Fidonet "National mail hour" (Send all mail)
- 6:00-6:30 EDT Local mail window (Send only local mail)
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 69D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- Schedule: ADD UN-EVENT DUPLICATE CHANGE REMOVE D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | 0..1..2..3..4..5..6..7..8..9.10.11.12.13.14.15.16.17.18.19.20.21.22.23 |
- | Sun ...............XXXXXX................................................. |
- | Mon ...............XXXXXX................................................. |
- | Tue ...............XXXXXX................................................. |
- | Wed ...............XXXXXX................................................. |
- | Thu ...............XXXXXX................................................. |
- | Fri ...............XXXXXX................................................. |
- | Sat ...............XXXXXX................................................. |
- | |
- | # Start End S M T W T F S Tag Type Status |
- | - ----- --- ------------- --- ---- ------ |
- | 1 05:00 06:00 S M T W T F S NMH Mail Done |
- | 2 06:00 06:30 S M T W T F S LOCAL Mail Done |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- Above, is what the schedule maintenance screen would look like with the
- two events described. Events are maintained by using the commands: ADD,
- UN-EVENT, DUPLICATE, CHANGE or REMOVE. Each of these commands in
- described in detail. Remember that the ESC key is always the "way out"
- when you're in the event maintenance subsystem. Look on the bottom line
- of the screen for information about each "field."
-
-
- ADD - Add a new event
- ---------------------
-
- D'Bridge may have up to 64 pre-programmed events; the ADD option is used
- to insert new entries into the schedule. Select this option by moving
- the highlight to "ADD" and pressing ENTER. The following window should
- be displayed:
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | Event "tag": NMH |
- | Enabled?: Yes |
- | Type: Mail |
- | Weekday(s): All[X] Sun[X] Mon[X] Tue[X] Wed[X] Thu[X] Fri[X] Sat[X] |
- | Start time: 04:00 |
- | End time: 05:00 |
- |Between calls: 30 to 60 (seconds) |
- | Max trys: 30 |
- | Max sessions: 3 |
- | Max failures: 3 |
- | Event alias: |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 70D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the event.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
-
-
- EVENT "TAG"
-
- The "TAG" is an arbitrary 8-letter name by which you identify the event.
- In the above example, I've used "NMH" to stand for "National Mail Hour."
- This "TAG" must be unique; it is used on the screen and in the log to
- identify events.
-
-
-
- ENABLED?
-
- This Yes/No question simply specifies whether this event should be
- currently enabled or not. Normally, you would answer YES but if you
- ever want to temporarily disable the event, you may change it to no.
- This option is provided so that you can disable events without actually
- removing them.
-
-
-
- TYPE
-
- There are four types of events; each functions differently:
-
- Mail A "mail" event defines a period of time when certain mail
- may be sent. The default is to send ALL mail, unless you
- specify ADVANCED ROUTING.
-
- DOS A "DOS" event defines a list of DOS commands, programs and
- batch files to execute at a pre-defined time. These tasks
- are all "spawned" while D'Bridge remains in memory. This
- will only work if you have enough memory.
-
- Exit An "exit" event specifies that you want D'Bridge to terminate
- at the specified time. This would normally be used in a
- batch file to transfer control to another program - instead
- of "spawning" it as above. With EXIT, you specify what DOS
- errorlevel you want to use.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 71D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- WEEKDAY(S)
-
- With the WEEKDAYS field, you put an "X" next to all days that you wish
- to run this event. If you specify "ALL," then all the days of the week
- are marked. To access individual days, erase the "X" next to "ALL" by
- pressing the SPACE BAR.
-
-
-
- START TIME
-
- Specify the time that you wish to activate the event. This time should
- be specified in 24-hour format and must not conflict with any other
- scheduled event. To specify a START TIME, just enter a time using 3 or
- 4 digits. For example:
-
- 300 is 3:00 AM; 2250 is 10:50 PM
-
-
-
- CRITICAL? (DOS and exit events only)
-
- For DOS and EXIT EVENTS, you should specify "YES" if you want the event
- to execute even if D'Bridge is not running at the time of the event. A
- CRITICAL event is one that D'Bridge will execute even after the START
- TIME specified; it is only executed once. Specify "NO" if you want the
- event to occur ONLY if D'Bridge is running at that time.
-
-
-
- DOS COMMANDS (DOS events only)
-
- For DOS events, you may specify any number of DOS commands, programs
- or batch files to execute. It is even possible to used DOS primitives
- like CD (Change directory) and COPY. It is up you to make sure that
- none of the commands specified require human interaction. For example,
- if you specify the command to start your word processor, odds are that
- the word processor will continue running until someone comes along...
-
-
-
- ERROR LEVEL (exit events only)
-
- For EXIT EVENTS, you simply specify the DOS ERRORLEVEL to return when
- terminating. This number would normally be used by an "IF ERRORLEVEL"
- directive in a batch file.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 72D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- END TIME (mail events only)
-
- Specify the time that you wish the MAIL EVENT to terminate. Remember
- that you can't conflict with any other scheduled event. Again, the
- time is specified in 24-hour format as above.
-
-
- BETWEEN CALLS
-
- Here, you specify the period of time to wait between outbound calls.
- This is entered as a "range." If you say "30 to 60," then D'Bridge
- will wait a random amount of time between 30 and 60 seconds between
- calls. This period of time is used to receive incoming mail; if this
- event is supposed to send mail only, you may specify a very short time
- period.
-
-
- MAX TRYS
-
- The MAX TRYS parameter indicates the maximum number of times D'Bridge
- should attempt to dial a specific system during the current MAIL EVENT.
-
-
- MAX SESSIONS
-
- The MAX SESSIONS parameter specifies the maximum number of actual
- connects that are allowed during the given mail event. This is handy
- for limiting ECHOmail turnaround for long-distance systems.
-
-
- MAX FAILURES
-
- The MAX FAILURES parameter specifies the maximum number of aborted or
- bad sessions are allowed with each system during the specified mail
- event. This parameter can help control costs when the answering system
- has crashed or is not functioning properly.
-
-
- EVENT ALIAS
-
- If you want your system to "act" as if its using a different primary
- address during an event, specify that ALIAS here. Always list the
- full address in the format ZONE:NET/NODE.POINT in the alias field.
- After the event is complete, your system will return to its primary
- address as specified in the BASIC CONFIGURATION screen.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 73D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- /-ADVANCED ROUTING for event#1 (NMH)--------------------------------\
- | Accept EMAIL calls? Yes Dynamic event? No |
- | Accept FAX calls? No Process requests? Yes |
- | Host-route privates? No Accept human calls? No |
- | CM/Non-CM systems only? Both Maximum cost/msg: |
- | Scan ECHOmail areas? Yes Priorities allowed: NCI |
- | Packets for: ALL |
- | Hold for: NONE |
- | Poll: NONE |
- | Pickup mail from: ALL |
- | Allow pickup from: ALL |
- | Route to: HOSTS EXCEPT OURNET |
- | Route files for: NONE |
- | Forward mail for: ALL |
- | Forward mail to: OURNET |
- | Forward files for: NONE |
- | Forward files to: NONE |
- | FAX to: ALL |
- | Intl FAX-forward for: NONE |
- | Local FAX-forward for: ALL |
- \-------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- The advanced routing screen defines exactly who to send mail for,
- who to poll and how mail is to be routed. This information is
- defined in a simple "routing" language. Following is a description
- of the syntax used:
-
-
- <ADDRESS> An <ADDRESS> is any specific Fidonet address in the format:
-
- ZONE:NET.NODE.POINT
-
- Assuming that my address is: ZONE 1, NET 135, NODE 68,
- I can use the following address formats to describe a
- specific system:
-
- 1:135/68.2 My address
- 135/68.2 My address again, ZONE assumed
- 68.2 My address, ZONE:NET assumed
- .2 My address, ZONE:NET/NODE assumed
- 25 Specifies 1:135/25
- 107/27 Specifies 1:107/27
- MYBOSS Specifies 1:135/68
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 74D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- <FILTER> A <FILTER> defines a list of allowable Fidonet addresses
- allowed for a particular function. A filter is defined
- in its own window and uses the following general format:
-
- <ADDRESS> ... <ADDRESS> EXCEPT <ADDRESS> ... <ADDRESS>
-
- A FILTER may consist of any number of lines. Each line
- is "ORed" with the other ones meaning that if any of the
- individual filter lines is "true," the entire filter is
- true. If you're confused, think of a FILTER as a list
- of possible values and a specific ADDRESS is either IN
- the list or NOT IN the list. Here's some examples of
- valid filter lines:
-
-
- 135/ALL 107/ALL 109/23
- 135/ALL 107/ALL EXCEPT 135/20 135/30
-
-
- If the above two lines were to be used together in one
- filter, the EXCEPT would mean nothing because the first
- line has included all of NET 135 anyway. A filter may
- also contain (almost) any combination of the following
- keywords:
-
- ALL By itself means ALL addresses
- .ALL All points for my ZONE:NET/NODE
- 135/ALL All addresses in NET 135, my ZONE
- 2:ALL/ALL All addresses in ZONE 2
- 3:952/22.ALL All points under 3:952/22
- NONE Specifies no addresses
- OURNET Means ALL.ALL (all addresses in your NET)
- OTHERS Means ALL EXCEPT OURNET
- HOSTS Means ALL:ALL/0 (All NET hosts)
- HUBS Means all HUBS (See NODELIST section)
- OGATE Means OUTBOUND GATEWAY (See section 3.7)
- MYBOSS For a point system, means .0 (Point boss)
- MYHUB Refers to the node specified as your HUB
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 75D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- For specific examples of how the routing language is used to setup a
- private network, see section 6. Following is a detailed description
- of each field on the ADVANCED ROUTING screen:
-
-
-
- ACCEPT EMAIL CALLS?
-
- If you want D'Bridge to answer incoming calls during this event, answer
- YES here. In most cases, you would want to accept calls except during
- events where only outbound traffic is desired or during a time where the
- line is being used to receive FAX calls.
-
-
-
- ACCEPT FAX CALLS?
-
- If you want the FAX software to answer incoming calls during this event,
- then specify YES here. If you are sharing a line between EMAIL and FAX,
- do not answer YES to both ACCEPT EMAIL and ACCEPT FAX. You should just
- use one or the other.
-
-
-
- HOST-ROUTE PRIVATES?
-
- It is possible that some of the systems in your nodelist will be marked
- as "private" and not include a phone number. In this case, there are
- two options if you wish to send mail to a private or unlisted system:
- You can either hold the mail and wait for them to call in to pick it up
- or you can send the mail to their HOST or HUB. Specify YES here if you
- wish to send all mail for unlisted/private systems to the NET host or
- answer NO if you want to put the mail on hold for pickup.
-
-
-
- CM/NON-CM SYSTEMS ONLY?
-
- In this case, CM stands for "continuous mail" as designated in the node-
- list flags. (See SECTION 6.1 for specific discussion of the flags.)
- This parameter controls whether your system will call "CM" systems,
- Non-CM systems or both during this mail event. (CM systems are the
- ones designated as being able to receive EMAIL 24-hours per day.)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 76D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- SCAN ECHOMAIL AREAS?
-
- If you have set up ECHOmail and would like D'Bridge to scan your message
- base for outbound ECHOmail traffic originating from your system, answer
- YES here. If you scan ECHOmail after each BBS call and after leaving
- the editor, there is no reason to do it at the start of an event. If
- you answer YES, all areas will be scanned and mail will be forwarded when
- the event starts.
-
-
- DYNAMIC EVENT?
-
- A DYNAMIC EVENT is one that terminates when there is no more outbound
- mail to be sent. Most MAIL EVENTS are not dynamic, but some operators
- of BBS systems want to allow "human" callers as soon as the mail is
- sent. If you specify "YES" for DYNAMIC EVENT, the event will terminate
- as soon as there is no more outbound activity; you may still receive
- mail, even though the event is over. If you want the event to continue
- until the END TIME specified, say "NO" to this question.
-
-
- PROCESS REQUESTS?
-
- If you run a public access system, BBS, you might want to disallow
- file-requests during your mail events. If you wish to honor file-
- -requests during this mail event, specify "YES" here. If you would
- rather not accept file-requests this event, answer "NO."
-
-
- ACCEPT HUMAN CALLS?
-
- If you run a BBS, you must decide if you wish to allow "human" callers
- during this mail event. Remember, if you do, they may tie-up your
- system until after the mail event is over! For Fidonet's National Mail
- Hour, it is traditional NOT to allow BBS calls so that the line would
- be free for "mail" calls. To ALLOW human callers, specify "YES" here;
- if you don't want BBS calls to interrupt this event, say "NO."
-
-
- MAXIMUM COST/MSG
-
- If you want to restrict outbound calls based on cost, you may specify
- a maximum cost per message allowed. If you specify 0 (zero,) then no
- EMAIL with any cost will be sent. If you leave this field blank, then
- there will be no cost restriction. PLEASE NOTE THE DIFFERENCE BETWEEN
- BLANK AND ZERO!
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 77D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- PRIORITIES ALLOWED
-
- This parameter may contain any or all of the letters (NCI) meaning
- NORMAL, CRASH and IMMEDIATE. This acts as a filter that allows D'Bridge
- to only send mail of the desired priority during the given event (or
- UN-EVENT.) For most systems, all events should contain all three
- letters, NCI in this field. This would allow the cost/accounting sub-
- system to control "when" D'Bridge may call "where."
-
-
- PACKETS FOR (default "ALL")
-
- Here's where we get into the filters and addresses! For PACKETS FOR, you
- specify a <FILTER> as defined previously in this section. This will
- determine for which systems you want to create packets. NOTE: This does
- not necessarily mean that D'Bridge will call the system, the packet might
- be on "HOLD" or "ROUTED" to a different system. An example follows:
-
- PACKETS FOR: ALL
-
- Except in strange cases, there is never any reason to specify anything
- other than "ALL" for this filter.
-
-
- HOLD FOR (default "NONE")
-
- If you DO NOT wish to send mail to certain systems, but wish to "HOLD"
- the mail, waiting for them to pick it up, specify a HOLD FOR <FILTER>.
- Normally, you would say "NONE," meaning that you wish to send all mail
- packets that are created. Examples:
-
- HOLD FOR: NONE
- HOLD FOR: OTHERS .ALL
- HOLD FOR: 2:500/27 202/202 105/3 135/27
- HOLD FOR: ALL
-
-
- POLL (default "NONE")
-
- If you wish to force D'Bridge to call certain systems, regardless of
- whether you have mail to send or not, use this option. Normally, POLL
- would be used in a situation where you have pre-arranged to pickup your
- mail from a certain system by "polling" them at a specified time. If
- you enter three addresses in POLL, each time this event is started,
- D'Bridge will generate an empty packet for them, forcing a call. Note:
- you may not use "ALL" here, you must specify a list of valid addresses
- to POLL. Examples:
-
- POLL: 2 4 5 8 10 24 30 35
- POLL: 2:500/27 107/27
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 78D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- PICKUP MAIL FROM (default "ALL")
-
- For some events, you might want to refuse "pickup mail" when you call
- certain systems. Normally, it is desirable to pickup your mail when
- you call each system - it saves a phone call. Certain applications
- warrant restricting the "pickup" features. Here, you enter a <FILTER>
- specifying from which systems you DO wish to pickup mail. Examples:
-
- PICKUP MAIL FROM: ALL
- PICKUP MAIL FROM: NONE
- PICKUP MAIL FROM: OURNET 107/27 2:500/27
-
-
-
-
-
- ALLOW PICKUP FROM (default "ALL")
-
- Normally, it is desirable to allow systems that are calling in with
- mail to pickup any outbound mail addressed to them. If you do not
- wish to allow this, perhaps for security reasons, then specify a
- <FILTER> that defines which systems ARE allowed to pickup mail when
- they call. Examples follow:
-
- ALLOW PICKUP FROM: ALL
- ALLOW PICKUP FROM: OTHERS EXCEPT 107/27 202/202
- ALLOW PICKUP FROM: NONE
-
-
-
-
-
- ROUTE TO (default "HOSTS EXCEPT OURNET")
-
- Routing - this is where is starts to get complicated. This is the
- parameter that controls how a message is "routed." In a private network
- with just one "NET" number, there is generally no routing; messages go
- directly from the sender to the receiver. However, it might be desirable
- to route all message traffic through the central HOST to cut phone costs.
- There is a great deal that you can do with routing and the best way is
- to simply describe a few scenarios:
-
- ROUTE TO: HOSTS EXCEPT OURNET
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 79D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- The previous example demonstrates the format for "standard" routing.
- In this case, all messages being sent to addresses in our NET number
- will go direct; everything being sent to addresses outside our NET
- number will be sent to that NET's HOST (which will then be forwarded
- to its destination.) If the destination address has a HUB, it will
- instead be sent to the HUB. Using this routing method, several
- messages sent to different addresses in the same net will be transmitted
- with just one long-distance phone call.
-
-
- ROUTE TO: MYBOSS FOR ALL
-
- The above example demonstrates the normal routing for a "point" system.
- All outbound mail would be routed through your BOSS (.0) and you would
- only call one system for the entire mail event.
-
-
- ROUTE TO: 105/3 FOR 105/ALL
- 107/27 FOR 107/ALL 109/ALL
- 2:500/0 FOR 2:ALL/ALL
- HOSTS EXCEPT OURNET
-
- The above example is an example of bizarre routing. I've told D'Bridge
- that I want "standard" routing for this event, except:
-
- All mail for NET 105 goes to 105/3
- " " " NETs 107 and 109 goes to 107/27
- " " " Europe (ZONE 2) goes to 2:500/0
-
-
- Anyway, there are two specific syntaxes for the ROUTE TO field:
-
- ROUTE TO: <ADDRESS> FOR <FILTER>
-
- - or -
-
- ROUTE TO: HOSTS EXCEPT OURNET
-
- - or -
-
- ROUTE TO: HUBS (HOSTS and HUBS are really the same)
-
- - or -
-
- ROUTE TO: NONE
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 80D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- ROUTE FILES FOR (default "NONE")
-
- D'Bridge has the capability to route files as well as EMAIL messages.
- This is strictly forbidden in most public EMAIL systems, but we provide
- this capability because of its potential use in a commercial environment.
- If specified in this filter, EMAIL messages with files-attached, will be
- routed using the ROUTE-TO statement above. This filter just lists what
- systems files may be routed for.
-
- Example:
-
- ROUTE FILES FOR: OURNET
-
-
-
-
- FORWARD MAIL FOR (default "ALL")
-
- Because of ROUTING, mail FORWARDING becomes necessary. FORWARDING
- is defined as sending mail that is neither destined for or originating
- from your system. Normally, you shouldn't need to forward mail unless
- you are a HOST or HUB, or have made some sort or arrangement to do it.
- If you have forwarding disabled, messages "IN TRANSIT" will just sit
- in your network mail area until you notice that they're there and
- manually forward them. Here, you specify for which systems you will
- forward mail using a <FILTER>. There's no reason why you shouldn't
- specify "ALL" here. Examples:
-
- FORWARD MAIL FOR: ALL
- FORWARD MAIL FOR: 135/20 .ALL EXCEPT .7
-
-
-
-
- FORWARD MAIL TO (default "OURNET")
-
- This is the "dangerous" one. This field controls to which addresses you
- are allowing mail to be forwarded. If you were to specify "ALL" here,
- your system would send "IN TRANSIT" messages to any system in your
- nodelist. Needless to say, this could cost you a lot of money. More
- typically, you would specify "OURNET" plus any nodes that you have
- agreed to forward mail to. Examples follow:
-
- FORWARD MAIL TO: OURNET
- FORWARD MAIL TO: OURNET 107/27
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 81D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- FORWARD FILES TO: (default "NONE")
-
- Just like the FORWARD TO filter above, this specifies which systems
- may have files forwarded to them. Not all EMAIL packages that are
- compatible with D'Bridge have the capability to forward files. Before
- using the file-forwarding option, check with the system operator of
- the "host" system to make sure that they'll forward files you send.
-
-
-
-
- FORWARD FILES FOR: (default "NONE")
-
- Just like the FORWARD FOR filter, this specifies for whom you will
- forward files. This only affects messages that are in-transmit, neither
- originating from or destined for your system.
-
-
-
-
- DOS COMMANDS (no default)
-
- During certain events, you may wish to have D'Bridge terminate or
- execute DOS commands every time mail is received from a remote system.
- The DOS COMMANDS field allows you to specify any number of DOS commands
- or programs to be executed when mail arrives. Any DOS command or
- program may be used, but you must make sure that they don't require
- any human interaction or D'Bridge will be "stuck" until you give the
- program the input it wants.
-
- As well as DOS commands, the following functions are available from
- the DOS COMMANDS field:
-
-
- *R This will force D'Bridge to rescan the netmail area
- after all the DOS commands are executed. This should
- be on a line by itself.
-
- *S This will force D'Bridge to do a complete ECHOmail
- scan immediately.
-
- *X<errorlevel> This will cause D'Bridge to exit with the specified
- errorlevel. Make sure that this is the only thing
- on the line, everything else will be ignored.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 82D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- When you have finished with all fields, press the ESC key. You should
- get a small menu like this:
-
- /-------------\
- | Change |
- | Routing |
- | Save |
- \-------------/
-
- Move the cursor to the desired option, then press ENTER. The SAVE
- will take you back to the main schedule menu as described in the
- beginning of this chapter. ROUTING takes you back to the ADVANCED
- ROUTING screen and allows you to change it; ESC or CHANGE takes
- you back to the ADD/CHANGE event screen and allows you to change
- values.
-
- After you SAVE the event, D'Bridge will show you a graphic picture of
- the weekly schedule using a bar-graph method. This should help you
- to prevent a scheduling conflict as you add more events.
-
-
-
- UN-EVENT - Maintain the Crashmail Parameters
- --------------------------------------------
-
- When no other events are active, D'Bridge is running what we call the
- "UN-EVENT." An UN-EVENT is just what it sounds, not an event. We use
- this as the method for you to specify "ADVANCED ROUTING" information for
- crashmail. Each time D'Bridge is started, if there is no other event
- active, it scans for crashmail and makes packets for all specified
- systems. Normally, D'Bridge keeps everyone's mail on "HOLD" 24-hours a
- day, so it may be picked up at anytime.
-
-
-
- DUPLICATE - Copy one event to another
- -------------------------------------
-
- The DUPLICATE function is just like ADD, but it allows you to copy
- a previously defined event to another. In many cases, you may have
- several events that are quite similar. DUPLICATE simply saves some
- typing (and possible mistakes) by duplicating the specified event.
- Select DUPLICATE by pressing ENTER when it is highlighted. Assuming
- that there are events to copy, event #1 should be highlighted. Using
- the UP and DOWN arrow keys, you can move the highlight bar to select
- the event that you wish to DUPLICATE. After you press ENTER, the
- schedule maintenance subsystem will be in ADD mode after copying the
- event entirely. Refer to the ADD function, described earlier in this
- section for more information.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 83D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Schedule Maintenance 3.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- CHANGE - Change event information
- ---------------------------------
-
- The CHANGE function allows you to change any information that you had
- previously defined with the ADD function. Just like DUPLICATE, you
- select the event to change by moving the highlight bar UP and DOWN, then
- pressing the ENTER key. When you do this, the event will be displayed
- in its maintenance window and allow you to change values; refer to the
- ADD function, described earlier in this section, for more information.
-
-
-
-
-
- REMOVE - Erase an event completely
- ----------------------------------
-
- The REMOVE function allows you to erase any event from the schedule.
- Just like DUPLICATE and CHANGE, you must select the event by moving the
- highlight bar UP and DOWN, then pressing the ENTER key. When you do
- this, D'Bridge will ask you to confirm (Yes or No) if you want to remove
- the event or not.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 84D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Nodelist configuration 3.11
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 3.11 CONFIG: NODELIST CONFIGURATION
- ------------------------------------
-
-
- The NODELIST CONFIGURATION option allows the operator to define the
- parameters that affect the D'Bridge nodelist. Let's start with some
- basic definitions of terms used here.
-
-
- NODE A node is simply another name for a system. Each system
- running D'Bridge (or any other mailer) is called a node.
-
- POINT A point is just another name for a node. A point is never
- listed in the NODELIST, it is listed in a separate POINTLIST
- maintained by each POINT BOSS.
-
- NODELIST The master list of NODES that your system is able to contact.
- This list includes the address, name, operator, city, phone
- number and baud rate along with some additional information
- like flags/comments. For D'Bridge to be able to send mail
- directly to a system, the destination system must be in your
- NODELIST.
-
- POINTLIST The master list of POINTS under your a BOSS is called the
- POINTLIST. It is similar in format to a NODELIST, but
- contains only POINTS for one NODE.
-
-
-
-
- /-NODELIST CONFIGURATION------------------------------------------------\
- | "St. Louis" nodelists: C:\DB\FILES\ NODELIST NODEDIFF 6567 153 |
- | Private nodelists: |
- | Pointlist: |
- | Fake pointnet: |
- | Fake point addressing: |
- | Create username index: Yes |
- | Additional user file: USER.LST |
- | Outbound gateway: |
- | Use ZONEgates? No |
- | Exclude ZONE:NET(s): |
- | Translate NET(s): |
- | Country prefix: 1 |
- | Domestic prefix: |
- | NO-COST prefix: |
- | International prefix: 011- |
- | Phone # override(s): 135/69 232-5555 |
- | Baud rate override(s): 135/69 2400 |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 85D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Nodelist configuration 3.11
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
-
- "ST. LOUIS" NODELISTS?
-
- St. Louis refers to a standard format for NODELIST text files. This
- includes a "nodelist" and a "nodediff." You may have any number of
- St. Louis-style nodelists at one time by listing each separately in
- the window. Each line in the window describes one nodelist and should
- contain:
-
- <DIRECTORY PATH> <NODELIST BASE> <NODEDIFF BASE>
-
- For example:
-
- C:\DB\FILES\ NODELIST NODEDIFF 7567 153
- C:\DB\FILES\ ANETLIST ANETDIFF 38791 153
-
-
- The two numbers on the right are the CRC of the nodelist name and the
- currently installed nodelist. These numbers are maintained by D'Bridge
- and the user need not concern himself with them.
-
- D'Bridge automatically determines which nodelist is the most-recent based
- on the extension of the "list" or "diff" file. The St. Louis format is
- based on weekly update files called "diff" files; these files contain
- the differences between last week's and this week's nodelists and are
- generally smaller than the nodelist itself. If a diff file exists for
- a nodelist, it will be automatically decompressed and installed when
- it arrives (if applicable.)
-
-
-
-
- PRIVATE NODELIST(S)
-
- You may also use any number of private nodelists. In this field you
- may specify an number of text files to be included in your compiled
- nodelist. You may notice that D'Bridge adds two numbers after the
- filename once the nodelist is compiled; these numbers are the date and
- time of the private nodelist file. If these numbers are changed or the
- nodelist is replaced or edited, D'Bridge will automatically recompile
- the nodelist when it is started next.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 86D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Nodelist configuration 3.11
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- POINTLIST
-
- If you are part of a point system, you will want to specify the name of
- your POINTLIST file. This is a list of POINTS that are under the same
- ZONE:NET/NODE as your system. Just like the PRIVATE NODELISTS, the
- numbers after the filename indicate the date and time of the POINTLIST
- when the nodelist was last compiled. If these are changed, D'Bridge
- will automatically recompile the nodelist.
-
-
- FAKE POINTNET
-
- To maintain compatibility with older EMAIL systems, a "FAKE POINTNET"
- has been established to allow Fidonet-based mailers to act as points
- of a D'Bridge BOSS. Since there is no definition of a "point" address
- in Fidonet, a fake NET number is used. Specify the fake net to use
- here. When a system calls in using that NET number, the node number
- used will be translated into a point address.
-
-
- FAKE POINT ADDRESSING
-
- This field specifies which systems require the FAKE POINT addressing.
- Specify the point numbers of the systems for which FAKE POINT addressing
- is required. This affects the way in which ECHOmail packets are created.
-
-
- CREATE USERNAME INDEX?
-
- D'Bridge will optionally create a USERNAME index when it compiles the
- nodelist. If you answer "YES" to this field, the index will be created
- and D'Bridge (and the editor) will be able to cross-reference operator
- name to address. This feature is quite handy, but makes the nodelist
- compile much slower. If you don't want the index created, answer "NO."
-
-
- ADDITIONAL USER FILE
-
- You may specify the name of a text file that contains an additional
- userlist to merge with the nodelists. Typically, this list will contain
- a list of people that use certain EMAIL systems but are not listed as
- the primary operator. The format for this file is:
-
- <address> <name>
-
- ie. 1:135/68.2 George Meyers
- .20 John Smith
- 107/27.5 Oliver North
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 87D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Nodelist configuration 3.11
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- OUTBOUND GATEWAY
-
- Most networks do not use an outbound gateway, but if your NET has a
- system designated to send all outbound mail, then put its address here.
- You would use this in conjunction with the ROUTE TO field in the schedule
- maintenance subsystem. (ROUTE TO: OGATE FOR OTHERS)
-
-
- USE ZONEGATES?
-
- In Fidonet (and other international networks) there are ZONEGATES that
- allow mail to be sent from one ZONE to another without making an over-
- seas call. If you are part of Fidonet, and you are sending mail from
- the U.S. to Europe, you have the option of sending the mail through the
- ZONE 1 gateway (1/2) or going direct to your destination. Specify "YES"
- if you wish all interzone traffic (without attached files) to be routed
- through the ZONEGATE; specify "NO" if you always want to use direct
- routing.
-
-
- EXCLUDE ZONE:NET(s)
-
- Some systems (that use a large NODELIST like Fidonet) may want to
- completely eliminate certain ZONES and/or NETS from their nodelist.
- If there is no reason to communicate with people in other countries,
- you can greatly reduce the NODELIST size and compile-time by excluding
- those addresses that you don't use. For example, if you live in the
- U.S. and don't plan to do any mail to Europe or Australia, you can
- exclude them in the following way:
-
- EXCLUDE ZONE:NET(s): 2:ALL 3:ALL
-
-
- TRANSLATE NET(s)
-
- This field gives you the option to actually translate one NET to
- another. This will let you move a NET from one zone to another or
- simply change the NET number to something else. This will not be
- used for most systems, but is a feature found in other EMAIL systems
- and I am including it for compatibility. The syntax is:
-
- TRANSLATE NET(s): <original ZONE:NET> <new ZONE:NET>
-
- ie. TRANSLATE NET(s): 2:507 1:507
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 88D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Nodelist configuration 3.11
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- COUNTRY PREFIX
-
- Here, you MUST specify your country code. This is the prefix found
- before the "area code" in the nodelist. For the U.S. and Canada,
- specify "1" - other countries, specify your country code (in the same
- way you do with DOS)
-
-
-
- NO-COST PREFIX
-
- If there is a prefix that you must dial before NO-COST (local) calls,
- specify it here. In the U.S. and Canada, this field will be left blank
- in most cases. (Some PBX systems might require you to dial "9" to get
- a local outside line.)
-
-
-
- DOMESTIC PREFIX
-
- If there is a prefix in your country that you must dial before all
- domestic calls, specify it here. For the U.S. and Canada, this field
- should be left blank; we need no PREFIX. (Some PBX systems might
- require that you dial an "8" to get a long-distance line.)
-
-
-
- INTERNATIONAL PREFIX
-
- Specify the prefix to dial before any international calls are made.
- In the U.S., use "011" - other countries, check with your phone company.
- An international call is defined as one where the COUNTRY PREFIX of the
- system being called differs from your own.
-
-
- PHONE NUMBER OVERRIDES
-
- If you wish to override the phone number for an existing address, or
- define the phone number for an unlisted NODE or POINT, the PHONE NUMBER
- OVERRIDES is the place to do this. Following is an example of how I
- specify the phone number for one of my unlisted points:
-
- 135/68.2 232-9365
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 89D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Nodelist configuration 3.11
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- BAUD RATE OVERRIDES
-
- This is where you may specify temporary overrides to baud rate for
- specified addresses. For example, a friend of mine just got a 9600
- baud modem, but he is still listed in the nodelist as 2400. I'll
- just add the line:
-
- 107/27 9600
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 90D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Packet/mail control 3.12
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 3.12 CONFIG: PACKET/MAIL CONTROL
- ---------------------------------
-
-
- Selecting the "Packet/mail control" option will display the following
- window:
-
-
- /-PACKET/MAIL CONTROL---------------------------------------------------\
- | Outbound mail archive: C:\TEXT\OUTBOUND.TXT |
- | Netmail archive: C:\TEXT\NETMAIL.TXT |
- | Purge netmail after: 7 days |
- | Rename incoming files? No |
- | Unpack mail? Yes |
- | Kill null msgs? No |
- | Kill in-transit msgs? Yes |
- | In-transit rescan? Yes |
- | Process ECHOmail? Yes |
- | Limit NO-COST calls? No |
- | Save ECHOmail area line? No |
- | Save ECHOmail SEENBYs? No |
- | Save duplicate messages? Yes |
- | Link ECHOmail replies? Yes |
- | Auto-add ECHOmail areas? Fido (No/Fido/QuickBBS) |
- | Accept AREAFIX requests? Yes |
- | AREAFIX information: 1:18/68.1 SKYDIVE 50 Crash Yes |
- | Forced priorities: 1:18/68.1 Hold |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
-
- OUTBOUND MAIL ARCHIVE
-
- This specifies the name of the text file (if any) to write messages
- flagged ARCHIVE/SENT before they are erased. This is quite useful
- as a history of EMAIL sent; it includes the full message text and the
- date and time it was sent.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 91D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Packet/mail control 3.12
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- NETMAIL ARCHIVE
-
- The NETMAIL ARCHIVE parameter specifies the text file (if any) that
- the DBUTIL PURGE option will use to archive NETMAIL messages before
- erasing them. If you do not wish to save old NETMAIL messages, leave
- this field blank.
-
-
-
- PURGE NETMAIL AFTER x days / PURGE NETMAIL EXCEPT x messages
-
- In the DBUTIL PURGE program, there are two options for deciding which
- messages to erase from the system. When the cursor is on this field,
- you may press the F1 key to switch between the methods: PURGE EXCEPT
- and PURGE AFTER. With PURGE EXCEPT, DBUTIL will erase all but "x"
- messages; specify "x" in this field as how many messages to save after
- purging. With the PURGE AFTER option, DBUTIL will purge messages based
- on their age. PURGE AFTER 30 DAYS means to erase all messages over 30
- days old when the DBUTIL PURGE is run.
-
-
-
- RENAME INCOMING FILES?
-
- There will be occasions when you will receive different files with
- the same filename. If you answer YES to this question, any files
- received that have a duplicate filename in the INBOUND FILES DIRECTORY
- will be renamed by "sequencing" the last character of the extension.
- A duplicate README.TXT would become README.TX1 if it existed; if "1"
- was already there as well, "2" would be used, etc. If you answer NO
- to RENAME INCOMING FILES, the file will simply be replaced by the newer
- one.
-
-
-
- UNPACK MAIL?
-
- This question should almost always be answered as YES. If you say NO,
- that means that you do not want D'Bridge to unpack any of the mail
- packets as they are received. (You can't read any EMAIL messages that
- haven't been unpacked.) If you wish to do this on a "batch" basis only,
- answer NO.=
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 92D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Packet/mail control 3.12
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- KILL NULL MESSAGES?
-
- Usually, you would answer YES to KILL NULL MESSAGES. A null message
- means a message that has a TO, FROM and SUBJECT, but no text. These
- are usually just messages associated with a file-attach and should
- be ignored anyway. If you answer YES to this question, all messages
- that are unpacked and have no text will be ignored.
-
-
-
- KILL IN-TRANSIT MESSAGES?
-
- The definition of an IN-TRANSIT message is one that was neither
- originated from nor destined for your system. This message exists
- on your system just to be forwarded elsewhere. If you answer YES
- to this question, IN-TRANSIT messages will be flagged KILL/SENT when
- they arrive. If you answer NO here, forwarded mail will "pile-up"
- until it is purged or manually killed.
-
-
-
- IN-TRANSIT RESCAN?
-
- If your system acts as a hub or boss-node, you might want to provide
- immediate turnaround when "routed" mail is received. If you answer
- YES to IN-TRANSIT RESCAN, the NETmail area will be rescanned after each
- in-transit message is received. This will cause the message to be made
- available to the destination system immediately rather than waiting for
- the next event.
-
-
-
- PROCESS ECHOMAIL?
-
- If you want D'Bridge to process ECHOmail, answer YES here. If you
- answer NO, any ECHOmail messages that are unpacked will just be
- treated as normal NETmail. This allows D'Bridge to be used with
- other message base formats than it supports providing there is a
- compatible external ECHOmail processor available.
-
-
-
- SAVE ECHOMAIL AREA LINE?
-
- Normally, you would answer NO to this question. The exception would
- be for bulletin board systems that require the "AREA:" text to appear
- at the top of messages.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 93D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Packet/mail control 3.12
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- LIMIT NO-COST CALLS?
-
- D'Bridge has the ability to limit the number of outbound sessions that
- are allowed during an event (See section 3.10 for information...) If
- you answer NO to LIMIT NO-COST CALLS, there will be no limit for how
- many times you can call a local system. This is handy for allowing
- unlimited turnaround for local (NO-COST) ECHOmail while still limiting
- long-distance connections.
-
-
-
- SAVE ECHOMAIL SEENBYs?
-
- If you wish to save the text that contains the SEENBY lines in your
- message base, answer YES. It really doesn't matter how you respond
- to this question; the system will perform the same way. NOTE: This
- field has no affect on the Fido storage method.
-
-
-
-
- SAVE DUPLICATE MESSAGES?
-
- Personally, I would answer NO to this question, but if you would like
- to see what messages are received duplicated (more than once,) answer
- YES here. If you save the duplicate messages, they will be tossed into
- the BADECHO area for your inspection.
-
-
-
- AUTO-ADD ECHOMAIL AREAS
-
- D'Bridge has the capability of automatically adding ECHOmail areas that
- don't exist when undefined CONFERENCE TAGS are detected. This can save
- lots of work in setting up areas; all you need to do once they are added
- is to enter the area security and description using EDITOR: Local/
- ECHOmail areas.
-
- In this field, you specify what storage format to use, if any for new
- ECHOmail areas:
-
-
- NO If you answer NO to this question, messages with an unknown
- conference tag will be tossed to the BADECHO area.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 94D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Packet/mail control 3.12
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- Fido If you specify Fido storage, a new subdirectory will be
- created when a new conference is received. This subdirectory
- will be created in the NEW ECHO AREA PATH specified on the
- DIRECTORY PATHS screen.
-
-
- QUICKBBS With the QuickBBS storage method, the next available area
- number will used in the message bases. For this reason, it
- is important to define ALL your message bases in D'Bridge so
- that it doesn't accidently assign one that you're using just
- in your BBS.
-
-
-
- ACCEPT AREAFIX REQUESTS?
-
- If D'Bridge should accept and process AREAFIX requests, answer YES here.
- If you answer NO, the requests received will just appear in your NETMAIL
- area and never be processed. D'Bridge only processes requests as they
- are unpacked, not from them existing in the NETMAIL area.
-
-
-
- AREAFIX INFORMATION
-
- This is the window where you list all your AREAFIX passwords and
- security levels. There is one line for each system using the format:
-
- <ADDRESS> <PASSWORD> <SECURITY> <PRIORITY> <ALLOW RESCAN?>
-
- Where:
-
- ADDRESS is the address of the system in the form ZONE:NET/NODE.POINT
-
- PASSWORD is a codeword agreed upon by both systems (you and the system
- specified.) The password may be from 1 to 32 characters.
-
- SECURITY is the security level assigned to the system. This is a number
- between 0 and 9999; based on the security level specified in each ECHO-
- mail area, it determines which areas a system may request. Only areas
- with a security level less than or equal to this number may be accessed
- with AREAFIX.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 95D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: Packet/mail control 3.12
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- PRIORITY is the EMAIL priority associated with the link. In most cases,
- you would use CRASH for systems in your local calling area and NORMAL or
- HOLD for long-distance links. Valid priorities are: Immediate, Crash,
- Normal and Hold.
-
- ALLOW RESCAN means whether the specified system should be allowed to
- request a complete rescan of a conference as it is added. Normally,
- this is acceptable, but if your system is particularly busy, you may
- want to disallow this by answering NO.
-
- New entries can be automatically added by using the REQUEST ECHO LINK,
- ALT-R command. Every system using AREAFIX must have a password in this
- field or they will receive a "no password" message from D'Bridge.
-
-
-
- FORCED PRIORITIES
-
- This window allows you to absolutely override the priority for any
- system on a semi-permanent basis. The overrides are listed one per
- line and the format is:
-
- <ADDRESS> <PRIORITY>
-
- ADDRESS is the address of the desired system.
-
- PRIORITY is the overridden priority: Immediate, Crash, Normal or Hold
-
- This field is also maintained in the VIEW/MODIFY QUEUE, ALT-V screen.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 96D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: XMAIL control 3.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 3.13 CONFIG: XMAIL CONTROL
- ---------------------------
-
-
- Selecting the "XMAIL control" option will display the following window:
-
- /-XMAIL CONTROL---------------------------------------------------------\
- | Unpack inbound XMAIL? Yes |
- | LHARCmail for: NONE |
- | ZIPmail for: ALL |
- | PAKmail for: NONE |
- | LHARC creation command: LHARC a -m |
- | LHARC extract command: LHARC x -m |
- | ZIP creation command: PKZIP |
- | ZIP extract command: PKUNZIP -o |
- | PAK creation command: PAK A |
- | PAK extract command: PAK E /WA |
- | ARC creation command: ARC A |
- | ARC extract command: ARC XO |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
-
- UNPACK INBOUND XMAIL?
-
- If you want to use the ECHOmail facilities of D'Bridge, you MUST answer
- YES to this question. If you answer NO, D'Bridge will never unpack the
- compressed mail (XMAIL) packets that arrive.
-
-
- LHARCMAIL FOR
-
- If you want to use the LHARC archive format for some systems, specify
- the net/node filter here. (This is in the same format as described
- in the advanced routing screen of schedule maintenance.) This only
- affects outbound XMAIL.
-
-
-
- ZIPMAIL FOR
-
- If you want to use the ZIP archive format for some systems, specify
- the net/node filter here.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 97D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: XMAIL control 3.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- PAKMAIL FOR
-
- If you want to use the PAK archive format for some systems, specify
- the net/node filter here.
-
-
-
- LHARC CREATION COMMAND
-
- Specify the DOS command to create or update an LHARC file. The default
- is: LHARC a -m
-
-
-
- LHARC EXTRACT COMMAND
-
- Specify the DOS command to extract all files from an LHARC file. The
- default is: LHARC x -m
-
-
-
- ZIP CREATION COMMAND
-
- Specify the DOS command to create or update an ZIP file. The default
- is: PKZIP
-
-
-
- ZIP EXTRACT COMMAND
-
- Specify the DOS command to extract all files from an ZIP file. The
- default is: PKUNZIP -o
-
-
-
- PAK CREATION COMMAND
-
- Specify the DOS command to create or update an PAK file. The default
- is: PAK A
-
-
-
- PAK EXTRACT COMMAND
-
- Specify the DOS command to extract all files from an PAK file. The
- default is: PAK E /WA
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 98D'Bridge Electronic Mail System CONFIG: XMAIL control 3.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- ARC CREATION COMMAND
-
- Specify the DOS command to create or update an ARC file. The default
- is: ARC A
-
-
-
- ARC EXTRACT COMMAND
-
- Specify the DOS command to extract all files from an ARC file. The
- default is: ARC XO
-
-
-
-
- If you wish to use the XMAIL features of D'Bridge, you will need to get
- one of these supported archive programs:
-
-
- ARC System Enhancement Associates
- 21 New Street
- Wayne, NJ 07470
-
- PKZIP PKWARE, Inc.
- 7545 N. Port Washington Rd.
- Glendale, WI 53217
-
- PAK NoGate Consulting
- P.O. Box 88115
- Grand Rapids, MI 49518-0115
-
- LHARC Copyright by Haruyasu Toshizaki
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 99D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Function keys 3.14
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 3.14 ADVANCED: FUNCTION KEYS
- -----------------------------
-
-
- The FUNCTION KEYS option allows the operator to define what DOS commands
- the F1-F10 keys will perform when D'Bridge is idle. It is often
- desirable to pre-program commands that are used often so they can be
- executed simply by pressing a function key. NOTE: These keys are only
- active while D'Bridge is "IDLE." When you are at a menu, these keys
- have no effect.
-
-
- /-FUNCTION KEYS---------------------------------------------------------\
- |On this screen, you may define what DOS commands the function keys run.|
- | |
- | F1: CHKDSK /F |
- | F2: |
- | F3: |
- | F4: |
- /-F6:-------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | TYPE DBRIDGE.LOG |
- | PAUSE |
- |\----------------------------------------------------------------------/
- | F9: |
- | F10: |
- | ALT-F1: |
- | ALT-F2: |
- | ALT-F3: |
- | ALT-F4: |
- | ALT-F5: |
- | ALT-F6: |
- | ALT-F7: |
- | ALT-F8: |
- | ALT-F9: |
- |ALT-F10: |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- The above example shows the definition for the F6 function key as using
- the DOS "TYPE" command to display the system log, then pausing.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 100D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: BBS Configuration 3.15
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 3.15 ADVANCED: BBS CONFIGURATION
- ---------------------------------
-
-
- The BBS Configuration is only used if you are running a BULLETIN BOARD
- SYSTEM in conjunction with D'Bridge. If you are running just an EMAIL
- system then this section does not apply to you. Selecting the BBS
- Configuration option displays the following screen:
-
-
- /-BBS CONFIGURATION-----------------------------------------------------\
- | Using a BBS? Yes |
- | Human caller timeout: 15 |
- | Hours: 24 hours |
- | Minimum baud: |
- | "Banner" file: |
- | "Too slow" file: |
- | "After hours" file: |
- | "Please wait" text: Pressing ESC gets you in faster... |
- | "Loading BBS" text: Loading the D'Bridge support BBS... |
- | DOS commands for BBS: cd \opus |
- | Scan ECHOmail after? Yes |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
-
- USING A BBS?
-
- If you are D'Bridge as the "front-end" for a bulletin board system (BBS)
- then answer "YES" to this question. If you do not want D'Bridge to run
- another program (such as a BBS) when "humans" call, specify "NO."
-
-
-
- HUMAN CALLER TIMEOUT
-
- Specify the number of seconds that D'Bridge should wait before
- determining that a call is "human" and not an EMAIL call. The minimum
- for this field is 10 seconds, but you may want to make this time longer
- if you have "noisy" phone lines or have trouble with inbound connections.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 101D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: BBS Configuration 3.15
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- HOURS (If running a BBS)
-
- You may (if you wish) specify certain hours which humans may call your
- BBS. There is already an option in the schedule maintenance subsystem
- to disallow human callers during mail events, but you may also specify
- a time range here also. (Ie. 07:00 - 23:00)
-
-
-
-
- MINIMUM BAUD
-
- Some system operators have chosen to discontinue support for slower
- modems. (Usually 300 or 1200 baud) Here, you may specify the minimum
- allowable baud rate for BBS calls. This field is here to provide you a
- great deal of flexibility. Let it not be said that we condone its use.
-
-
-
-
- BANNER FILE
-
- If you have a text file that you wish to display when D'Bridge answers
- the phone, you may specify it here. NOTE: Using a banner file can slow
- down the "SYNC" of incoming mail calls, so use this at your own risk!
-
-
-
-
- "TOO SLOW" FILE
-
- If you have specified a minimum baud rate, then you may also specify
- the name of a text file to display when a "human" caller dials in with
- a modem slower than the minimum you've specified. This file would
- typically explain why they can't get on - perhaps offering to sell them
- a faster modem. :-)
-
-
-
-
- "AFTER HOURS" FILE
-
- If you have specified a time range when the BBS may be accessed, you
- may also define the name of a text file to display when someone calls
- in outside of those hours.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 102D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: BBS Configuration 3.15
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- "PLEASE WAIT" TEXT
-
- When someone first dials into D'Bridge, it displays its copyright notice
- and the "PLEASE WAIT" TEXT. You may specify any message you wish to
- replace the standard "Please wait..." In fact, you may use multiple
- lines in this message, but each line that you adds slows down the "SYNC"
- process when mail is received.
-
-
-
-
- "LOADING BBS" TEXT
-
- When D'Bridge has decided that the calling system wants access to the
- BBS, (either by timeout or by receiving an ESC) it sends the "LOADING
- BBS" TEXT. Again, this may be any number of lines, but usually just
- says "Loading the BBS..." or something like that.
-
-
-
-
- DOS COMMANDS FOR BBS
-
- Here, you specify the DOS commands that will be used to invoke the BBS,
- telling it that you already have a caller online. There are two methods
- for doing this: SPAWNING and EXITING. The most popular method is to
- SPAWN to BBS - leaving D'Bridge in memory. EXITING is used only when
- there is not enough memory to SPAWN the entire BBS system. In this
- field, you simply list the DOS commands that you want D'Bridge to run to
- invoke the BBS. There are several "special" commands that substitute
- values or cause an EXIT:
-
- *B A *B in a command line is replaced with the baud rate of the
- serial port.
-
- *C Replaced by the actual connect string from the mode.
-
- *P A *P in a command line is replaced with the port number that
- D'Bridge is using. (1-7)
-
- *R Causes a rescan of NETmail.
-
- *S Causes a rescan of ECHOmail.
-
- *T A *T in a command line is replace with the number of minutes
- until the next event. Most BBS systems can use this number to
- make sure that the caller logs off within that time period.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 103D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: BBS Configuration 3.15
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- *X If a *X is found in any command line, D'Bridge will terminate
- with an errorlevel of the BAUD RATE / 100. For example, a 300
- baud connection would have an error level of 3; 2400 baud would
- return an error level of 24, etc. This is typically used with
- a batch file to invoke the BBS with the correct parameters
- depending on the baud rate of the caller. All other commands
- on a line with *X are ignored. All lines after it are useless.
-
- As an example, here's what my DOS BBS COMMANDS field looks like to run
- Opus, then execute the MYMAIL program (An Opus MAIL-CHECK program by
- Steve Sullivan):
-
- cd \opus
- opus opus -t*t -p*p -b*b
- mymail -u
-
- When a caller dials in at 2400 baud with 120 minutes until the next
- event, D'Bridge runs the following DOS commands:
-
- cd \opus
- opus opus -t120 -p1 -b2400
- mymail -u
-
- After all these commands are complete, D'Bridge initializes the modem
- the returns to its previous status. (Mail event, IDLE, etc.)
-
-
- For specific information on setting up D'Bridge with your BBS, see
- section 10 for specific information.
-
-
-
-
-
- SCAN ECHOMAIL AFTER
-
- If you want D'Bridge to send ECHOmail immediately after it is entered
- on your BBS, answer YES here. It is usually more time-effective to
- scan ECHOmail during a scheduled event, but D'Bridge gives you the
- flexibility to have immediate turnaround on ECHOmail entered on the BBS.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 104D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Security/Miscellaneous 3.16
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 3.16 ADVANCED: SECURITY/MISCELLANEOUS
- --------------------------------------
-
-
- The Security/Miscellaneous configuration is used to control many of the
- different features D'Bridge has. For a basic mail system, nothing on
- this screen needs to be changed. Selecting this option will display
- the following screen:
-
-
- /-SECURITY/MISCELLANEOUS------------------------------------------------\
- | Default password for outbound mail: |
- | Session passwords: 135/20 WALLY |
- | Ignore unauthorized mail packets? No |
- | Rename unauthorized inbound files? Yes |
- | Allow unlisted nodes to send mail? Yes |
- | File-requests for unlisted nodes? Yes |
- | Time-limit for file-requests: 60 (minutes) |
- | File-request limit: 500 (K bytes) |
- | Maximum files for file-request: 6 (NUMBER of files) |
- | Check limits BEFORE or AFTER file? After |
- | Enforce limits for 24-hours? Yes |
- | Minimum baud rate for requests: 300 |
- | Function requests: MEGALIST.INQ MEGALIST.LST ML-INQ|
- | External gateways: |
- | Fidonet protocol for: NONE |
- | WaZOO protocol for: NONE |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
-
- DEFAULT PASSWORD FOR OUTBOUND MAIL
-
- In this field, you may specify a "default" password to use when sending
- mail. Most systems do not require passwords, but you may specify a
- password to be used "by default." (ie. when no other is specified.)
- We do not really recommend this option, but it is provided for
- compatibility with other EMAIL systems.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 105D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Security/Miscellaneous 3.16
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- SESSION PASSWORDS
-
- In a corporate environment, or a public network where security is
- becoming a problem, you may specify a SESSION PASSWORD for each system
- that you plan to communicate with directly. This password must be
- specified by BOTH systems and must be agreed upon in advance. Once in
- place, it becomes impossible to communicate with the other system if you
- don't use the same password.
-
- A password will prevent an unauthorized system from picking-up mail.
- With HiTek comes Hi-Tech hackers. It is not hard to change your address
- to something else, then poll your host to see what mail you can "steal."
- Any "link" that is protected with a password is not vulnerable to this
- simple form of "mail-stealing." For a password with 135/20, type:
-
- 135/20 WALLY (Where "WALLY" is the desired SESSION PASSWORD)
-
- Any number of session passwords may be defined. Remember, in the above
- example, it is important that 135/20 also sets up a SESSION PASSWORD for
- my address, 135/68, or it won't work. Both ends must use the same
- password! (Passwords must be eight letters or less)
-
-
-
- IGNORE UNAUTHORIZED MAIL PACKETS?
-
- If you are using SESSION PASSWORDS to protect any of your links, you
- may choose to completely ignore incoming mail from a link using the
- wrong password. If you do wish to ignore this mail, specify "YES" to
- this field. If you want to receive the mail normally, answer "NO."
-
-
-
- RENAME UNAUTHORIZED INBOUND FILES?
-
- If you are using SESSION PASSWORDS to protect any of your links, you
- may choose to rename incoming files to BADFILE.001, BADFILE.002, etc.
- The reason for doing this is to prevent unauthorized ECHOMAIL and
- FUNCTION REQUESTS from being executed. Specify "YES" if you want to
- automatically rename incoming files or "NO" if you want to receive
- them normally.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 106D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Security/Miscellaneous 3.16
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- ALLOW UNLISTED NODES TO SEND MAIL?
-
- In a private network, possibly the BEST way to discourage hackers from
- the outside is to hang-up on them immediately. If you specify "YES" to
- this question, D'Bridge will immediately reject any incoming call that is
- from a system not listed in your nodelist. This should only be used in
- a private network - public networks often have communications from new
- addresses or private addresses, not in the nodelist.
-
-
-
- FILE-REQUESTS FOR UNLISTED NODES?
-
- If you support file-requests, you must decide whether or not you wish
- to allow systems that are NOT in your nodelist to request files. Some
- people (kids, usually) will abuse your system's file-request privilege
- by calling back many times, using many fake node numbers to file-request.
- If you say "YES" to this question, any system, listed or not will be
- able to issue file-requests. If you say "NO" then only requests from
- systems found in your nodelist will be honored.
-
-
-
- TIME-LIMIT FOR FILE-REQUESTS
- FILE-REQUEST LIMIT
- MAXIMUM FILES FOR FILE-REQUEST
-
- When you are running a public system, you may find that you have trouble
- with people abusing the file-request privilege by constantly requesting
- too many files and keeping your system busy for hours. D'Bridge allows
- you to limit the time, size and number of files requested. If a caller
- exceeds these limits, they will receive a text file that explains why
- their request was not honored. There are three parameters that control
- the file-request limits. If any one of the three are exceeded, then
- the caller is considered over-the-limit:
-
- Time limit for file-requests: The maximum number of minutes allowed.
- File-request limit: The maximum kilobytes (K) allowed.
- Maximum files for file-request: The maximum number of files allowed.
-
-
-
- CHECK LIMITS BEFORE OR AFTER FILE?
-
- This specifies whether the file-request limits are tested BEFORE or
- AFTER each file is transferred. Personally, I prefer testing AFTER
- because I like to allow people to request any file on my system; some
- files on my system are larger than the FILE-REQUEST LIMIT (K.)
- If the limits are checked BEFORE each transfer, it would be impossible
- to file-request any file larger than the size limit.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 107D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Security/Miscellaneous 3.16
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- ENFORCE LIMITS FOR 24-HOURS?
-
- If you wish to accumulate these file-request limits for a 24-hour
- period, answer "YES" here. If you want the limits enforced on a
- per-call basis, answer "NO." If the limits are enforced for 24-hours,
- a file is created containing the address, timestamp and limit data.
- The limit will be reset exactly 24-hours from the START of the first
- file-request. If you must manually reset these limits, delete the
- file "DBRIDGE.FRS."
-
-
-
- MINIMUM BAUD RATE FOR REQUESTS
-
- This specifies the minimum link rate (baud) that is allowed for file-
- requests. (300/1200/2400/4800/9600... Etc.)
-
-
-
- FUNCTION REQUESTS
-
- A FUNCTION REQUEST is an online service provided to calling systems
- while they are still "on the line." FUNCTION REQUESTS only work with
- other WaZOO-based EMAIL systems such as D'Bridge, FrontDoor, Opus and
- BinkleyTerm. This is a VERY advanced feature and will not be used by
- most systems, so don't feel bad if you don't understand this...
-
- A function request can be defined in four steps:
-
- 1) The caller sends the REQUEST FILE.
-
- 2) D'Bridge recognizes the filename as being a FUNCTION REQUEST
- and spawns the REQUEST SERVER task. (user-provided)
-
- 3) The REQUEST SERVER (a program provided by the user) takes its
- input data from the REQUEST FILE and the CALLER.FIL file that
- D'Bridge creates. It prepares output file(s) to send back to
- the caller plus a OUTPUT FILE LIST that tells D'Bridge what
- files to send.
-
- 4) When the REQUEST SERVER has terminated, D'Bridge then transmits
- all the files listed in the OUTPUT FILE LIST, deletes them, then
- continues to send the rest of the "pickup" mail.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 108D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Security/Miscellaneous 3.16
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- To use this feature, you must either write your own REQUEST SERVER or
- use one of the existing systems such as ML-INQ or FILEFIND. Both of
- these programs can be obtained from the D'Bridge Support BBS, 1:18/68.
-
- The format for the FUNCTION REQUESTS field is:
-
- <REQUEST FILE> <OUTPUT FILE LIST> <DOS COMMAND>
-
- For an example, I'll explain how I run the ML-INQ program on my system.
- ML-INQ stands for Megalist Inquiry. The Megalist is another program I
- wrote that creates a "master file listing" for all participating Fido
- and Opus systems. The list got so huge, that I decided to add an online
- inquiry service. To access the MegaList Inquiry feature, the calling
- system simply creates a text file that contains a list of filename to
- search for; this file is called MEGALIST.INQ. Anytime D'Bridge receives
- a file called MEGALIST.INQ, the REQUEST SERVER "ML-INQ" is executed.
- Here's what I have in my FUNCTION REQUEST field:
-
- MEGALIST.INQ MEGALIST.LST ML-INQ
-
-
- The ML-INQ program first opens the file "CALLER.INF" to get general
- information about the system and the caller. CALLER.INF is a text
- file created automatically by D'Bridge just before spawning the REQUEST
- SERVER task. Here's what my CALLER.INF contains at the moment:
-
- 1:101/200 (The Fidonet address)
- TC-Trader (The system name)
- Cheryl Buzzell (The operator name)
- C:\DB\FILES\ (My INBOUND FILES DIRECTORY path)
-
-
- ML-INQ then opens the file "C:\DB\FILES\MEGALIST.INQ" to get the actual
- request from the caller. Then, it prepares the file "MEGALIST.OUT" that
- contains the results of the search. Finally, ML-INQ creates the OUTPUT
- FILE LIST, this time called MEGALIST.LST (in the current directory);
- this file contains the list of files to send back to the caller, then
- erase. In this case, the OUTPUT FILE LIST only contains MEGALIST.OUT.
-
- Finally, ML-INQ returns control to D'Bridge and the file gets sent and
- deleted as specified. The request file, MEGALIST.INQ is also erased.
-
- A request server may transmit files without erasing them (if they are
- available for file-request) simply by creating a WaZOO-style request
- file (with the extension .REQ) in the INBOUND FILES DIRECTORY. D'Bridge
- will treat these files like inbound file requests.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 109D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Security/Miscellaneous 3.16
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- IMPORTANT: It is essential that any REQUEST SERVER not take more than
- 30 seconds to execute. Taking more time than this can cause
- the calling system to timeout and hang-up.
-
- If you are still confused about how FUNCTION REQUESTs work, I would
- suggest that you FILE-REQUEST "FILEFIND.ARC" from 1:135/68; the source
- code (in Turbo Pascal) is included to give you a better example of exactly
- how to write a REQUEST SERVER.
-
-
-
- EXTERNAL GATEWAYS
-
- Again, this is a VERY advanced feature and will not be used by 99% of
- the D'Bridge systems out there; this is for the other 1%:
-
- An EXTERNAL GATEWAY allows D'Bridge to act as a "front-end" for up to
- 20 other EMAIL receivers at the same time. The way this works, is by
- defining a specific "SYNC" sequence, D'Bridge can look for that sequence
- and spawn another EMAIL system while the calling system is still online.
- This way, D'Bridge can be compatible with as many systems as possible.
- As of this time, I know that there are gateway programs for UUCP and
- USENET. I'm sure that there are others that I just don't know about.
-
- As an example, let's say that I want to install a UUCP mail receiver
- "on top" of D'Bridge. I have a program written for the IBM PC that
- will receive mail when a call is received. Assuming that this program
- has the option to respond to a call already in progress and terminate
- when it has finished the session, it is compatible. The first thing
- that you need to do is figure out what the SYNC sequence is.
-
- A SYNC sequence is the sequence of bytes that the calling system sends
- to the receiving system (multiple times) until the receiver responds
- with an acknowledgment that it is ready to being a mail session.
- D'Bridge can be programmed to recognize up to 20 separate sequences of
- up to 16 bytes each and spawn a different task depending on which one
- is received. For example, let's say that your UUCP transmitter
- continuously sends the sequence: 9F, A9, 9F, A9... (hex) until the
- receiving system acknowledges. For this sequence, simply specify your
- EXTERNAL GATEWAYS field as:
-
- 9F/A9 UUCP_RCV -b*b -p*p
-
- As soon as an incoming call is detected sending the sequence 9F, A9,
- D'Bridge will spawn the UUCP mail receiver with the following command
- line:
-
- UUCP_RCV -b2400 -p1
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 110D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Security/Miscellaneous 3.16
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- Just like described in DOS BBS COMMANDS, (Section 3.9), the BAUD RATE
- and PORT NUMBER can be substituted by using a *B and *P respectively.
- It is up to the spawned task (UUCP_RCV in this case) to handle the mail
- session from this point on; it should terminate as soon as the mail is
- received and make sure that it doesn't answer any calls itself.
-
- Because of the normal operation of D'Bridge, we've restricted three
- characters: 1B (Escape), AE (Fidonet TSYNC), or F1 (WaZOO YOOHOO
- character) These three bytes may not be a part of your SYNC string.
- It is also suggested that you use bytes with high parity (Greater than
- 7F (hex)) to prevent "human" users from easily activating your alternate
- mailer.
-
- For more information on EXTERNAL GATEWAYS, or if you wish to be put in
- contact with someone already using this feature, contact D'Bridge
- Support at 1:1050/0.
-
-
-
- FIDONET PROTOCOL FOR
-
- If you want to override the default EMSI/WAZOO protocol that D'Bridge
- uses and revert to XMODEM/TELINK protocols, specify the NET/NODE filter
- here. This field should contain "NONE" in all but the strangest config-
- urations.
-
-
-
- WAZOO PROTOCOL FOR
-
- If you want to override the default EMSI protocol that D'Bridge uses
- revert to the YOOHOO-YOOHOO/2U2 handshake, specify the NET/NODE filter
- here. This field should contain "NONE" in all but the strangest config-
- urations.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 111D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Disk space minimums 3.17
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- ADVANCED: DISK SPACE MINIMUMS
- -----------------------------
-
- D'Bridge can potentially use a lot of disk space with ECHOmail, so a
- subsystem to shutdown the system certain functions if disk space becomes
- critical has been developed. Selecting the DISK SPACE MINIMUMS option
- will display the following screen:
-
-
- /-DISK SPACE MINIMUMS (in Kilobytes)-------------------------------\
- | | | | | | | |
- | Drive(s) | | | | | | |
- | | | | | | | |
- | Total space | 20708 | 20708 | | | | |
- | Free space | 2096 | 4201 | | | | |
- | Percent free | 10% | 20% | | | | |
- | | | | | | | |
- | System operation | 256 | 256 | | | | |
- | BBS operation | 512 | 512 | | | | |
- | Unpack mail | 1024 | 512 | | | | |
- | Forward ECHOmail | 2048 | | | | | |
- | | | | | | | |
- \------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next line and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- line. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
-
- SYSTEM OPERATION
-
- The system operation line specifies the minimum disk space allowed (in K)
- before D'Bridge will completely shut-down. Once shut-down, D'Bridge will
- not reactivate without human interaction. Either disk space must be
- freed, or DB SETUP must be used to change the minimum.
-
-
-
- BBS OPERATION
-
- The BBS operation line specifies minimum disk space criteria for BBS
- operation. If disk space is below specified criteria, human callers
- will be told that the BBS is offline due to disk space shortage.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 112D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Disk space minimums 3.17
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- UNPACK MAIL
-
- The unpack mail line specifies the minimum disk space required before
- a mail packet may be decompressed or unpacked. Once this limit is
- reached, all ECHOmail and NETMAIL unpacking will be halted.
-
-
-
- FORWARD MAIL
-
- The forward mail line specifies the minimum disk space required to
- forward ECHOmail messages to other systems.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 113D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Output configuration 3.18
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 3.18 ADVANCED: OUTPUT CONFIGURATION
- ------------------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge has the capability to store its entire configuration in a text
- file called an "exported configuration." This file contains lines of
- human readable text that may be changed and re-imported as an alternate
- method of configuration. Using an the exported configuration language,
- a network administrator may pre-configure D'Bridge for any number of
- remote sites.
-
-
- This option simply asks for a filename, then writes the configuration
- as a text file. This may later be used by the "DB IMPORT" option from
- the command-line.
-
-
- Every night at midnight, D'Bridge automatically exports its current
- configuration to a backup file called DBRIDGE.AUT; you may import this
- file at anytime to return the system to the configuration as of mid-
- night.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 114D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Accounting/Translation 3.18
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 3.18 ADVANCED: ACCOUNTING/TRANSLATION
- ---------------------------------------
-
-
- The Accounting/Translation screen is used to control the cost information
- as well as specify the "filter" that controls the outbound mail flow. To
- completely understand D'Bridge, you must first understand the basics of
- cost-based scheduling.
-
-
- D'Bridge comes with a cost-file as an example. This file is usually
- USA-EAST.COS, but this could differ depending on where you acquired your
- copy. The files with the extension .COS are "exported cost files" and
- contain a complete image of the ACCOUNTING/TRANSLATION screen. They can
- be used to store, merge or replace your database. When you first install
- or upgrade D'Bridge, it will automatically import DBRIDGE.COS if it
- exists; if not, it will use the first file it finds with the .COS exten-
- sion.
-
-
- When you select the Accounting/Translation option, the following screen
- will be displayed:
-
-
- Add, Change, Remove, Import, Export, UP/DOWN/PGUP/PGDN/ESC
- /-COST ACCOUNTING/PHONE NUMBER TRANSLATION------------------------------\
- |Prefix Dial as Location |
- |1 1 United States (avg) |
- |1-204 1-204 Manitoba |
- |1-305 Local (Miami/Dade) |
- |1-305-370 1-370 Davie, FL |
- |1-305-437 1-437 Pembroke Pines, FL |
- |1-306 1-306 Saskatcewan |
- |1-403 1-403 Alberta |
- |1-418 1-418 Quebec |
- |1-506 1-506 New Brunswick |
- |1-604 1-604 British Columbia |
- |1-705 1-705 Ontario |
- |1-709 1-709 Newfoundland |
- |1-807 1-807 Ontario |
- |1-808 1-808 Hawaii |
- |1-809 1-809 Caribbean |
- |1-819 1-819 Quebec |
- |1-902 1-902 Nova Scotia |
- |20 20 Egypt |
- |212 20 Morocco |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 115D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Accounting/Translation 3.18
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- When the screen first comes up, the first entry will be highlighted.
- You may scroll through the cost entries by using the UP, DOWN, PAGEUP
- and PAGEDOWN keys. The valid commands are highlighted at the top of the
- screen:
-
-
- ADD
-
- Pressing the A key enters "add" mode. You will be prompted with the
- following questions:
-
- /-Add costlist ENTRY------------------------------------------\
- | |
- | What prefix would you like to add? _____________________ |
- | |
- | |
- \-------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- PREFIX, in this case, means the first part of a phone number, the way
- in which it appears in the nodelist. The general format for a phone
- number in the nodelist is:
-
- CC-AAA-EEE-NNNN
-
- CC represents the COUNTRY CODE. For example, 20 is Egypt and 1 is the
- United States.
-
- AAA represents the AREA or CITY CODE of the system. 305 is the AREA CODE
- for Miami, FL.
-
- EEE represents the EXCHANGE (or local calling zone). D'Bridge software
- is in the 232 exchange of Miami.
-
- NNNN represents the NUMBER. D'Bridge Software's EMAIL system is 9365.
- This is rarely used for translation, but may if applicable.
-
-
- As an example, let's use the prefix 1-305-370. In our case, this number
- is within our area code (305) but not a local call. Because of the entry
- 1-305, D'Bridge would normally try to dial the 370 exchange as a local
- call. For this we need to add this prefix as a toll-call. After we
- enter the desired prefix, the following screen will be displayed:
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 116D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Accounting/Translation 3.18
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- Add, Change, Remove, Import, Export, UP/DOWN/PGUP/PGDN/ESC
- /-COST ACCOUNTING/PHONE NUMBER TRANSLATION------------------------------\
- |Prefix Dial as Location |
- |1 1 United States (avg) |
- |1-204 1-204 Manitoba |
- |1-305 Local (Miami/Dade) |
- /-ADD COSTLIST ENTRY----------------------------------------------------\
- | |
- | Prefix: 1-305-370 |
- | Dial as: 1-370 |
- | Location: Davie, FL |
- | |
- | /--------------------+-----+-----+---+----+-----------------------\ |
- | |All S M T W F T S |Start|End |NCI|Secs|Costs | |
- | |--------------------+-----+-----+---+----+-----------------------| |
- | | A S M T W T F S |23:00|08:00|NCI|60 | .19 | |
- | | M T W T F S |17:00|23:00| CI|60 | .25 | |
- | | M T W T F |08:00|17:00| CI|60 | .31 | |
- | | S |17:00|23:00| CI|60 | .31 | |
- | | S S |00:00|24:00|NCI|60 | .19 | |
- | \--------------------+-----+-----+---+----+-----------------------/ |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- The above example shows a typical translation for a toll-call within
- the same area code. When a phone number is dialed, D'Bridge will first
- translate then phone number by looking in this translation database.
- It will search for the longest match of the prefix. In this case, the
- leading 1-305-370 would be dialed as 1-370.
-
-
- Following is a description of each of the fields in the window:
-
-
- PREFIX
-
- This is the "key" to the database record. You cannot change it. If
- you must, you need to remove and add the record again. The PREFIX field
- is the first part of a phone number. (Which will be replaced with the
- DIAL AS field when a number is dialed.)
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 117D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Accounting/Translation 3.18
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- DIAL AS
-
- When phone number translations are done, the DIAL AS field will be used
- to replace the PREFIX for dialing. The DIAL AS field is actually broken
- down into two fields: PREFIX and SUFFIX. If you need to dial something
- after the number such as a credit card or billing account number, you may
- specify a SUFFIX by using a vertical pipe "|" to separate the PREFIX from
- the SUFFIX. An example would be: 1-305-370|,,3188. ",,3188" would be
- send to the modem after dialing. The two commas are a modem command
- meaning "pause a few seconds" before dialing the other digits.
-
-
-
- LOCATION
-
- This is just a description field for your information.
-
-
-
- COST/PRIORITY FILTER MATRIX
-
- The box at the bottom of the screen contains the cost information.
- In order to keep communications costs low, D'Bridge has adopted a
- system of "cost-based-control." This means that the system can be
- programmed to place all calls during the most economical periods based
- on this cost screen entirely. The cost-information for calling a given
- country or city can be acquired by calling your long-distance company.
- Typically, there are different rates on different days and at different
- times. This table allows you to specify up to 5 cost-periods for
- accounting and control purposes.
-
- When D'Bridge looks at these cost-tables, it searches from the top of
- the list to the bottom, stopping on the first match. For this reason,
- "catch-all" entries, like the one shown at the bottom of our example
- should be listed last. For flexibility and simplicity, overlapping
- periods are allowed to be defined, but D'Bridge will select the first
- applicable period for accounting and control. Please note that any
- time-ranges left undefined are assumed "free" and D'Bridge will try to
- dial out during these times. DON'T LEAVE ANY TIME-RANGE UNSPECIFIED.
-
-
-
- DAYS (All S M T W T F S)
-
- In these fields, specify for what day(s) the costing-line is applicable.
- Any non-blank character will designate a weekday.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 118D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Accounting/Translation 3.18
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- START
-
- Here, you specify the starting time of the cost period. Make sure that
- you use 24-hour time. (23:00 is 11:00 PM)
-
-
-
- END
-
- In this field, you specify the ending time of the cost period.
-
-
-
- NCI
-
- Here's the CRITICAL part to understand. During a given cost-period, you
- have the option of what priorities of mail you would like to send. In
- the NCI field, you may specify any or all of the letters N, C and I that
- designate the priorities NORMAL, CRASH and IMMEDIATE. If you list all
- three "NCI," then all priorities of mail are allowed to be sent during
- this cost-period. If you say "CI," then just CRASH and IMMEDIATE mail
- will be sent. This allows you to send NORMAL priority mail during the
- low-cost periods and higher priority mail anytime. (That's what this
- example shows.)
-
-
-
- SECS
-
- Specify the number of seconds that the COSTS field is based on. In the
- United States, this is normally "60," but other countries and/or long-
- distance carriers may have a different billing increment.
-
-
-
- COSTS
-
- The COSTS field allows you to specify the FIRST, SECOND... FIFTH "per-
- period" costs. For example, if the SECS field is set for 60, then the
- values ".31 .29" means ".31 (cents) for the first minute, .29 (cents)
- per minute after that.
-
-
- When you are finished editing the cost data, press to save it. D'Bridge
- will ask you "Save entry? (Yes/No/Change)." Specify YES to save the
- entry, NO to abort it completely or C to make changes before saving it.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 119D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: Accounting/Translation 3.18
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- CHANGE
-
- To change an existing cost entry, simply move the highlight bar to the
- desired entry and press "C." Change mode works identically to the ADD
- command described on the previous pages.
-
-
-
- REMOVE
-
- To remove an existing entry, move the highlight bar to the desired
- entry and press "R." You will be asked to confirm that you want to
- remove the entry permanently.
-
-
-
- IMPORT
-
- If you wish to IMPORT costing data from an "exported costing file," you
- may use the IMPORT option to MERGE or REPLACE the existing data. Simply
- specify the name of the COST FILE and whether to merge or replace the
- database. This is typically used to add a standard costing file (such
- as USA-EAST.COS) to your database. The MERGE option can also be used
- to simply update the existing information with newer cost data.
-
-
-
- EXPORT
-
- This option allows you to create an "exported costing file" for backup
- or transfer purposes. This is a complete "snapshot" of your costing/
- translation database stored in a standard text file. (For the format
- of the file, see section 9.3)
-
-
-
-
- NOTE: It is impossible to accurately predict the cost of any phone call
- due to timing and billing differences. It is not the intent of
- D'Bridge to give you an exact preview of your phone bill, just a
- log of what calls were made and how much they are expected to
- cost.
-
- WARNING: The cost tables included with D'Bridge are compiled from average
- costs noted from actual long-distance connections or taken from
- cost-tables. D'BRIDGE SOFTWARE MAKES ABSOLUTELY NO GUARANTEES
- AS TO THE ACCURACY OF THESE TABLES. It is up to the users to ensure
- that the costs and hours listed in the tables are correct for the
- area and long-distance carrier they are using.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 120D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: New support system 3.19
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 3.19 ADVANCED: NEW SUPPORT SYSTEM
- ----------------------------------
-
- D'Bridge has support systems located world-wide to assist you with
- using the software. With this screen, you select your PRIMARY SUPPORT
- SYSTEM and enter the phone number exactly as it would be dialed. The
- support systems are listed in NET 1050, which is pre-programmed into
- the D'Bridge nodelist. If you need to obtain a newer version of the
- EMAIL software, you may get one from any of the listed systems.
-
- Selecting the NEW SUPPORT SYSTEM option will display the following
- screen:
-
-
- /-SUPPORT SYSTEM SELECTION----------------------------------------------------\
- | |
- | The following support systems are available as of 12/15/89: |
- | |
- | 0) D'Bridge Sales and Support Miami/FL 1-305-232-9365 |
- | 11) D'Bridge Sales/West U.S. Portland/OR 1-503-292-7233 |
- | 12) D'Bridge Sales/West U.S. Portland/OR 1-503-292-7237 |
- | 13) D'Bridge Sales/East U.S. Philadelphia/PA 1-215-879-3310 |
- | 14) D'Bridge Sales/Canada Ontario/Canada 1-412-823-4521 |
- | 21) D'Bridge Sales/Europe Arnhem/Holland 31-85-459034 |
- | 22) D'Bridge Sales/Italy Civitavecchia/Italy 39-766-540-899 |
- | 23) D'Bridge Sales/UK London/UK 44-1-351-7262 |
- | 24) D'Bridge Sales/Germany Hamm/Deutschland 49-2381-460077 |
- | 25) D'Bridge Sales/Belgium Borgerhout/Belgium 32-3-8770709 |
- | 26) D'Bridge Sales/Sweden Kalmar/Sweden 46-480-14302 |
- | 31) D'Bridge Support/Australia Melborne, Australia 61-3-848-3331 |
- | 32) D'Bridge Support/Australia Melborne, Australia 61-3-563-2496 |
- | |
- | Which one would you like to use as your primary support system? 0 |
- | What phone number would you need to dial to reach it? 1-305-232-9365 |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- Select your support node from the list of valid choices. D'Bridge will
- then give you the chance to edit the phone number that will be dialed.
- This is necessary because of differences in international dialing methods
- and the possibility that calling a support node might be a local call.
- Make sure that the phone number can be dialed exactly as entered - no
- further translation will be done to your primary support system's phone
- number; is will be dialed exactly as specified here.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 121D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: ZMODEM parameters 3.20
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 3.20 ADVANCED: ZMODEM PARAMETERS
- ---------------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge allows you precise control over its ZMODEM sender by giving
- you the following matrix to maintain:
-
-
-
- /-ZMODEM PARAMETER-----------------------------------------------------------\
- | | | | | | | | |
- | Baud rates | 300 | 1200 | 2400 | 4800 | 9600 | 19200 | 38400 |
- | | | | | | | | |
- | Starting block size | 128 | 256 | 256 | 1024 | 4096 | 4096 | 4096 |
- | Maximum block size | 128 | 1024 | 2048 | 1024 | 4096 | 4096 | 4096 |
- | Recovery block size | 32 | 32 | 64 | 128 | 256 | 256 | 256 |
- | Block step rate | 4 | 4 | 4 | 4 | 4 | 4 | 4 |
- | | | | | | | | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- The cursor will appear on the top line. Fields may be changed by typing
- over the current values or by using the field edit keys: INSERT, DELETE,
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows. Pressing ENTER or the DOWN arrow advances to the
- next field and pressing the UP arrow moves the cursor to the previous
- field. You must press the ESC key to exit this window and save the setup.
- Following is a field-by-field description of this window:
-
-
-
-
- STARTING BLOCK SIZE
-
- This is the block size that will be used at the start of a ZMODEM file-
- transfer. This must be a power of two between 32 and 8192. (32, 64,
- 128, 256, 512, 1024, 2048, 4096 or 8192)
-
-
-
-
- MAXIMUM BLOCK SIZE
-
- This is the largest block size that D'Bridge will use in ZMODEM. The
- value will grow from the STARTING BLOCK SIZE to the MAXIMUM BLOCK SIZE
- using the BLOCK STEP RATE specified.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 122D'Bridge Electronic Mail System ADVANCED: ZMODEM parameters 3.20
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- RECOVERY BLOCK SIZE
-
- This is the block size to be used after an error has been reported by
- the receiver. Normally, this is less than the starting block size
- because where there is one error (phone noise) there may be another
- immediately. Making the recovery block size small reduces the amount of
- time it takes the system to recover from bad line noise.
-
-
-
- BLOCK STEP RATE
-
- When the ZMODEM sender is not receiving error reports from the receiver,
- it will increase the block size by doubling it after "x" successful
- blocks until it reaches the MAXIMUM BLOCK SIZE specified. The BLOCK
- STEP RATE is "x" or how many consecutive good blocks before increasing
- the block size. By default, D'Bridge uses a factor of 4.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 123D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge: General operation 4.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 4.0 D'BRIDGE: GENERAL OPERATION
- --------------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge is activated by typing "DB" while in the directory where it
- was installed.
-
- C> DB
-
- Assuming that the DB command was found, you quickly get the following
- display on your screen:
-
-
- IDLE: ESC-Commands D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--------------------------------------+-ACTIVITY-------------------------\
- | | |
- | | |
- | | Friday, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 D'Bridge ONLINE, 261320 bytes free | |
- |11:51 WorkRAM: 18427 bytes available | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 Storage: 4.8mb Free on drive C: | |
- |11:51 Scanning for outbound mail | |
- |11:51 0 messages scanned, 0 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 No outbound mail at this time | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | -- No outbound mail currently on hold -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- The screen may have slightly different information than this example,
- but you should get the general idea. The clock should be running and
- D'Bridge should be ready to answer a call or accept an commands from
- the operator. If the clock is stopped or you don't get this screen,
- please refer to SECTION 12.0, "Trouble?," for more information.
-
- Assuming everything looks OK, press the ESC key to display the main
- menu. D'Bridge uses a menu-structure that it quite similar to many
- of the other commercial programs available today. You can select an
- option by moving the highlight bar to the desired selection and pressing
- the ENTER key. The UP, DOWN, LEFT and RIGHT arrows will move the bar.
- Also, pressing the first letter of any option will immediately select
- that menu item.
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 124D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge: General operation 4.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- There are six menus available from the "command mode" of D'Bridge, they
- are:
-
- MAIL Controls mail events, the QUEUE window and allows you to
- issue immediate commands such as poll, file-request and
- transmit file.
-
- EDITOR Allows you to run DBEDIT, the D'Bridge message editor and
- access the configuration screens that setup the editor.
-
- UTILITIES Various utility-type functions, displays the inbound or
- outbound history, enters "terminal mode" or allows you
- to recompile the nodelist.
-
- CONFIG Selects from the eight primary configuration screens: BASIC,
- DIRECTORY PATHS, MODEM, FAX, SCHEDULE, NODELIST, PACKET/
- MAIL AND XMAIL.
-
- ADVANCED Selects from nine additional "advanced" configuration
- screens: FUNCTION KEYS, BBS, SECURITY/MISCELLANEOUS,
- DISK MINIMUMS, ACCOUNTING, IMPORT/EXPORT, SUPPORT SYSTEMS
- ZMODEM PARAMETERS and WINDOW COLORS.
-
- QUIT Allows you to EXIT, DROP or PUSH to DOS.
-
-
-
- D'Bridge is a fairly complex program and requires that someone in each
- network (usually the NETWORK ADMINISTRATOR) have a fairly complete
- understanding of its operation. This section attempts to explain how
- it works in general terms; if you are the NETWORK ADMINISTRATOR, I
- would strongly suggest reading section 6.1 of setting up a private
- network.
-
-
-
-
- SENDING AN EMAIL MESSAGE
- ------------------------
-
- As you probably understand by this point, D'Bridge can send EMAIL (text
- messages) to any system in your nodelist. To send a message, you will
- need to use the ENTER/READ EMAIL option on the EDITOR menu. Reading
- chapter 5 should give you a complete understanding of how to enter a
- message, so you should read over that chapter first. If you have
- entered a message and are wondering when it will be sent, you should
- start by understanding mail events.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 125D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge: General operation 4.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- A "mail event" is a period of time when D'Bridge is permitted to call
- other systems to transfer messages and files. There are four priorities
- which messages can have: IMMEDIATE, CRASH, NORMAL and HOLD. Unless you
- have specified your message to be IMMEDIATE or CRASH priority, your
- message will be transmitted only during a scheduled mail event. These
- scheduled mail events are time-periods specified by your NETWORK
- ADMINISTRATOR when mail is to be transferred. This could happen once
- per night, several times a day or only every few days - that's
- completely user-definable. Most likely, you will just have one mail
- event each night. In a network, all systems should use the same time-
- period for their mail events.
-
-
- Assuming that your system is properly configured, all you need to do
- to send an EMAIL message is to enter it using DBEDIT, the message editor
- (ENTER/READ EMAIL option on the editor menu) and make sure that D'Bridge
- is running overnight or whenever your scheduled mail event is. At the
- start of each event, D'Bridge will scan all of your EMAIL messages and
- determine which ones need to be sent. All the messages for a given
- destination are put into "packets" and added to the QUEUE window, ready
- to be sent. Unless some special routing information is used, your
- system will call the destination systems, send the mail and pick-up any
- mail that is waiting for you. At the same time, if you receive any mail
- from other systems, they will pick-up any mail that you were going to
- send to them, eliminating an extra phone call. At the end of the mail
- event, if D'Bridge hadn't reached any of the destination systems, it
- will quit trying and your mail won't be sent. Normally, this should
- only happen if there is a problem on the other end, or perhaps because
- you forgot to turn your modem on...
-
-
- Enough about scheduled mail - if you want to send an EMAIL message and
- you want it to be delivered immediately, then you must specify CRASH
- priority when you enter the message. All your messages entered as
- "crashmail" will be sent as soon as you leave the message editor and
- D'Bridge restarts. You may have noticed that when you first brought
- up D'Bridge, it says "Scanning for outbound crashmail." What this
- means is that every time you start it, D'Bridge looks through all your
- messages to see which ones have CRASH priority and it tries to send
- them right away - no matter what time of day it is. Needless to say,
- this feature can only be used if the destination system is ready to
- receive mail anytime. If the destination is using D'Bridge on a voice
- line and you try to send a crashmail message, it will dial the phone
- anyway, probably wasting some long distance time. (Your modem can't
- tell if a human answers the phone, it probably will just report "NO
- CARRIER.")
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 126D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge: General operation 4.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- RECEIVING AN EMAIL MESSAGE
- --------------------------
-
- This is the easy part. Assuming that your modem is connected to a
- phone line, D'Bridge can receive mail anytime it says "Waiting" in
- the ACTIVITY WINDOW. That should be anytime you are not using the
- DBEDIT message editor or using one of the configuration screens.
- When D'Bridge receives a call, it first determines if the caller is
- another compatible EMAIL system. Assuming that it is, it identifies
- the caller on the screen and proceeds to receive whatever is being
- sent - that could be messages, files or requests for files/functions.
- When the call is complete, D'Bridge unpacks the mail and you may use
- the DBEDIT message editor to read or print it. For more information
- about reading your mail, read chapter 5.
-
-
-
- SENDING OR REQUESTING FILES
- ---------------------------
-
- As was explained earlier, along with EMAIL, data files may be sent or
- received. These files could be spreadsheets, database files, graphic
- images or even programs. Any file that you can copy onto a diskette
- with the DOS copy command can be sent using D'Bridge. There are two
- ways to send or request files:
-
- - Using DBEDIT message editor, you can enter a message that has
- the FILE-ATTACH or FILE-REQUEST "flag" set. You simply enter
- the filename(s) (including subdirectory) as the subject and
- they will be sent at the same time as the message. This method
- is also called the "queued" method because D'Bridge will keep
- trying (for days even) until the file is sent or requested.
-
- - Using the TRANSMIT-FILE or FILE-REQUEST option from the MAIL
- menu. This method causes D'Bridge to immediately dial the
- destination system and send or request the file(s) specified.
- This method is not a "queued" command because the operation
- is aborted if you press the ESC key or D'Bridge is unable to
- connect with the remote system within the allowable number of
- tries.
-
- With D'Bridge, files can be transmitted at speeds that come very close
- to the highest-possible speed that data can be sent using your modem
- and computer equipment. 32-bit "CRCs" are used to ensure that the file
- arrives exactly as it was sent, though there always is that 1-in-a-
- trillion chance that an error could slip through, but since this method
- is the same as your bank uses to communicate with the "FED," odds are
- it's secure enough for your purposes too!
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 127D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge: General operation 4.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- CALLING ONLINE COMPUTER SERVICES
- --------------------------------
-
- D'Bridge also features an "terminal mode" that causes your computer
- to act as a "glass Teletype" or ANSI terminal. With this mode, you
- can use your modem to call online services such as bulletin boards,
- CompuServe<TM> and other such systems. ANSI emulation allows the remote
- system to have complete control over such functions as color selection
- and cursor positioning. This feature was provided as a simple add-on
- but is not designed to be a fancy "terminal program." It provides
- what I feel are the essential features and doesn't go much beyond that.
- D'Bridge terminal mode features:
-
- - ANSI emulation including music
- - Upload/Download with XMODEM, TELINK and ZMODEM
- - Dialing directory
- - Session capture
- - Ability to use the D'Bridge scripting language
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 128D'Bridge Electronic Mail System MAIL: Hold all mail 4.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 4.1 MAIL: HOLD ALL MAIL
- ------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Main: MAIL editor utilities config advanced quit D'Bridge
- /---------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--| HOLD ALL MAIL |-------------+-ACTIVITY-------------------------\
- | | View/Modify Queue | | |
- | | Rebuild queue | | |
- | | Poll a node | | |
- | | Transmit file(s) | | Friday, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 | File-request |bytes free | |
- |11:51 | Information display |ilable | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 | Select alias |rive C: | |
- |11:51 \---------------------/mail | |
- |11:51 0 messages scanned, 0 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 No outbound mail at this time | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | -- No outbound mail currently on hold -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- Selecting the HOLD ALL MAIL option will immediately place all outbound
- mail on HOLD. If a system has a FORCED OVERRIDE of IMMEDIATE or CRASH,
- this command will have no effect on a packet for their system. To HOLD
- mail for a FORCED node, either remove the FORCED OVERRIDE or change it
- to HOLD by using VIEW/MODIFY QUEUE, ALT-V.
-
- This command only holds mail until the next NETmail scan or next event.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 129D'Bridge Electronic Mail System MAIL: View/Modify queue 4.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 4.2 MAIL: VIEW/MODIFY QUEUE
- ----------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Main: MAIL editor utilities config advanced quit D'Bridge
- /---------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--| Hold all mail |-------------+-ACTIVITY-------------------------\
- | | VIEW/MODIFY QUEUE | | |
- | | Rebuild queue | | |
- | | Poll a node | | |
- | | Transmit file(s) | | Friday, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 | File-request |bytes free | |
- |11:51 | Information display |ilable | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 | Select alias |rive C: | |
- |11:51 \---------------------/mail | |
- |11:51 10 messages scanned, 3 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 12 packets outbound | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- |Pkt Destination Tries/Connects/Time Priorities Packet types Status|
- | 1 !150/613 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 2 107/150 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 3 3601/22 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 4 !2:512/1006 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 5 170/600 6 1 02:27 X Sent |
- | 6 !151/4 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- | 7 *373/23 0 0 00:00 H M T Hold |
- | 8 *18/68.1 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- Selecting the VIEW MODIFY QUEUE option (or pressing ALT-V from IDLE mode)
- allows you direct access to the outbound mail queue allowing you to view,
- erase or change priorities of queue entries. When you enter this screen,
- all "sent" packets are erased and the queue is renumbered. Using the
- above screen as an example, packet number 5, for 170/600 would be erased
- since it was correctly sent to its destination.
-
- The top line of the queue should be highlighted. To view or change a
- queue item, first move the highlight bar to the desired entry using the
- UP and DOWN arrows. Next select one of the following commands by
- pressing the first letter of the option (I for Immediate, etc.)
-
-
- QUEUE: Immediate, Send, Hold, Reset limits, Force, View or Kill
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 130D'Bridge Electronic Mail System MAIL: View/Modify queue 4.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- IMMEDIATE The IMMEDIATE option will change the priority of an
- entire queue entry to immediate until the next NETmail
- scan. If the queue entry is FORCED or is a unlisted
- system, this option is not valid and the computer will
- sound the "foghorn."
-
-
- SEND The SEND option will change the priority of an entire
- queue entry to crash priority. This change only lasts
- until the next NETmail scan. If the queue entry is
- FORCED or unlisted, the computer will sound the "foghorn."
-
-
- HOLD The HOLD option causes an entire queue entry to be held
- and not transmitted unless the receiving system poll for
- it. This option is not valid if there is a FORCED
- PRIORITY for the system.
-
-
- RESET LIMITS When you RESET LIMITS for a queue entry, both the number
- of TRIES and CONNECTS is reset to zero, allowing the
- queue entry to be transmitted during this event even if
- the retries limit has been exceeded.
-
-
- FORCE When you FORCE a priority for a certain system, that
- system will be forced to that priority "until further
- notice." The only way to override the FORCE is to remove
- it by specifying "NONE" here. When you press "F" for
- FORCE, a menu is displayed:
-
- FORCED MODE: Immediate, Crash, Hold or None
-
- Choose what priority to force this system to; if you don't
- want to do this, just press ESC and no change will be
- made. Select the priority or "N" to remove the "force."
- When a node is forced, it is designated by an exclamation
- point "!" next to the address.
-
-
- VIEW Viewing a queue entry lets you "look inside" a queue entry
- and see what messages and files are queued to send. Some
- general information about a system is displayed on the
- left; on the right, is a detail window which may be
- scrolled up and down by using the UP, DOWN, PGUP and PGDN
- keys. Press ESC to exit view mode.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 131D'Bridge Electronic Mail System MAIL: View/Modify queue 4.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- KILL KILL is a very dangerous option because it allows you to
- erase any or all outbound mail and requests with one extra
- keystroke. Pressing "K" will display a window asking what
- you would like to KILL. If you don't want to KILL any
- part of the entry, press ESC to cancel. Otherwise, choose
- from the menu which lets you erase everything or just one
- "part" of the queued entry. You'll have to try it to
- really understand - just be careful.
-
-
- When you are finished VIEWING and MODIFYING the queue, just press ESC
- to exit this screen.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 132D'Bridge Electronic Mail System MAIL: Rebuild queue 4.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 4.3 MAIL: REBUILD QUEUE
- ------------------------
-
-
-
- Main: MAIL editor utilities config advanced quit D'Bridge
- /---------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--| Hold all mail |-------------+-ACTIVITY-------------------------\
- | | View/Modify queue | | |
- | | REBUILD QUEUE | | |
- | | Poll a node | | |
- | | Transmit file(s) | | Friday, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 | File-request |bytes free | |
- |11:51 | Information display |ilable | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 | Select alias |rive C: | |
- |11:51 \---------------------/mail | |
- |11:51 10 messages scanned, 3 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 12 packets outbound | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- |Pkt Destination Tries/Connects/Time Priorities Packet types Status|
- | 1 !150/613 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 2 107/150 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 3 3601/22 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 4 !2:512/1006 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 5 170/600 6 1 02:27 X Sent |
- | 6 !151/4 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- | 7 *373/23 0 0 00:00 H M T Hold |
- | 8 *18/68.1 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- The REBUILD QUEUE option causes D'Bridge to erase all the packets that
- that are currently in the QUEUE window as re-scan for outbound mail.
- This is the same thing that happens when D'Bridge begins a mail event.
- This is handy for recreating packets if you had previously aborted the
- scan when D'Bridge first came up or you entered some messages in the
- editor. (There is an option to automatically re-scan NETmail after
- leaving the editor.)
-
- REBUILD QUEUE will normally create packets for all outbound mail
- regardless of whether it is CRASH priority or not; typically, all crash-
- mail will be sent, and all other mail will be on hold. This can easily
- be changed by using the VIEW/MODIFY QUEUE, ALT-V command.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 133D'Bridge Electronic Mail System MAIL: Poll a node 4.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 4.4 MAIL: POLL A NODE
- ----------------------
-
-
-
-
- /-POLL---------------------------------------------------------------------\dge
- | |002
- | Poll whom? ________________ F1-List nodes in NET 1:135 |--\
- | F2-Change ZONE:NET | |
- | F3-List all NETS | |
- | F4-List NETS in ZONE 1 | |
- | F5-Scan user names | |
- | | |
- | Priority: Normal (Normal/Crash/Immediate) | |
- | | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------------------------/ |
- |11:51 Waiting for call or event | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- |Pkt Destination Tries/Connects/Time Priorities Packet types Status|
- | 1 !150/613 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 2 107/150 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 3 3601/22 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 4 !2:512/1006 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 5 170/600 6 1 02:27 X Sent |
- | 6 !151/4 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- | 7 *373/23 0 0 00:00 H M T Hold |
- | 8 *18/68.1 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- The POLL A NODE option causes D'Bridge to call the specified system to
- pickup mail that may be on "hold" at the destination system.
- D'Bridge will simply ask you "Poll whom?" and you enter either the
- address of the system to call or the operator's name. If you enter a
- name, it will display a list of all systems with the Operator name you
- specify. (If you enter "JOE," it will display all the "Joes" in your
- nodelist and allow you to select the one you wish.
-
- If you don't know the address, five function keys (F1-F5) will aid you
- in your search. Once you have determined the system to call and pressed
- ENTER, D'Bridge will add a POLL entry to the queue with the specified
- priority. If you use IMMEDIATE or CRASH priority, the POLL will happen
- right away.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 134D'Bridge Electronic Mail System MAIL: Transmit file(s) 4.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 4.5 MAIL: TRANSMIT FILE(S)
- ---------------------------
-
-
- /-TRANSMIT FILE(S)---------------------------------------------------------\dge
- | |002
- | Send to whom: ________________ F1-List nodes in NET 1:135 |--\
- | F2-Change ZONE:NET | |
- | F3-List all NETS | |
- | F4-List NETS in ZONE 1 | |
- | F5-Scan user names | |
- | Filename(s): _______________________________________________________ | |
- | | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------------------------/ |
- |11:51 No messages to send at this time | 1:135/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 Waiting for call or event | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- |Pkt Destination Tries/Connects/Time Priorities Packet types Status|
- | 1 !150/613 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 2 107/150 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 3 3601/22 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 4 !2:512/1006 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 5 170/600 6 1 02:27 X Sent |
- | 6 !151/4 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- | 7 *373/23 0 0 00:00 H M T Hold |
- | 8 *18/68.1 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The TRANSMIT FILE(S) option gives you simple and quick way to send
- files to another system. Any file that can be copied using the DOS
- "COPY" command can be send with D'Bridge. Similar to the POLL A NODE
- command, the TRANSMIT FILE(S) option asks you for the destination
- address. Here, you may enter the address of the system or part of the
- operator's name. Once you've entered the address, D'Bridge will ask
- you for a list of files to transmit. You may enter as many files as
- you wish, one per line. Make sure that you've included the DOS sub-
- directory if they aren't in the current directory. If D'Bridge can't
- find a file, the cursor will simply be stuck on the line until you
- press ESC (to cancel the entire request), press the UP arrow or enter
- a valid (existing) DOS filename. When you're satisfied that you've
- entered the list correctly, press ENTER. You may also use the DOS
- "wildcard" characters "*" and "?" to specify a group of files to send.
-
- To use a priority other than the default, enter <FILENAME> <PRIORITY>
- in the window:
-
- C:\AUTOEXEC.BAT Immediate
- C:\BIGFILE.ZIP Hold
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 135D'Bridge Electronic Mail System MAIL: Request files 4.6
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 4.6 MAIL: REQUEST FILES
- ------------------------
-
-
- /-FILE REQUEST-------------------------------------------------------------\dge
- | |002
- | Request from: ________________ F1-List nodes in NET 1:135 |--\
- | F2-Change ZONE:NET | |
- | F3-List all NETS | |
- | F4-List NETS in ZONE 1 | |
- | F5-Scan user names | |
- | Filename(s) : _______________________________________________________ | |
- | | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------------------------/ |
- |11:51 No messages to send at this time | 1:135/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 Waiting for call or event | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- |Pkt Destination Tries/Connects/Time Priorities Packet types Status|
- | 1 !150/613 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 2 107/150 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 3 3601/22 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 4 !2:512/1006 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 5 170/600 6 1 02:27 X Sent |
- | 6 !151/4 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- | 7 *373/23 0 0 00:00 H M T Hold |
- | 8 *18/68.1 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- The FILE REQUEST option allows you to request that a remote system send
- you file(s). With a network of all D'Bridge systems, all file requests
- are really update requests. This means that if you already have a file
- and you re-request it, it will only be sent if the file size or
- date/time differ. To use the FILE-REQUEST option, simply enter the
- address of the system you wish to call (just like MANUAL POLL and
- TRANSMIT FILE(S)) and enter a list of files that you wish to receive.
- If you're not sure of the exact filenames, you may use the DOS "wild-
- card" characters, "*" and "?." After you have entered the entire list of
- files to request, press ENTER and D'Bridge will add the request to the
- outbound mail queue.
-
- To use a priority other than the default or file-request passwords, use:
-
- <FILENAME>[,<PASSWORD>] <PRIORITY>
-
- FILE1,SECRET Immediate
- FILE2 Crash
-
- Note that HOLD is not a valid priority for file-requests. Requests only
- work when you call the remote system.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 136D'Bridge Electronic Mail System MAIL: Information display 4.7
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 4.7 MAIL: INFORMATION DISPLAY
- ------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- /-INFORMATION DISPLAY---------------------------------------------------------\
- | Today Yesterday This week This month This year |
- | |
- | Calls received 26 44 70 345 754 |
- | EMAIL calls 18 29 47 214 479 |
- | BBS calls 6 6 12 80 177 |
- | GATEWAY calls |
- | Aborted calls 2 9 11 51 98 |
- | |
- | Calls placed 4 257 259 671 1,306 |
- | Connections made 2 11 13 46 82 |
- | Failed connects 3 6 |
- | Total cost 0.42 0.42 2.34 3.60 |
- | |
- | Data sent (kb) 3,229 2,809 6,308 17,589 42,041 |
- | Data received (kb) 227 95 322 777 1,453 |
- | |
- | EMAIL messages rcvd 5 5 10 36 88 |
- | ECHOmail messages 55 25 80 490 1,224 |
- | Duplicate messages 3 10 |
- | ECHOmail forwarded 44 88 132 618 1,683 |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- Press any key to continue
-
-
-
-
- The INFORMATION SCREEN, ALT-I, is automatically maintained by D'Bridge.
- It provides useful statistics about mail volume and traffic. This
- screen is for your information only; pressing any key exit this screen.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 137D'Bridge Electronic Mail System MAIL: Select alias 4.8
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 4.8 MAIL: SELECT ALIAS
- -----------------------
-
-
-
- Select the desired alias address, then press ENTER. ESC to cancel D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--------------------------------------+-ACTIVITY-------------------------\
- | | |
- | | |
- | | Friday, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 D'Bridge ONLINE, 261320 bytes free | |
- |11:51 WorkRAM: 18427 bytes available | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 Storage: 4.8mb Free on drive C: | |
- |11:51 Scanning for outbound mail | |
- |11:51 0 messages scanned, 0 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- /-SELECT ALIAS ADDRESS-\ at this time | |
- |1:18/68 |-------------------+----------------------------------|
- |1:135/68 | |
- |1:135/968 | |
- |1:1050/0 | |
- |7:48/2010 | |
- \----------------------/No outbound mail currently on hold -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- SELECT ALIAS ADDRESS, ALT-A allows you to select from your defined list
- of aliases (and entered in the BASIC CONFIGURATION screen.) Simply move
- the highlight bar and press ENTER when the desired alias is selected.
- Pressing ESC cancels the assignment. You should see an immediate change
- of the address in the activity window. Remember, if you want the mail
- packets to reflect this alias address, you'll need to rescan NETmail by
- using the BEGIN MAIL EVENT command.
-
- The alias assignment only lasts until the current event ends or the next
- one starts.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 138D'Bridge Electronic Mail System EDITOR: Read/Edit EMAIL 4.9
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 4.9 EDITOR: READ/EDIT EMAIL
- ----------------------------
-
-
-
- Main: mail EDITOR utilities config advanced quit D'Bridge
- /-------------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-LOG----------| READ/EDIT EMAIL |-+-ACTIVITY-------------------------\
- | | Setup editor parameters | | |
- | | Local/ECHOmail areas | | |
- | | Keyboard macros | | Friday, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 D'Bridg| Translation table | | |
- |11:51 WorkRAM\-------------------------/ | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 Storage: 4.8mb Free on drive C: | |
- |11:51 Scanning for outbound mail | |
- |11:51 0 messages scanned, 0 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 No outbound mail at this time | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | -- No outbound mail currently on hold -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- The READ/EDIT EMAIL option causes D'Bridge to load DBEDIT, the message
- editor. DBEDIT is a separate program and depending on how much memory
- you have available and how you have D'Bridge configured, it will either
- DROP or PUSH to the editor. PUSHing is faster, but requires more memory;
- try both options (in the SETUP EDITOR PARAMETERS screen) and see which
- you like better.
-
- DBEDIT may also be run directly from the dos prompt; it is used to enter
- and read the EMAIL messages that D'Bridge sends and receives. D'Bridge
- uses the Fidonet standard message format that is used by so many other
- EMAIL systems, bulletin boards and utilities. This will allow you to
- use a great variety of external programs such as "robot" mailers,
- form-letter generators and editors.
-
- For a complete explanation of DBEDIT, refer to SECTION 5 in this manual;
- it goes into great detail about reading, entering and responding to your
- EMAIL.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 139D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Display history 4.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 4.10 UTILITIES: DISPLAY HISTORY
- --------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Main: mail editor UTILITIES config advanced quit D'Bridge
- /------------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--------------------| HISTORY DISPLAY |TY-------------------------\
- | | Request ECHOmail link | |
- | | New ECHOmail link | |
- | | Terminal mode |iday, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 D'Bridge ONLINE, | Force nodelist compile | |
- |11:51 WorkRAM: 18427 by| Process ECHOmail | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 Storage: 4.8mb Fr| Display schedule | |
- |11:51 Scanning for outb\------------------------/ |
- |11:51 0 messages scanned, 0 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 No outbound mail at this time | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | -- No outbound mail currently on hold -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- When you select the HISTORY DISPLAY option, ALT-H, you will receive
- a menu of available history screens. Currently there are four screens
- active:
-
- Outbound mail
- Inbound mail
- Received ECHOmail
- AREAFIX log
-
- Select one of these history screens and press ENTER; press ESC to cancel.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 140D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Display history 4.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- OUTBOUND HISTORY
-
- The outbound history screen simply displays a log of all outbound mail
- calls within the last "n" days. ("n" is specified on the BASIC CONFIG
- screen, section 3.5) This display always starts at the end by showing
- you the most recent call. The UP, DOWN, PGUP and PGDN keys scroll the
- screen, ESC exits. This displays lists the date, time, destination,
- bytes sent/received, elapsed time and actual cost of the connection.
-
-
-
- /OUTBOUND MAIL HISTORY--------------------------------------------------------\
- |Date Time Sent to Sent Received E/T Cost|
- |05/11 04:36 3:632/340 Custom Programm 1,682b ---- 00:34 1.20|
- |05/11 04:42 109/706 S.O.T.A. BBS in 312b ---- 00:22 .16|
- |05/11 04:52 3:711/405 Sorcim Micros i 1,782b ---- 00:41 1.20|
- |05/11 05:06 102/450 PC Workshop in 4,952b 612b 01:07 .32|
- |05/11 05:09 105/305 Huggy's Den in 2,821b ---- 00:39 .16|
- |05/11 05:20 108/871 Point d'appui i 3,584b ---- 00:41 .16|
- |05/11 06:15 2:508/28 Words & Picture 11,370b ---- 02:31 3.60|
- |05/11 08:15 135/14 MetroFire in Mi 2,325b 40,295b 03:52 0.00|
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- INBOUND HISTORY
-
- The inbound history screen simply displays a log of all incoming mail
- calls within the last "n" days. ("n" is specified on the BASIC CONFIG
- screen, section 3.5) This display always starts at the end by showing
- you the most recent call received. The UP, DOWN, PGUP and PGDN keys
- scroll the screen, ESC exits. This displays lists the date, time,
- origin, bytes sent/received, elapsed time. Since this is inbound mail,
- there is no cost involved.
-
-
-
- /INBOUND MAIL HISTORY---------------------------------------------------------\
- |Date Time Calling system Received Sent E/T|
- |05/11 01:54 134/27 Lynx in Cochrane Alt 1,046b 119,952b 09:46|
- |05/11 02:07 107/104 TRIBECA ISC BBS in N 128b ---- 00:13|
- |05/11 02:12 11/109 Runway's End in Peor ---- ---- 00:21|
- |05/11 02:35 108/871 Point d'appui in Cin 1,792b 1,152b 00:41|
- |05/11 03:00 147/17 O.P.E.C. in Bethany ---- 1,080b 00:31|
- |05/11 03:29 2:507/115 PleasureDome in Saar 1,248b ---- 00:34|
- |05/11 03:35 343/8 Seattle Software Exc 9,170b ---- 02:01|
- |05/11 05:17 2:507/115.2 Point of PleasureDom 382b 3,274b 01:12|
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 141D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Display history 4.10
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- RECEIVED ECHOMAIL HISTORY
-
- The received ECHOmail history screen displays a log of all ECHOmail
- messages received within the last "n" days. ("n" is specified on the
- BASIC CONFIGURATION screen section 3.5) This display always starts
- at the end by showing you the most recent call. The UP, DOWN, PGUP
- and PGDN keys scroll the screen, ESC exits. This displays lists the
- date, time, destination, bytes sent/received, elapsed time and actual
- cost of the connection.
-
-
-
- /RECEIVED ECHOMAIL HISTORY----------------------------------------------------\
- |Date Time Origin Area Description Rvcd Dups|
- |05/11 17:10 105/3 DBRIDGE D'Bridge ECHO 1 0|
- |05/12 00:26 135/20 NET_DEV Network Developer's 1 0|
- |05/12 01:00 105/3 DBRIDGE D'Bridge ECHO 1 0|
- |05/12 04:46 135/20 NET_DEV Network Developer's 14 0|
- |05/12 09:40 135/20 FTSC Technical Standards 2 0|
- |05/12 12:46 135/20 NET_DEV Network Developer's 1 0|
- |05/12 12:49 107/150 DB_ALPHA D'Bridge ALPHA Conf 1 0|
- |05/12 16:17 2:512/1006 DB_ALPHA D'Bridge ALPHA Conf 1 0|
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- AREAFIX LOG
-
- The AREAFIX log screen displays a log of all automatic additions to
- your "forward-to" list in the area manager. These may be in the form
- of AREAFIX requests or manually by using the NEW ECHOMAIL LINK, ALT-N
- option. Again, the display is purged based on the parameter in the
- BASIC CONFIGURATION screen, SECTION 3.5. The function keys work as
- described previously.
-
-
-
- /AREAFIX HISTORY--------------------------------------------------------------\
- |Date Time System Area Action |
- |05/11 01:54 134/27 DBRIDGE Added/Scanned |
- |05/11 02:07 107/104 POLITICS Added |
- |05/11 02:07 107/104 Area list sent |
- |05/11 02:35 108/871 DBRIDGE Removed |
- |05/11 03:00 135/10 TBBS Added |
- |05/11 03:29 2:507/115 POLITICS Added ---- |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 142D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Request ECHOmail link 4.11
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 4.11 UTILITIES: REQUEST ECHOMAIL LINK
- --------------------------------------
-
-
- AREAFIX is a subsystem within D'Bridge that allows you to remotely
- request new ECHOmail links from a HOST or FEED system. This system,
- designed by Greg Dawson, completely eliminates the need for manual
- intervention on the part of the HOST system. Now that handling hundreds
- of ECHOmail conferences on a single system is a daily reality, this
- automated system of forwarding maintenance is required.
-
-
- /-REQUEST ECHOMAIL LINK----------------------------------------------------\dge
- | |002
- | Request from: ________________ F1-List nodes in NET 1:135 |--\
- | F2-Change ZONE:NET | |
- | F3-List all NETS | |
- | F4-List NETS in ZONE 1 | |
- | F5-Scan user names | |
- | Conference(s): _____________________________ | |
- | | |
- | Area listing? No | |
- |Get old messages? No | |
- | | |
- | Priority: Normal (Hold/Normal/Crash/Immediate) |--|
- | | |
- | ESC-Cancel request | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------------------------/d |
- | 3 3601/22 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 4 !2:512/1006 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 5 170/600 6 1 02:27 X Sent |
- | 6 !151/4 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- | 7 *373/23 0 0 00:00 H M T Hold |
- | 8 *18/68.1 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- The REQUEST ECHOMAIL LINK, ALT-R command allows you to request that a
- remote system, either START or STOP forwarding of ECHOmail conferences.
- To use this feature, you must pre-arrange a PASSWORD with the operator
- of your ECHOmail feed.
-
- First, enter the address of the system to request ECHOmail. If you
- have not established an AREAFIX password for the specified system,
- D'Bridge will ask you to assign one at this time. AREAFIX will not
- function without a security password (for good reason!) AREAFIX
- passwords may also be entered on the PACKET/MAIL CONTROL screen.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 143D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Request ECHOmail link 4.11
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Next, enter a list of CONFERENCE TAGS desired, one per line; press
- ENTER on a blank line when finished. If you wish to remove a conference
- rather than adding it, simply put a minus sign "-" before the tag.
-
- If you wish to receive a list of available ECHOmail from your ECHO link,
- answer YES to "Area listing?" If you want the host system to rescan the
- message base, sending you all the old messages, answer YES to "Get old
- messages?"
-
- Finally, choose the EMAIL priority that you wish to use to transmit the
- request. This priority has nothing to do with the priority which you
- will receive the ECHOmail - that's up to the other system operator.
-
- When the request is received by the remote system, it will add or remove
- your system from its "forward-to" list as you have specified; it will
- send you a confirmation message that will explain the changes made and
- and errors or violations you have made. This message may be sent auto-
- matically, or you may have to poll later to receive it; this depends on
- how your ECHOmail link has his system configured.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 144D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: New ECHOmail link 4.12
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 4.12 UTILITIES: NEW ECHOMAIL LINK
- ----------------------------------
-
-
-
- /-NEW ECHOMAIL LINK--------------------------------------------------------\dge
- | |002
- | Send to: ________________ F1-List nodes in NET 1:135 |--\
- | F2-Change ZONE:NET | |
- | F3-List all NETS | |
- | F4-List NETS in ZONE 1 | |
- | F5-Scan user names | |
- | Conference(s): _____________________________ | |
- | | |
- |Re-scan messages? No | |
- | Send area list? No | |
- | Priority: Normal (Hold/Normal/Crash/Immediate) |--|
- | Process now? | |
- | | |
- | ESC-Cancel request | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------------------------/d |
- | 3 3601/22 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 4 !2:512/1006 0 0 00:00 H M X Hold |
- | 5 170/600 6 1 02:27 X Sent |
- | 6 !151/4 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- | 7 *373/23 0 0 00:00 H M T Hold |
- | 8 *18/68.1 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- The NEW ECHOMAIL LINK, ALT-N command allows you to add systems to the
- FORWARD-TO list in your area manager. This command queues up the same
- type of entry as an inbound AREAFIX request with the exception of the
- security check. When a system is added or removed from an area, an
- audit trail is created in the AREAFIX LOG and a confirmation message
- is created and sent to the receiving system.
-
- First, enter the address of the system to send the ECHOmail conference(s)
- to. You do not have to have an AREAFIX password just to enter a manual
- request.
-
- Next, enter a list of CONFERENCES to add or remove, one per line; press
- ENTER on a blank line when finished. If you wish to remove a conference
- rather than adding it, simply put a minus sign "-" before the tag.
-
- If you wish to have D'Bridge rescan the entire ECHOmail area and send all
- the mail currently stored, answer YES to "Rescan?" If you wish to send a
- list of areas available, answer YES to "Send area list?"
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 145D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: New ECHOmail link 4.12
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Choose the EMAIL priority that you wish to use to transmit the
- request. This priority has nothing to do with the priority which you
- will receive the ECHOmail - that's up to the other system operator.
-
- Finally, if you want the request to be processed immediately, answer
- YES to "Process now?" If the request is not processed immediately,
- you may enter several requests then run the PROCESS ECHOMAIL option
- on the UTILITIES menu; (See SECTION 4.15)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 146D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Terminal mode 4.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 4.13 UTILITIES: TERMINAL MODE
- ------------------------------
-
-
-
- Main: mail editor UTILITIES config advanced quit D'Bridge
- /------------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--------------------| History display |TY-------------------------\
- | | Request ECHOmail link | |
- | | New ECHOmail link | |
- | | TERMINAL MODE |ay, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 D'Bridge ONLINE, | Force nodelist compile | |
- |11:51 WorkRAM: 18427 by| Process ECHOmail | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 Storage: 4.8mb Fr| Display schedule | |
- |11:51 Scanning for outb\------------------------/ |
- |11:51 0 messages scanned, 0 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 No outbound mail at this time | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | -- No outbound mail currently on hold -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- The D'Bridge terminal mode is designed to let you communicate with
- online services such as bulletin board system (BBS), CompuServe<TM>
- and other such electronic information systems. Terminal mode acts
- like a glass Teletype, having an 24x80 display plus a status line that
- gives information such as current baud rate, parity, etc. It is not
- the intention of D'Bridge to provide many terminal features such as you
- might find in other communication programs; D'Bridge is an EMAIL system
- and only provides this terminal mode as a simple means for you to tie-
- in with other systems with a direct connection.
-
- Terminal mode transmits all printable and control characters without
- translation to your modem. The ALT keys are used to control the various
- functions in terminal mode. Pressing ALT-X exits the terminal and
- returns to mailer mode.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 147D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Terminal mode 4.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- Once in the terminal mode, you will notice that pressing ALT-H displays
- a help screen. These are the commands currently supported:
-
-
- /-TERMINAL MODE COMMANDS----------------\
- | |
- | ALT-C Dial system(s) from nodelist |
- | ALT-D Dial system(s) from directory |
- | ALT-P Set terminal parameters |
- | ALT-L Capture log ON/OFF |
- | ALT-T Terminate connection |
- | ALT-W Wipe (clear) screen |
- | ALT-X Exit terminal mode |
- | ALT-Y PUSH to DOS |
- | ALT-Z DROP to DOS |
- | PgUp Upload file(s) |
- | Pgdn Download file(s) |
- | |
- \---------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- ALT-C / Call system from nodelist
-
- D'Bridge can dial any systems in your nodelist that are not "unlisted
- nodes." Pressing ALT-C will display the following window:
-
-
- /-CALL SYSTEM(S) FROM NODELIST--------------------------------------------\
- | |
- | F1-List nodes in NET 1:135 |
- | F2-Change ZONE:NET |
- | F3-List all NETS |
- | F4-List NETS in ZONE 1 |
- | Dial which node(s)? F5-Scan user names |
- | |
- | _____________________________________________________________________ |
- | |
- \-------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- Simply enter a list of addresses you wish to call, separated by spaces.
- D'Bridge will auto-dial the entire list until a connection is made. The
- function keys F1-F5 are available to assist you in locating the proper
- addresses. When a connection has been made, D'Bridge will "beep" and
- return to terminal mode with the remote system online at the proper
- baud rate.
-
-
- F1 Pressing the F1 key displays all the NODES and POINTS in the
- currently selected NET. Pressing ENTER while using this display
- selects a system; pressing ESC cancels.
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 148D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Terminal mode 4.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- F2 Allows you to change the currently selected NET by entering the
- ZONE:NET desired. After you change NETs, you can use the F1 key
- to list the systems in the new NET.
-
- F3 Gives a listing of all NETs in the entire nodelist and allows
- you to select a new NET.
-
- F4 Lists all NETs within the currently selected ZONE.
-
- F5 Scans the entire nodelist by username. (by first names)
-
- ENTER Starts the cycle-dialing window; D'Bridge will continue dialing
- until connected or aborted by the operator.
-
- ESC Cancels dialing mode
-
-
-
-
- ALT-D / Dialing directory
-
- D'Bridge terminal mode has a built-in dialing directory that allows
- you to program the phone numbers for up to 100 systems that you call
- frequently. Pressing ALT-D will display the following window:
-
-
- /-DIALING DIRECTORY---------------------------------------------------------\
- | Entry Name Phone number Baud/Parms |
- | ----- ---- ------------ ---------- |
- | 1 D'Bridge Support/Miami 1-305-232-9365 9600 8N1 |
- | 2 D'Bridge Support/West 1-503-292-7233 9600 8N1 |
- | 3 D'Bridge Support/West 1-503-292-7237 9600 8N1 |
- | 4 D'Bridge Support/East 1-215-879-3310 9600 8N1 |
- | 5 D'Bridge Support/Canada 1-416-823-4521 9600 8N1 |
- | 6 D'Bridge Support/Europe 31-85-459034 2400 8N1 |
- | 7 D'Bridge Support/Italy 39-766-540-899 2400 8N1 |
- | 8 D'Bridge Support/Austrai 61-3-848-3331 9600 8N1 |
- | 9 D'Bridge Support/Austrai 61-3-563-2496 9600 8N1 |
- | 10 |
- | 11 |
- | 12 |
- | |
- | Edit entry, Delete entry, UP, DOWN, PGUP, PGDN, #, ENTER-Dial, ESC-Cancel |
- | |
- | Command? |
- \---------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 149D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Terminal mode 4.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- You may easily enter or change numbers in this list by using the EDIT
- ENTRY command. Move the highlight bar to the entry that you wish to
- add or edit then press "E." It will display the following window:
-
-
- /-EDIT DIRECTORY ENTRY---------------------\
- | |
- | Entry number: 1 |
- | Name: D'Bridge Support/Miami |
- | Phone number: 1-305-232-9365 |
- | Baud rate: 9600 |
- | Parity: NONE |
- | Data bits: 8 |
- | Stop bits: 1 |
- | Save entry? |
- | |
- \------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- Enter the NAME, PHONE NUMBER, BAUD RATE, PARITY, DATA BITS and STOP BITS
- desired, then answer YES for "Save entry?" Pressing ESC will abort the
- change. After you have answered YES, the window will disappear and the
- entry will be permanently added to your personal dialing directory.
-
- To dial a number, simply type the ENTRY NUMBERS desired, separated by
- spaces, then press ENTER. You can also move the highlight bar to the
- desired line and press ENTER. Either will do the same thing.
-
- If you wish to use the D'Bridge scripting language, simply enter the
- phone number with the following format:
-
- "SCRIPT.FIL"aaa-nnn-nnnn
-
- Where SCRIPT.FIL is the name of your script file, aaa is the AREA CODE
- you are calling and nnn-nnnn is the PHONE NUMBER.
-
- For complete information about the scripting language see SECTION 9.0.
-
-
-
-
-
- ALT-H / Terminate connection
-
- Pressing ALT-H will terminate the current call immediately by dropping
- the DTR signal to the modem for 1.2 seconds.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 150D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Terminal mode 4.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- ALT-P / Set terminal parameters
-
- The ALT-P command will allow you to set the default settings for
- terminal mode. Pressing ALT-P displays the following window:
-
-
- /-SET TERMINAL PARAMETERS--\
- | |
- | Comm port: COM1 |
- | Baud rate: 2400 |
- | Parity: NONE |
- | Data bits: 8 |
- | Stop bits: 1 |
- | Duplex: FULL |
- | Emulation: ANSI |
- | Capture ANSI: YES |
- | AutoDownload: YES |
- | |
- \--SPACE-Change, ESC-Exit--/
-
-
- By using the UP and DOWN arrow keys to select an option and pressing
- the SPACE bar to change, you can configure the terminal to any setting
- you wish. This setting will be recalled when terminal mode is entered,
- but the communications settings can also be changed by ALT-C and ALT-D.
-
-
- COMM PORT
-
- The COMM PORT specifies which serial interface channel you wish to
- use. This could allow you to select between modems or even direct
- links to other PCs. COM1 through COM7 are allowable values.
-
-
- BAUD RATE
-
- This allows you to select the speed or BAUD RATE of the serial link with
- your modem. Allowable values are 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200 and
- 38400, but not to exceed the value specified in the COMMUNICATIONS/MODEM
- SETUP screen. If you have LOCKED your modem at its top speed, this baud
- rate setting has no effect.
-
-
- PARITY
-
- The PARITY setting allows you to communicate with systems that require
- parity-error checking. Valid settings are NONE, EVEN and ODD, but most
- newer networks are using "NONE."
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 151D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Terminal mode 4.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- DATA BITS
-
- This setting is included for compatibility with old-style 7-bit systems.
- Allowable values are 7 and 8, but be warned that file-transfers will not
- function properly with a 7-bit link.
-
-
-
- STOP BITS
-
- Almost all baud rates use 1 stop bit, but "weird" configurations might
- require a value of 2. (Highly unlikely!)
-
-
-
- DUPLEX
-
- Some older systems require that your own system provide the "echo" of
- the characters typed. This is called HALF DUPLEX. Newer systems all
- echo back the characters that you type, eliminating the need for a HALF
- DUPLEX setting. Use FULL DUPLEX for systems such as CompuServe, The
- Source and BBS networks.
-
-
-
- EMULATION
-
- D'Bridge terminal program has only one emulation, ANSI. You may either
- select ANSI or NONE. The ANSI emulation does not require the use of
- an ANSI.SYS driver; it includes full color support plus ANSI-MUSIC!
-
-
-
- CAPTURE ANSI
-
- If you have the capture log enabled, D'Bridge has the option to either
- save or strip the ANSI codes from the file. If you want to SAVE the
- ANSI codes in the capture file, answer YES here.
-
-
-
- AUTODOWNLOAD
-
- D'Bridge terminal mode has the capability to detect when the remote
- system has initiated a ZMODEM send request. If you answer YES to this
- question, when such a request is detected, D'Bridge automatically starts
- a ZMODEM receive session saving you the trouble.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 152D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Terminal mode 4.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- ALT-L / Capture log ON/OFF
-
- The ALT-L key "toggles" the capture log ON or OFF. If you wish every-
- thing that is displayed on the screen to be captured to a text file,
- press ALT-L to turn on the capture log. It will ask you for a DOS file-
- name to store the information; it defaults to CAPTURE.LOG, but you may
- change it to any directory or filename you wish. Pressing ALT-L a second
- time or exiting terminal mode will close the text file. If a capture
- file already exists, D'Bridge will add on to the end of it, preserving
- its previous contents.
-
-
-
- ALT-W / Wipe (clear) screen
-
- Pressing ALT-W simply clears the current screen, moving the cursor to
- the upper-right corner.
-
-
-
- ALT-X / Exit terminal mode
-
- Pressing ALT-X will take you out of the terminal mode and back to
- D'Bridge. Your modem will be re-initialized and should be ready
- to receive incoming mail almost immediately.
-
-
-
- ALT-Y / PUSH to DOS
-
- Pressing ALT-Y will allow you access to DOS commands while you are
- still connected to a remote system. To get back into D'Bridge, type
- EXIT. This is handy for doing directory listings, etc. while you're
- connected to an online service.
-
-
-
- ALT-Z / DROP to DOS
-
- Pressing ALT-Z will also allow you access to DOS commands. The only
- difference is that with ALT-Z, D'Bridge is totally swapped out of memory
- to EMS or disk so that you have as much free memory as possible.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 153D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Terminal mode 4.13
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- PgUp / Upload
-
- The PgUp key allows you to transmit a list of files to the host
- computer. The way to do this is typically to tell the remote computer
- that you are ready to send some files, then press the PgUp button,
- select the desired protocol, XMODEM, Telink or ZMODEM, then enter a
- list of files to send. Note: With XMODEM, you can only send on file
- at a time because it is not a batch protocol.
-
-
-
- Pgdn / Download
-
- The PgDn key allows you to receive files from the host computer. This
- is normally done by first telling the remote system what files to send
- then pressing the PgDn key. You then tell D'Bridge what protocol you
- want to use, XMODEM, Telink or ZMODEM and specify which directory to
- put the files in. With XMODEM you must specify the actual filename
- because it is not a batch protocol.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 154D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Force nodelist compile 4.14
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 4.14 UTILITIES: FORCE NODELIST COMPILE
- ---------------------------------------
-
-
-
- Main: mail editor UTILITIES config advanced quit D'Bridge
- /------------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--------------------| History display |TY-------------------------\
- | | Request ECHOmail link | |
- | | New ECHOmail link | |
- | | Terminal mode |ay, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 D'Bridge ONLINE, | FORCE NODELIST COMPILE | |
- |11:51 WorkRAM: 18427 by| Process ECHOmail | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 Storage: 4.8mb Fr| Display schedule | |
- |11:51 Scanning for outb\------------------------/ |
- |11:51 0 messages scanned, 0 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 No outbound mail at this time | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | -- No outbound mail currently on hold -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- D'Bridge will automatically re-compile the nodelist when it is started
- and realizes that there is a newer nodelist file online. Sometimes,
- however, you may wish to force it to compile, henceforth this option.
- Simple enough? By the way, for those of you who don't know, COMPILE
- means to take the nodelist in it's raw form (a text file) and translate
- it into the database that D'Bridge uses for fast access to addresses
- and user names.
-
- All of the ST. LOUIS and PRIVATES NODELISTS and your POINTLIST defined on
- the NODELIST CONFIGURATION screen need to be compiled into the database
- before they may be accessed. This process creates the files DBNODEL.DAT
- and DBNODEL.IX in the D'Bridge root directory.
-
- Compiling the nodelist may take several minutes. You may stop it at
- any time simply by pressing the ESC. If you do this, you will get a
- warning message in the LOG window reminding you that D'Bridge won't
- be able to access the entire nodelist since it didn't completely finish
- processing.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 155D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Process ECHOmail 4.15
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 4.15 UTILITIES: PROCESS ECHOMAIL
- ---------------------------------
-
-
-
- Main: mail editor UTILITIES config advanced quit D'Bridge
- /------------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--------------------| History display |TY-------------------------\
- | | Request ECHOmail link | |
- | | New ECHOmail link | |
- | | Terminal mode |ay, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 D'Bridge ONLINE, | Force nodelist compile | |
- |11:51 WorkRAM: 18427 by| PROCESS ECHOMAIL | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 Storage: 4.8mb Fr| Display schedule | |
- |11:51 Scanning for outb\------------------------/ |
- |11:51 0 messages scanned, 0 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 No outbound mail at this time | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+----------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | -- No outbound mail currently on hold -- |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- D'Bridge normally processes inbound and outbound mail automatically, so
- there's no reason to manually do it. Sometimes, you need to be able to
- force an "unpack" and "ECHOscan" because you had stopped it before or
- you had disk-space problems. Selecting this option first Unpacks and
- forwards ECHOmail, then scans all your ECHOmail areas for outbound mail
- entered locally.
-
- When D'Bridge unpacks and forwards ECHOmail, it performs three steps:
-
- 1. It scans for XMAIL packets in the inbound files directory and
- decompresses them using the appropriate program: ARC, ZIP, PAK
- or LHARC.
-
- 2. Is scans for .PKT files in the inbound files directory and
- unpacks the EMAIL messages contained within. As it unpacks each
- message, it stores it in the appropriate area, NETMAIL, ECHOmail
- or BADECHO and forwards the message to all systems listed in the
- FORWARD TO field in the specific message area.
-
- 3. D'Bridge creates outbound XMAIL packets for all forwarded ECHOmail
- and adds corresponding entries to the QUEUE window.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 156D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Process ECHOmail 4.15
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- When D'Bridge scans the ECHOmail areas is does the following:
-
-
- 1. Each ECHOmail area with Fidonet storage is scanned for new mail.
- D'Bridge uses a "highwater" mark stored in the first message so
- that it knows where it left-off scanning. All new messages found
- are forwarded to the systems designated in the specific message
- area.
-
- 2. The QuickBBS message base is scanned from the point at which the
- scanner left-off last time. This should be fairly quick unless
- you have packed the message base with an external utility. If
- D'Bridge detects that the message base is smaller than it was
- last time it scanned, it will rescan the entire base and write
- a new pointer.
-
- 3. Assuming there was ECHOmail forwarded as a result of the scan,
- XMAIL packets are created using the archive program specified
- and QUEUE window entries are created.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- /-ACTIVITY----------------------\ /-ACTIVITY-----------------------\
- | -- Unpacking EMAIL -- | | -- Scanning ECHOmail -- |
- | | | |
- | Packet: 05928572.PKT | | Area: NETSYSOP |
- | Area: DB_ALPHA | | Message: Q502 |
- | Message #: Q497 | | Scanned: 7 |
- | Unpacked: 10 | | Forwarded: 21 |
- | Forwarded: 12 | | System: 18/68.1 |
- | System: 2:520/1006 | | |
- | | | -- 97% -- |
- | | | |
- \-------------------------------/ \--------------------------------/
-
- Unpack/Forward ECHOscan/Forward
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 157D'Bridge Electronic Mail System UTILITIES: Display schedule 4.16
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 4.16 UTILITIES: DISPLAY SCHEDULE
- ---------------------------------
-
-
- Main: mail editor UTILITIES config advanced quit D'Bridge
- /------------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-LOG--------------------| History display |TY-------------------------\
- | | Request ECHOmail link | |
- | | New ECHOmail link | |
- | | Terminal mode |ay, December 15, 1989 |
- |11:51 D'Bridge ONLINE, | Force nodelist compile | |
- |11:51 WorkRAM: 18427 by| Process ECHOmail | 11:51:52 |
- |11:51 Storage: 4.8mb Fr| DISPLAY SCHEDULE | |
- |11:51 Scanning for outb\------------------------/ |
- |11:51 0 messages scanned, 0 want out | 1:18/68 waiting... |
- |11:51 No outbound mail at this time | |
- |-QUEUE------------------------------------+-SCHEDULE-------------------------|
- | | Routine Start End Status |
- | | LOCAL1 04:00 05:00 Done |
- | | NMH 05:00 06:00 Done |
- | | LOCAL2 06:00 06:30 Done |
- | -- No outbound mail currently on hold -- | AFTER 06:31 Done |
- | | |
- | | |
- | | |
- | | |
- \------------------------------------------+----------------------------------/
-
-
-
- The DISPLAY SCHEDULE option, ALT-S, simply toggles the display of the
- SCHEDULE window. Most people prefer to have this window disabled so
- that the extended QUEUE information is displayed. Press ALT-S a few
- times a decided for yourself which version you like!
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 158D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Single-key commands 4.17
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 4.17 SINGLE-KEY COMMANDS
- -------------------------
-
-
- When D'Bridge is idle, you will notice that holding down the ALT key
- displays the following help window:
-
-
- /-SINGLE-KEY COMMANDS------------------------------------------\
- | |
- | ALT-A Select alias address |
- | ALT-C Dial a system from the nodelist (Terminal mode) |
- | ALT-D Dial a system from the directory (Terminal mode) |
- | ALT-E Read/Enter EMAIL messages |
- | ALT-F Request file(s) |
- | ALT-H Display EMAIL history |
- | ALT-I Display system information |
- | ALT-N New ECHOmail link / Resend old messages |
- | ALT-P Poll a node (call to see if there is mail waiting) |
- | ALT-Q Rebuild outbound queue |
- | ALT-R Request ECHOmail link (Outbound AREAFIX request) |
- | ALT-S Toggle schedule window display |
- | ALT-T Transmit file(s) |
- | ALT-V View/Modify queue |
- | ALT-X EXIT D'Bridge |
- | ALT-Y PUSH to DOS |
- | ALT-Z DROP to DOS |
- | ALT-4 Toggle 43-line EGA mode |
- | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- With the exception of the ALT-4 and ALT-5 commands, all the keys have
- functions that are on the main menu. Pressing the ALT-KEY is just a
- time-saver; the function is identical.
-
-
-
- EGA 43-line mode / VGA 50-line mode
-
- Pressing ALT-4 (for EGA) or ALT-5 (for VGA) will toggle the screen
- display between 43- or 50-line mode and standard 25-line mode. The
- high-resolution modes can only be used if you are using an EGA or VGA
- card and monitor. Systems that process lots of mail will quickly
- learn to enjoy the extended queue display...
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 159D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT - The EMAIL message editor 5.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 5.0 DBEDIT - THE EMAIL MESSAGE EDITOR
- --------------------------------------
-
-
- The EMAIL message editor is activated by selecting the READ/ENTER EMAIL
- option from the main menu or by pressing ALT-E. The editor may also
- be accessed directly from the DOS prompt by typing:
-
- C> DBEDIT
-
-
- Assuming that the DBEDIT command was found, you quickly a display that
- is similar to the following:
-
-
-
- F1-Enter, F2-Reply, F3-Edit, F4-List, F5-Kill, F6-Areas, ESC-Menu D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-READ/EDIT EMAIL-------------------------------------------------------------\
- |Msg # 250 |
- |Date: 10 Dec 89 12:02:10 |
- |From: Chris Irwin |
- | To: Tom Ordelman on 1:1050/21 D'Bridge Sales/Europe |
- |Subj: Greetings from sunny Miami! |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- |Hello Tom, |
- | |
- |I was just writing to let you know that I've been laying out by the pool |
- |finishing the D'Bridge documentation. I think that you will find that it |
- |is well-written and quite clear. I'm going skydiving tomorrow morning, so |
- |I won't be home... Give me a call when you get a chance! |
- | |
- |Regards, |
- |Chris, 1:18/68 |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- Area: D'Bridge network mail Msgs: 273 Highest: 298 Last read: 276
-
-
-
-
- This is the "READ" mode of D'Bridge. Using this screen, you can enter,
- read and reply to messages along with a variety of utility functions.
- Each function will be described in detail in the next few sections.
- Remember that a quick way to get out of DBEDIT is to press CONTROL-C.
- This is a perfectly acceptable way to get out, it's just like using
- the QUIT menu option.
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 160D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT - The EMAIL message editor 5.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- RIGHT and LEFT arrows - NEXT and PREVIOUS MESSAGE
-
- Pressing the RIGHT arrow key will display the next message in the
- current area; pressing the LEFT arrow will display the previous one.
-
-
-
- F1 or E - ENTER A MESSAGE
-
- As soon as you press the F1 key or the letter "E" D'Bridge will go into
- "EDIT" mode, clearing the screen and starting with a blank message. For
- detailed information on "EDIT" mode, see section 5.1.
-
-
-
- F2, R, Q or > - REPLY TO A MESSAGE
-
- Replying to a message is the same as entering a new one; the difference
- is that the "TO" name and address is taken automatically from the message
- currently on the screen. DBEDIT will move the "FROM" information to the
- "TO" field. This is handy to keep from making a mistake typing the name
- or Fidonet address. There are four keys that create a reply message:
-
- F2 Asks for QUOTED or NORMAL reply.
- R Creates a NORMAL reply.
- Q Creates a QUOTED reply.
- > Same as Q.
-
- If you select a NORMAL reply, the screen will clear and just the "TO"
- and "FROM" information will be on the screen. If you specify a QUOTED
- reply, the entire message that you are replying to will be QUOTED, so
- that you may remind who you are communicating with exactly what you are
- replying to. QUOTED text has each line starting with a ">" character and
- that indicates that the text came from the other person. For example,
- if a message reads:
-
-
- What time can I call you about the pricing information?
-
-
- Your QUOTED reply might look like:
-
-
- > What time can I call you about the pricing information?
-
- Give me a call around 4:00, if I'm not in, please leave the
- information with my secretary.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 161D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT - The EMAIL message editor 5.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- QUOTED replies are quite valuable for reminding the receiver exactly
- what you're talking about. In fact, if the receiver of the above message
- wanted to reply to you, the reply might look like:
-
-
- >> What time can I call you about the pricing information?
-
- > Give me a call around 4:00, if I'm not in, please leave the
- > information with my secretary.
-
- I can't - I'm flying to Paris today. I'll call you when I
- get back.
-
-
- In this case, two quote characters ">>" mean that you have QUOTED a
- QUOTED reply. Usually, text beginning with ">>" are your own words.
- This feature is quite useful, especially when it might be several days
- before a message is read. Refer to section 5.1 for complete information
- about "EDIT" mode.
-
-
-
-
- F3 or O - EDIT AN OLD MESSAGE
-
- Sometimes, you will enter a message, then realize that you wish to make
- a change before sending it. The F3 or "O" option does just that. It
- allows you to edit the currently displayed message. If the message
- displayed is not from you, you will be asked "You didn't enter this
- message, edit anyway?" Generally, it's not "nice" to edit other people's
- mail, but D'Bridge allows you to do this anyway. Again, refer to section
- 5.1 for detailed information about "EDIT" mode.
-
-
-
-
- F4 or L - LIST MESSAGES
-
- Pressing F4 or "L" will put DBEDIT into "LIST" mode. While in "LIST"
- mode, the display changes to show you all the message headers. This
- is handy when you want to scan for a particular message quickly. Until
- you press the ESC key, DBEDIT will remain in LIST mode and the function
- keys have a different meaning. While in this mode, you may view message
- headers and select a group of messages to KILL or PRINT.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 162D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT - The EMAIL message editor 5.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- LIST: Include, Exclude, All, None, Page, Display, Group, ESC-Exit D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-READ/EDIT EMAIL-------------------------------------------------------------\
- |/-LIST MESSAGES--------------------------------------------------------------\
- ||Msg # Date From To Subject |
- || 292 20 Apr Chris Irwin Tom Ordelman 2:280/280 D'Bridge Suppor|
- || 293 20 Apr Chris Irwin Joaquim Homri 135/20 Re: ZMODEM |
- || 294 20 Apr ARCmail Sysop 107/246 FF239209.MO1 |
- || 295 20 Apr ARCmail Sysop 108/871 F98429E1.MO1 |
- || 296 20 Apr ML-UPD 1.5 11/109 Megalist Admi 000B0071.MLA |
- || 297 21 Apr Tom Ordelman 2:280/280 Chris Irwin Re: D'Bridge Su|
- || 298 21 Apr Tony Wagner 105/3 Chris Irwin Software distri|
- || |
- || |
- || |
- || |
- || |
- |\----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- Area: D'Bridge network mail Msgs: 273 Highest: 298 Last read: 276
-
-
-
-
- The first line will be highlighted with a light bar. Using the UP, DOWN,
- PGUP and PGDN keys, you can move the light bar to the desired message.
- When you press the ESC key, the specified message will be displayed and
- DBEDIT will return to READ mode.
-
-
- While the LIST window is on the screen, the following commands are
- enabled:
-
-
- I - INCLUDE
-
- When you press the I key, a star "*" will appear next to the message
- number on the highlighted line. This means that this message is
- "included" for processing by group commands.
-
-
-
- E - EXCLUDE
-
- Pressing the E key will remove a star "*" from the highlighted line.
- this is used to un-include (de-select) the current message from
- processing by the group commands.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 163D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT - The EMAIL message editor 5.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- A - ALL
-
- If you press A, all of the messages will be included for processing
- by group commands and they will all have a star "*" next to them.
- This is handy to use in conjunction with "E" (EXCLUDE) when you want
- to process most of the messages with group commands.
-
-
-
-
- N - NONE
-
- Pressing N will remove all the stars "*" from the LIST MESSAGES
- window. None of the messages will be selected for group commands.
-
-
-
-
- P - PAGE
-
- Pressing P will select all messages on the currently displayed page.
-
-
-
-
- D - DISPLAY
-
- Pressing D will toggle the LIST display between showing the TO, FROM
- and SUBJECT and showing the entire SUBJECT line.
-
-
-
-
- G - GROUP
-
- Pressing G will display another list of options called GROUP
- COMMANDS. With these commands, you can PRINT or KILL all of the
- selected messages automatically. This can be a very "dangerous"
- command, so make sure you know exactly what you're doing if you use
- it. The following GROUP COMMANDS are allowed:
-
-
- P - PRINT (group command)
-
- The P group command will PRINT all messages that have stars "*"
- next to them and were previously included while in the "LIST"
- mode. Obviously this option will work only if you have a printer
- connected; press the ESC key to cancel the PRINT operation.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 164D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT - The EMAIL message editor 5.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- K - KILL (group command)
-
- The Kill group command will KILL all messages that were included
- and have a star "*" next to them. Make sure that you have
- double-checked which messages were included because once they
- are KILLED, they are permanently gone. (Perhaps Professor Norton
- could get them back...)
-
-
-
- F5 or K - KILL A MESSAGE
-
- Pressing the F5 or "K" allows you to permanently KILL (erase) a message
- from your disk. It will ask you "ARE YOU SURE?" just in case you pressed
- it accidently; use this option with caution!
-
-
-
- F6 or A - CHANGE MESSAGE AREAS
-
- DBEDIT allows you to have any number of local and ECHOmail areas.
- Pressing F6 or "A" will display a list of all the areas that you have
- defined in your configuration. Select the desired area by moving the
- light bar up and down, then pressing ENTER when the desired area is
- highlighted. You may also enter the AREA NUMBER and press ENTER. Both
- ways accomplish the same thing. If you are running a basic EMAIL
- system, you probably will not have any use for this option.
-
-
-
- ESC - EDITOR MENU
-
- All of the other editor features are accessible by using the EDITOR
- MENU. Pressing ESC will display the menu and allow you to select any
- of the following options, described in section 5.2:
-
- - Area information
- - Display statistics
- - Forward message
- - Copy/move message
- - Print message
- - Write message to file
- - Username AKAs/Alias addresses
- - Search headers/text
- - PUSH/DROP to DOS
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 165D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "edit" mode 5.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 5.1 DBEDIT: USING "EDIT" MODE
- ------------------------------
-
-
- After you have selected either the ENTER, REPLY or EDIT command, DBEDIT
- will be in "EDIT" mode. When you are using this mode, all of the keys
- have different meanings than they do in READ mode. The top line of the
- screen lists all the valid commands. When entering a new message, the
- following screen will be displayed:
-
-
-
- F1-Abort, F2-Save, F3-Ins line, F4-Del line, F5/F6-Mark, ESC-Menu D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-ENTER NEW MESSAGE-----------------------------------------------------------\
- |Msg # 277 |
- |Date: 13 May 88 10:52:43 |
- |From: Chris Irwin |
- | To: ________________________________ |
- |Subj: |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
- F3-List users, F8-Multiple destinations
-
-
-
-
- The cursor will first appear on the "TO" field. Here, you enter the
- name of the person to whom the message is addressed. If you have
- selected the USERNAME INDEX option, (in the nodelist configuration,)
- DBEDIT scans for a username simply by entering part of the name. For
- example, if you enter "CHRIS," DBEDIT will display all of the users who
- have a first name of Chris, Christine, Christy or Christopher and allow
- you to select the desired person. This search is based on FIRST NAME, so
- entering a last name won't work.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 166D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "edit" mode 5.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- If you wish to send the same message/files to different destinations,
- press the F8 key while on the "TO" field. This will display a window
- that allows you to enter any number of destinations, one per line in
- the following form:
-
- <ADDRESS>[,<PRIORITY>] <USER NAME>
-
- ie.
-
- 1:18/68 Chris Irwin
- 2:512/1006,H Piet Raa
- 1:105/3,C Tony Wagner
-
- Valid priorities are: H - Hold
- N - Normal
- C - Crash
- I - Immediate
-
-
- If you routinely send information to the same list of systems, you will
- want to take advantage of the "distribution list" feature. Instead of
- an address and a username, you can specify the names of any number of
- distribution lists to include. A distribution list is simply a text
- file that contains the same information as above, address and username.
-
-
- After you have entered or selected the name of the person you are writing
- the message to, DBEDIT will say "on" and expect you to enter the address
- of the user. If you selected the username from the D'Bridge database,
- the address should already be there and you simply press ENTER. If you
- are entering this message to someone not in the database or have \
- specified NO to the CREATE USERNAME INDEX field in the nodelist setup,
- you will need to enter the address. DBEDIT provides 5 function keys to
- help you to find an address:
-
-
-
-
- F3 - List nodes
-
- Pressing F3 will display a list of all the systems in the currently
- selected ZONE:NET. Moving the light bar, highlight the desired system
- and press ENTER. If you can't find the address in this NET, press the
- ESC key.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 167D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "edit" mode 5.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- F4 - Change net
-
- The F4 key allows you to change the currently selected ZONE and NET
- numbers. Enter the ZONE and NET numbers desired separated by a colon
- ":" character. If you specify just one number, it is assumed to be
- the NET and the ZONE remains the same. After changing the ZONE and
- NET can use the F3 key again to scan for individual systems.
-
-
-
- F5 - List nets
-
- Pressing F5 will give you a list of all ZONE and NET numbers in your
- nodelist and allow you to choose one as the currently selected NET.
- Similar to the F6 function, move the light bar to the desired line and
- press the ENTER key.
-
-
-
- F6 - List net/zone
-
- This function is identical to F5 above except only those NETS in the
- currently selected ZONE are listed.
-
-
-
- F7 - List FAXs
-
- This will scan your FAX list by username.
-
-
-
- After you have selected the destination address, the cursor will move to
- the SUBJECT line. If you want to send a file along with this message or
- if you wish to request one, you must enter the filename(s) as the subject.
- If you are SENDING files, you must specify the actual filename including
- drive and directory. If you are requesting a file, just specify the
- filenames that you wish to receive. Obviously, if you are neither SENDING
- nor REQUESTING files, then the SUBJECT line is simply a field that briefly
- states the purpose of the message. While the cursor is on the SUBJECT
- field, the following function keys are in effect:
-
-
-
- F3 - Send file
-
- Pressing the F3 sets the FILE-ATTACH attribute for the message. This
- means that all the files listed in the SUBJECT line (labeled ENCL) will
- be sent with the message.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 168D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "edit" mode 5.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- F4 - File request
-
-
- Pressing the F4 key sets the FILE-REQUEST attribute for the message.
- This means that when the message is sent, D'Bridge will request that the
- remote system send you all the listed files.
-
-
-
- F5 - Update request
-
- The F5 key sets the UPDATE-REQUEST attribute for the message. UPDATE-
- REQUESTS are the same as FILE-REQUESTS in D'Bridge.
-
-
-
- F6 - Cancel
-
- Pressing F6 cancels a FILE-ATTACH, FILE-REQUEST or UPDATE-REQUEST and
- makes the SUBJECT line be just informational.
-
-
-
- When the cursor is BELOW the line that separates the heading from the
- message text, DBEDIT acts just like most word-processing systems. You
- may simply type in your message, using the BACKSPACE and ARROW keys to
- edit. You may notice that when you press the ENTER key, a "HARD RETURN
- SYMBOL" is generated. Normally, you should not press the ENTER key
- unless you wish to start a new paragraph or are entering a list of some
- kind that should not be "rejustified" on the receiving system. Because
- D'Bridge can communicate with other EMAIL systems and bulletin boards,
- the messages might not look exactly the same on the receiving system as
- they look on your screen when they enter it. For example, some EMAIL
- editors only allow the display of 66-column text. If you were to use
- HARD RETURNS, (by pressing ENTER on each line,) your message would be
- very hard to read on the other EMAIL system. Get in the habit of only
- pressing the ENTER key when you want to start a new paragraph.
-
- While in the "EDIT" mode, the following function keys are in effect:
-
-
-
- F1 or ESC-Q-A - ABORT
-
- If you have accidently gone into "EDIT" mode or wish to cancel your edit
- and completely "throw away" the message you are entering, use the ABORT
- option. DBEDIT will ask "ARE YOU SURE?" just to make sure that you
- didn't press F1 accidently. ABORTING your editor will return you to
- "READ" mode.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 169D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "edit" mode 5.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- F2 or ESC-Q-S - SAVE MESSAGE
-
- Pressing F2 will immediately save the current message to disk. Unless
- otherwise specified, it will be sent during the next scheduled mail
- event. If you press F2 by accident, you can always use the EDIT OLD
- option to continue or change it. SAVING your message will return you to
- "READ" mode.
-
-
-
- F3 or CONTROL-N - INSERT LINE
-
- The INSERT LINE option will add a blank line BEFORE the line where the
- cursor is located.
-
-
-
- F4 or CONTROL-Y - DELETE LINE
-
- The DELETE LINE option does just that; it erases the line that the
- cursor is on.
-
-
-
- F5/F6 - MARK
-
- This is an "advanced" feature; The F5 key marks the beginning of a block
- of text; the F6 key marks the end. "Marked" text is designated by
- reverse video for the selected block. This is used in conjunction with
- the BLOCK commands described later; they allow you to COPY, MOVE, DELETE
- or WRITE the selected block of text to a file.
-
-
-
- F10 - FLAGS
-
- D'Bridge allows you to set up to 15 different "FLAGS" on an EMAIL
- message. Pressing F10 displays a menu of all the flags; only the
- ones that are "bright" at allowed. Depending on certain criteria,
- such as FAX addressing, etc, certain options are not always available.
- The currently defined flags are as follows:
-
-
- Private This message is intended for the addressee only.
- If the receiving system is a BBS, only the Sysop
- should be able to read the message.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 170D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "edit" mode 5.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- Hold HOLD priority should be used for this message.
- Please note that unless you specify XMAIL for this
- message, the message will be sent if there is any
- other outbound traffic for the destination system;
- if you enter a CRASH message to the same system,
- both messages will be sent unless you XMAIL it.
-
- Crash CRASH priority means that the message should be
- sent right-away, even during the UNEVENT. Only
- messages with CRASH or IMMEDIATE priority will be
- sent during the UNEVENT. CRASH messages might cost
- more due to making a long-distance phone call during
- the day rather than during a late-night scheduled
- event. CRASH priority messages are also never get
- routed, but go directly to their destination.
-
- Immediate An IMMEDIATE priority message means that the message
- will be sent right away and have priority over other
- outbound traffic that is not IMMEDIATE priority.
- This is handy for getting an important message out
- when there's a lot of other outbound traffic in the
- queue.
-
- XMail If you specify that a EMAIL message be XMAIL, this
- means that the D'Bridge mail scanner will pack the
- message in an outbound XMAIL archive with the spec-
- ified archive program: ARC, ZIP, PAK or LHARC. If
- you use this method, all priorities: IMMEDIATE,
- CRASH, NORMAL and HOLD are treated separately; HOLD
- mail will never be sent unless the other system calls
- to pick it up or the operator specifically overrides
- it in the VIEW/MODIFY QUEUE, ALT-V mode.
-
- Kill/Sent If a message has the KILL/SENT flag, it will be
- erased from your NETmail area as soon as it has been
- successfully transmitted. This is good for messages
- that have been sent to multiple destinations.
-
- Archive/Sent The ARCHIVE/SENT flag causes a message to be written
- to the specified OUTBOUND MAIL ARCHIVE specified on
- the PACKET/MAIL CONTROL screen. After the message
- text has been stored in this file, the message is
- erased from the system.
-
- Direct If a message is flagged as DIRECT, the normal routing
- specified in the ADVANCED ROUTING screen of the event
- setup is ignored; the message is sent directly to its
- final destination.
-
- Use Zonegate If you wish an inter-zone message to be routed
- through the official "zonegate," use this flag.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 171D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "edit" mode 5.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- Route/HUB If you want a message to be HOST- or HUB-ROUTED,
- specify this flag.
-
- HiRes If you want to use HIGH-RESOLUTION mode for a
- FAX message, use this flag. Typically, HiRes trans-
- missions take about twice as long as normal ones.
-
- FAX Cover Not implemented in 1.30
-
- Signature Not implemented in 1.30
-
- LetterHead Not implemented in 1.30
-
- No CCs If your message has multiple destination and you
- DO NOT want D'Bridge to insert "CC" lines showing
- who received the message, use this flag.
-
-
- You can change the flags either by moving the highlight bar with the
- UP and DOWN arrows and pressing ENTER, or by pressing the first letter
- of the desired flag. Press ESC when you are finished setting message
- flags.
-
-
-
- ESC - MENU
-
- The rest of the "EDIT" mode commands are activated from the menu.
- Pressing the ESC key will display the menu.
-
-
- Editor: BLOCK ?-help quit D'Bridge
- /--------\ 1.30/001002
- /-ENTER N| Read |-----------------------------------------------------------\
- |Msg # 25| Write | |
- |Date: 10| Copy |:02:10 |
- |From: Ch| Move | |
- | To: To| Delete | on 1:1050/21 D'Bridge Support/Europe |
- |Subj: Gr\--------/om sunny Miami! |
- |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
- |Hello Tom, |
- | |
- |I was just writing to let you know that I've been laying out by the pool |
- |finishing the D'Bridge documentation. I think that you will find that it |
- |is well-written and quite clear. I'm going skydiving tomorrow morning, so |
- |I won't be home... Give me a call when you get a chance! |
- | |
- |Regards, |
- |Chris, 1:18/68 |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 172D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "edit" mode 5.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
- BLOCK: READ
-
- The BLOCK READ option allows you to read in text from a standard text
- file. It will ask for the name of a text file and whether you want to
- use HARD of SOFT returns. If the text is in the form of paragraphs, use
- the SOFT option; if you are reading in columns of numbers or some sort
- of text that you don't want to be reformatted, specify HARD.
-
-
-
- BLOCK: WRITE
-
- Assuming that you have already used the F5 and F6 keys to highlight a
- block of text, the BLOCK WRITE option allows you to write it to a stand-
- ard text file.
-
-
-
- BLOCK: COPY
-
- The BLOCK COPY option will move the text highlighted with the F5 and F6
- keys to the position where the cursor is currently located. This option
- will not work if the cursor is within the highlighted region.
-
-
-
- BLOCK: MOVE
-
- The BLOCK MOVE option is the same as the BLOCK COPY command except the
- text is actually moved rather than copied to the current cursor position.
-
-
-
- BLOCK: DELETE
-
- The BLOCK DELETE command will erase all text that you highlighted with the
- F5 and F6 keys.
-
-
-
- QUIT: SAVE
-
- The SAVE option is the same as the F2 key. It saves the current message
- and returns to "READ" mode.
-
-
-
- QUIT: ABORT
-
- The ABORT option allows you to "throw away" the current edit. This is
- the same as the F1 key.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 173D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "edit" mode 5.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- QUIT: DROP TO DOS
-
- The DROP TO DOS command allows you access to DOS while you are editing a
- message. This method frees all available memory by swapping DBEDIT to
- EMS or disk. When you are finished using DOS commands or programs, type
- "EXIT" to return to your edit.
-
-
-
- QUIT: PUSH TO DOS
-
- The PUSH TO DOS command allows you access to DOS while you are editing a
- message. When you are finished using DOS commands or programs, simply
- type "EXIT" to return to your edit.
-
-
-
- To summarize, we have included the following table of keys and their
- effect in various "edit" modes:
-
-
- Mode/field Key(s) Effect
- -------------------------------------------------------------------
- "TO" F3 List users starting with the one entered
- F8 Multiple destinations/Distribution list(s)
-
- "ADDRESS" F3 List a NODEs in the currently selected NET
- F4 Select a new ZONE and NET
- F5 List all NETs in the nodelist
- F6 List all NETs in the selected ZONE
- F7 List FAX entries
-
- "SUBJECT" F3 Send file(s)
- F4 File-request
- F5 Update-request
- F6 Cancel send/request
-
- EDITOR UP Moves the cursor up one line
- DOWN Moves the cursor down one line
- LEFT Moves the cursor left on character
- RIGHT Moves the cursor right one character
- DELETE Deletes the character under the cursor
- INSERT Toggles "insert mode" ON/OFF
- HOME Moves cursor to the start of line/page/message
- END Moves cursor to the end of line/page/message
- TAB Moves cursor to the next tab position
- BACKSPACE Moves cursor left one character and erases
- previous character if at the end of a line or
- "insert mode" is ON.
- F1 Aborts the current edit, returns to READ mode
- F2 Saves the message, returns to READ mode
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 174D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "read" mode 5.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 5.2 DBEDIT: USING "READ" MODE
- ------------------------------
-
-
- "Read" mode allows the user to read EMAIL messages in any of the defined
- message areas. There are several keys that are used control "read" mode
- with a single keystroke:
-
-
-
- UP and DOWN arrows
-
- The UP and DOWN arrow keys move the currently displayed message UP and
- DOWN on your screen allowing you to read more text than will fit on the
- screen.
-
-
- PGUP and PGDN
-
- The PGUP and PGDN keys work like the UP and DOWN arrows except they
- advance the text one page at a time.
-
-
- HOME and END
-
- The HOME key displays the first page of a message; the END key displays
- the last page.
-
-
- LEFT and RIGHT arrows
-
- The RIGHT arrow displays the NEXT message; the LEFT arrow displays the
- previous message.
-
-
- + and - keys
-
- The PLUS and MINUS keys allow you to read by "thread." If a message
- says "Reply to #nnn," you can read the original message (the one replied
- to) by pressing the MINUS (-) key. Pressing PLUS (+) displays the next
- message in the "thread." This is most useful for "local" areas and does
- not usually work in your Network mail area.
-
-
- Number keys (0-9)
-
- You can advance to the desired message simply by entering the message
- number and pressing ENTER.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 175D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "read" mode 5.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- D'Bridge allows for virtually any number of message areas to be defined
- in the area manager. While in READ mode, you may select between the
- different message areas by using the F6 or "A" command. This command
- displays the following screen that allows you to select a new message
- area:
-
-
-
- F1-Enter, F2-Reply, F3-Edit, F4-List, F5-Kill, F6-Areas, ESC-Menu D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-READ/EDIT EMAIL-------------------------------------------------------------\
- |Msg # 251 |
- |Date: 07/-AREA CHANGE-----------------------------------------------------\ |
- |From: Ch| 0 NETMAIL Network mail area | |
- | To: To| 2 COMPLAIN Complaint Department | |
- |Subj: Gr| 4 DB_ALPHA D'Bridge ALPHA conference | |
- |--------| 6 FTSC Technical standards committee |--|
- |Hello To| 7 NETDEV Network developer's conference | |
- | | 10 SYSOP18 Region 18 Sysop conference | |
- |I was ju| 11 ZMODEM ZMODEM conference | |
- |finishin| 12 ECHOECHO ECHOmail working group | |
- |is well-| 19 SYSOP135 NET 135 Sysop conference | |
- |I won't | 21 DBRIDGE D'Bridge ECHO | |
- | | 22 QUICKBBS QuickBBS ECHO | |
- |Regards,| 24 TBBS TBBS ECHO | |
- |Chris, 1| 9999 BADECHO Bad ECHOmail area | |
- | | | |
- | | | |
- | \-----------------------------------------------------------------/ |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- Change areas either by highlighting the desired area using the UP and
- DOWN arrows and pressing ENTER or by entering the TAG or NUMBER of the
- message area you desire. Pressing ESC will leave you in the same area
- you were in before.
-
- Once DBEDIT is displaying another message area, it should be displaying
- the same message as was there the last time you used that area. This is
- called the LAST READ POINTER and is maintained for each user in the
- editor separately. D'Bridge stores the LAST READ POINTERS on your disk
- so that they are the same the next time you read your mail.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 176D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Using "read" mode 5.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- To summarize, we have included the following table of keys and their
- effect in various "read" modes:
-
-
- Mode Key(s) Effect
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
- READ F1, E Enter a new message
- F2 Enter a reply to a message (see REPLY mode)
- R Enter a normal reply
- Q, > Enter a quoted reply
- F3, O Edit an old message
- F4, L Change to LIST mode
- F5, K Kill (erase) the current message
- F6, A Change message areas
- ESC Displays the main menu (advanced functions)
- LEFT arrow Displays the previous message
- RIGHT arrow Displays the next message
- 0..9 Selects message number
- ENTER Selects message or advances to the next one
- UP arrow Scrolls the message up one line
- DOWN arrow Scrolls the message down one line
- PgUp Scrolls the message up one screen
- PgDn Scrolls the message down one screen
- HOME Displays the beginning of the message
- END Moves to the end of the message
- CTL-C Leave editor
-
- REPLY F1 Enter a quoted reply
- F2 Enter a normal reply
- ESC Cancel reply
-
- LIST UP arrow Moves the highlight bar up one line
- DOWN arrow Moves the highlight bar down one line
- PgUp Scrolls the screen back one page
- PgDn Scrolls the screen forward one page
- ENTER Select current message, return to READ mode
- I Includes the highlighted message
- E Excludes the highlighted message
- A Includes all messages
- N Includes no messages (excludes all)
- P Includes all messages on the current page
- G Enters GROUP mode
- ESC Exits LIST mode, displaying the same message
-
- GROUP P Print all included messages
- K Kills (erases) all included messages
- ESC Exits GROUP mode, returns to LIST mode
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 177D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Advanced features 5.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 5.3 DBEDIT: ADVANCED FEATURES
- ------------------------------
-
-
- There are several other features available from DBEDIT; they include
- forwarding, copying, moving or printing messages, searching text and
- selecting alternate addresses or "AKA" usernames. To activate the
- EDITOR MENU, press ESC while in "READ" mode; the following menu will
- be displayed:
-
-
- Editor menu: UTILITIES SEARCH QUIT D'Bridge
- /--------------------\ 1.30/001002
- /-READ/EDIT EM| Area information |------------------------------------------\
- |Msg # 252 Wri| Forward message | |
- |Date: 07 May | Copy message | |
- |From: Chris I| Move message | |
- | To: Tom Ord| Print message |Bridge Sales/Europe |
- |Subj: Greetin| Write msg to file | |
- |-------------| New username |------------------------------------------|
- |Hello Tom, | Use alias address | |
- | \--------------------/ |
- |I was just writing to let you know that I've been laying out by the pool |
- |finishing the D'Bridge documentation. I think that you will find that it |
- |is well-written and quite clear. I'm going skydiving tomorrow morning, so |
- |I won't be home... Give me a call when you get a chance! |
- | |
- |Regards, |
- |Chris, 1:18/68 |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- Following are descriptions of all the options available from the main
- editor menu:
-
-
- UTILITIES: AREA INFORMATION
-
- The AREA INFORMATION screen functions identically to the AREA CHANGE
- function described in the previous section. The difference is that
- AREA INFORMATION displays the number of messages, last read, low and
- high message numbers in each area. D'Bridge displays the areas that
- have new, unread mail in the selected BRIGHT color. Areas which have
- new mail have the HIGHEST message different than the LAST READ. The
- information screen looks like this:
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 178D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Advanced features 5.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- F1-Enter, F2-Reply, F3-Edit, F4-List, F5-Kill, F6-Areas, ESC-Menu D'Bridge
- 1.30/001002
- /-READ/EDIT EMAIL-------------------------------------------------------------\
- /-AREA INFORMATION------------------------------------------------------------\
- |# Name Description Low High LR Msgs|
- |0 NETMAIL Network mail area 16 1477 1471 190|
- |2 COMPLAIN Complaint Department 1 1458 1458 17|
- |4 DB_ALPHA D'Bridge ALPHA conference 279 1479 1479 268|
- |6 FTSC Technical standards committee 1 295 261 295|
- |7 NETDEV Network developer's conferenc 1 107 107 95|
- |10 SYSOP18 Region 18 Sysop conference 1 479 479 402|
- |11 ZMODEM ZMODEM conference 1 29 29 29|
- |12 ECHOECHO ECHOmail working group 1 3 3 3|
- |19 SYSOP135 NET 135 Sysop conference 1 178 175 15|
- |21 DBRIDGE D'Bridge ECHO 4 1332 1332 125|
- |22 QUICKBBS QuickBBS ECHO 130 1450 1450 199|
- |24 TBBS TBBS ECHO 621 1182 1080 102|
- |9999 BADECHO Bad ECHOmail area 1 1 1 1|
- | |
- | |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- UTILITIES: FORWARD MESSAGE
-
- The FORWARD MESSAGE option allows you to re-route or send a copy of the
- current message to another system. You simply enter the TO, ADDRESS and
- specify the priority and whether to keep a the original copy of the
- message.
-
-
-
-
- UTILITIES: COPY/MOVE MESSAGE
-
- The COPY and MOVE MESSAGE commands can only be used when you have
- specified alternate message areas. It will copy or move the current
- message from one area to another.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 179D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBEDIT: Advanced features 5.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- UTILITIES: PRINT MESSAGE
-
- Assuming you have a printer connected to your "PRN" port, DBEDIT will
- print the current message.
-
-
- UTILITIES: WRITE MSG TO FILE
-
- The WRITE MSG TO FILE option allows you to export a message to a standard
- text file. This might be used to transfer data from D'Bridge to a word-
- processor or spreadsheet.
-
-
- UTILITIES: NEW USERNAME
-
- If you have defined more than one USER NAME in the SETUP EDITOR PARAM-
- ETERS menu, you can select from any of these to be the current user.
- This is the same screen that you receive when you first start the editor
- with more than one user defined.
-
-
- UTILITIES: ALIAS ADDRESSES
-
- For systems who have defined multiple ALIAS ADDRESSES on the BASIC
- CONFIGURATION menu, this function allows you to enter messages that
- are addressed from one of your aliases.
-
-
- SEARCH: HEADERS or TEXT
-
- The SEARCH HEADERS or TEXT options allow you to search through your
- messages for specific keywords. Simply enter the word to search for
- and D'Bridge will find and highlight all occurrences.
-
-
- QUIT: EXIT
-
- Terminates DBEDIT and returns to D'Bridge.
-
-
- QUIT: DROP/PUSH TO DOS
-
- PUSH TO DOS allows you to enter DOS commands and run other programs
- while DBEDIT is still in memory. Type "EXIT" to return to DBEDIT.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 180D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Understanding the queue 6.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 6.0 UNDERSTANDING THE QUEUE
- ----------------------------
-
-
- Everything D'Bridge does is based on the entries in the outbound queue
- window. Once you understand what the "queue" is and how it is organized,
- you will have a good overview of the program's structure.
-
-
- The "QUEUE"
-
- The outbound queue is a database that contains entries for each of the
- systems that has currently "outbound" mail. When D'Bridge first starts,
- the outbound queue is created by scanning the NETmail area (either in
- Fido or QuickBBS format,) then scanning the disk-based queue for polls,
- file-requests, etc. This database is then sorted by address and then
- displayed in the bottom-left window.
-
- The queue can best be understood by disabling the SCHEDULE window so
- the entire QUEUE window will be displayed. (Press ALT-S to toggle the
- schedule window on and off.)
-
-
- /-QUEUE----------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | Destination Try/Con/Bad/Online Priorities/Pkt types Status |
- |*18/68.1 0 0 0 00:00 C N X M Hold/Unlisted |
- | 105/3 0 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- | 108/0 0 0 0 00:00 N F M Decision at 17:00|
- | 135/3 30 0 0 00:00 C X Try limit |
- | 135/142 1 1 0 00:32 Sent successfully|
- | 143/18 1 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- | 167/999 0 0 0 00:00 C M Hold/Unlisted |
- | 2:243/40 0 0 0 00:00 H X Hold |
- |*8:77/7 0 0 0 00:00 N T M Hold/Unlisted |
- \----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- To understand the queue, you simply need to have a good understanding of
- the individual fields:
-
-
- DESTINATION
-
- The destination is simply the Fidonet or FAX address of the system to
- contact. The destination is not always the "ultimate" destination due
- to possible routing, but is the system to be called. If the destination
- system calls in, it can pickup the mail unless you disable that feature.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 181D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Understanding the queue 6.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- TRY
-
- The try field simply lists how many times D'Bridge has tried to call
- the destination system in the current event. If there is a plus sign
- "+" after the number, it has been manually reset this event by the
- operator.
-
-
-
- CON
-
- This field lists the number of actual connections (carrier detects) that
- are made as the result of outbound calls to the system. Inbound
- connections do not count in the CON field. Again, if there is a plus
- sign "+" after the number, it has been manually reset this event.
-
-
-
- BAD
-
- This field lists the number of failures encountered during outbound
- sessions this event. In general, a failure means that it was a wasted
- phone call for one reason or another. (Generally, the reason or error
- is listed in the log file.) Again, the plus sign after the number is
- an indication that it has been manually reset (using the ALT-V command.)
-
-
-
- ONLINE
-
- The online field keeps track of total connect time as a summation of
- all outbound connects. This field is not reset until the end of the
- current event.
-
-
-
- PRIORITIES
-
- The priorities field lists what priorities of mail are contained within
- the queue entry. This field may contain any or all of the following:
-
- I Immediate (Highest priority mail)
- C Crash (High priority mail)
- N Normal (Normal, budget priority mail)
- H Hold (Mail that is never sent; remote must pick-up.)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 182D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Understanding the queue 6.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- PACKET TYPES
-
- The packet type field contains what types of mail packets are contained
- within the queue entry. The field may contain any or all of the
- following:
-
- R Outbound AREAFIX request (ALT-R)
- T Transmit file(s) (ALT-T)
- F File-request(s) (ALT-F)
- P Poll (ALT-P)
- X XMAIL (Editor/BBS/ECHOmail)
- M NETmail (Editor/BBS)
-
-
-
- STATUS
-
- The STATUS field is most-likely the most important one to understand.
- If you are having trouble understanding why a mail packet is not being
- sent, the STATUS indication should be able to tell you exactly what is
- wrong. Please read and understand what the following status indications
- mean:
-
-
-
- Hold
-
- The mail can't be sent because "HOLD" is the only priority specified
- for the mail. (You told it to do this when you entered a message or
- set-up an ECHOmail area.)
-
-
- Hold/Unlisted
-
- This indication means that it is impossible to call this system
- because he is either not in your nodelist or his number is listed
- as "unpublished." The destination system must call in for his mail
- or you need to get a nodelist that contains his phone number.
-
-
- Max cost hold
-
- The cost of the message you want to send (as indicated in the editor)
- exceeds the maximum allowed during the current event. (See maximum
- message cost in section 3.10)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 183D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Understanding the queue 6.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- Temporary hold
-
- This means that the operator has used the VIEW/MODIFY QUEUE mode to
- set the entry's status told "hold." To send the message, select
- ALT-V again and specify "SEND."
-
-
- Forced hold
-
- This means that the operator has specified a forced priority of hold
- at some time in the past. This may be changed by using the ALT-V
- command to remove the "forced" status.
-
-
- Priority hold
-
- This means that the given mail event does not allow the specified
- priority of mail to be transmitted. (This is related to the
- PRIORITIES field in the advanced routing of the schedule; see section
- 3.10 for more information.)
-
-
- Not a CM system
-
- In this event, you have specified that only those systems with a "CM"
- (continuous mail) flag may be called. (Again, this is a function of
- the advanced routing screen of the scheduler.)
-
-
- CM not allowed
-
- In this event you have told D'Bridge not to call any "CM" system.
-
-
- Decision at 17:00
-
- This means that because of the cost-control data, no outbound call
- may be placed to this address until at least 17:00. At 17:00, a
- decision will be as to whether it may be called or not. This is
- the mechanism that allows D'Bridge to call-out only at the economical
- times for normal priority mail. If you want the mail to be sent now,
- you should use a higher priority or change the cost-control data in
- the ACCOUNTING/TRANSLATION screen.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 184D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Understanding the queue 6.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Try limit
-
- This means that D'Bridge has exceeded the maximum number of times
- allowed to try calling the remote system. Typically, you are not
- charged for non-connects, but you might want a limit on how many
- tries. (Gotta give up sometime...)
-
-
- Session limit
-
- You have reached the maximum number of sessions allowed within the
- given event. In the case of long-distance systems, this has most-
- likely saved you a wasted phone call, making too many ECHOmail calls
- in the save evening...
-
-
- Failure limit
-
- This means that you have reached the maximum failures (bad sessions)
- allowed for the event. Maybe something is wrong with the remote
- system?
-
-
- Picked up
-
- This means that all mail has been successfully picked-up by the
- remote system. This saves D'Bridge the trouble and expense of making
- the call itself.
-
-
- Sent successfully
-
- This means that you called the other system, sent the mail and all
- went well. All mail is confirmed as delivered to the "destination"
- system; remember that routed mail is now in the hands of another
- operator and is not 100% guaranteed to arrive.
-
-
- ----------
-
- The dashes (-----) mean that the packet is ready to send, now.
-
-
-
- Understanding what each of these status codes means should give you
- new insight into the operation of D'Bridge. Please feel free to contact
- technical support if there are still technical issues unclear to you;
- we'd be glad to help clarify them.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 185D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Creating a private nodelist 6.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 6.1 CREATING A PRIVATE NODELIST
- --------------------------------
-
-
- Without a nodelist, D'Bridge can not make outbound EMAIL calls. Your
- nodelist tells D'Bridge what systems it can communicate with and contains
- information such as name, phone number and baud rate. Nodelists are text
- files that can be created by any standard text editor such as EDLIN. It
- lists ZONES, NETS and NODES, one per line using the "St. Louis format,"
- the same style used by Fidonet, Alternet and many other public EMAIL
- networks. You may specify any number of St. Louis or private nodelists
- in D'Bridge. Here's a sample NODELIST for a bogus private network:
-
-
- HOST,1720,XYZ_Corporation,Miami_FL,Chris_Irwin,1-202-232-5245,2400,CM
- ,2,New_York_Office,Bronx_NY,Ron_Smith,1-202-555-9343,2400,CM
- ,4,Western_Division,Los_Angeles,Oliver_North,1-714-555-5286,2400,CM
- ,6,XYZ_Canada,Quebec,Lawrence_DeLaMouche,1-418-555-2811,2400,CM
- ,15,European_Office,Arnhem_Holland,Tom_Morrison,31-85-293845,1200
- ,20,Moscow_Bureau,Moscow_USSR,Ed_Yankowitz,!Unlisted,2400,CM
-
-
- This example defined a HOST system and 5 nodes in NET 1720. Unless
- a ZONE directive is specified, NET 1720 will be in whatever zone you
- are in. Notice the format of the text file; no spaces are allowed.
- All underscore characters "_" will be translated to spaces when the
- information is displayed. Each field is separated by commas. The
- following format is used for the "St. Louis format" nodelist:
-
-
- KEYWORD,NUMBER,NAME,CITY,OPERATOR,PHONE,BAUD,FLAGS
-
-
- KEYWORD The KEYWORD directive may be blank or contain any of the
- following values:
-
-
- ZONE The ZONE keyword marks the start of a new ZONE
- and NET (both with the same number.) It also
- defines the NODE that is the ZONE coordinator.
-
- HOST The HOST keyword defines the start of a new NET
- number and defines its HOST. (A HOST has a NODE
- number of zero.)
-
- REGION The REGION keyword is identical to HOST with the
- exception that no mail will be automatically
- routed through the "HOST" node. This is mainly
- used when the NET covers more than one geographic
- area.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 186D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Creating a private nodelist 6.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- HUB The HUB keyword defines the start of a routing
- group. A HUB acts as the HOST to receive in-
- coming mail for all nodes listed after it.
-
- PVT Defines that the listed node is private and does
- not have a listed phone number. If a system's
- phone number is not listed, this keyword MUST
- be used.
-
- DOWN Defines that the listed node is down and should
- not be added to the database.
-
-
- NUMBER This specifies the NODE number of the listed node UNLESS
- the KEYWORD is ZONE, HOST or REGION; in these cases, the
- NUMBER defines the ZONE and/or NET, depending.
-
-
- NAME Defines the name of the system. D'Bridge truncates NAMES
- to 25 characters. Underscores "_" will be translated to
- spaces for display.
-
-
- CITY Specifies the city where the system is located. Again,
- underscores "_" translate to spaces.
-
-
- OPERATOR Defines the name of the primary system operator. Under-
- scores "_" translate to spaces.
-
-
- PHONE List the ENTIRE phone number including the COUNTRY CODE,
- AREA CODE and PHONE NUMBER separated with dashes. "-"
- For example: 1-305-232-9365 or 38-52-592831
-
-
- BAUD Specify the MAXIMUM BAUD RATE for the system. May be
- either 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600 or 19200.
-
-
- FLAGS A free-form field that may contain additional information
- about the system. Include the characters "CM" if you wish
- to designate a system as CONTINUOUS MAIL, being able to
- receive EMAIL 24-hours/day.
-
-
- Pointlists are set up in the same format, with all listed nodes being
- point systems. There is no ZONE, HOST or REGION entry for a pointlist.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 187D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Duties of a network administrator 6.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 6.2 DUTIES OF A NETWORK ADMINISTRATOR
- --------------------------------------
-
-
- Every network must have an "administrator" or anarchy would certainly
- prevail! This chapter briefly outlines what duties the administrator
- of any private network should perform. Remember, these are just guide-
- lines.
-
-
-
- 1) The NETWORK ADMINISTRATOR is generally responsible for daily operation
- of the network. This means that any problems are reported directly
- to the administrator. Obviously, a very large network would sub-
- divide the support into several regional administrators who would try
- to field all problems if they could.
-
-
- 2) The NETWORK ADMINISTRATOR is responsible for the maintenance of the
- nodelist. Any systems that are added, changed or deleted must have
- these changes reflected in the nodelist and the new nodelist updates
- must be sent to all systems in the network.
-
-
- 3) The general structure and routing used in the network must be either
- designed or approved by the NETWORK ADMINISTRATOR. He must be kept
- informed of all aspects of the network so that he can "keep a handle
- on it..."
-
-
- 4) The NETWORK ADMINISTRATOR will assign NET and NODE numbers unless
- that responsibility is divided into different regions and handled
- by the regional administrators.
-
-
-
- If you have any questions on what this all means, please feel free to
- contact Technical Support for assistance.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 188D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Public amateur networks 6.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 6.3 PUBLIC AMATEUR NETWORKS
- ----------------------------
-
-
- There are a number of public amateur networks that anyone may join.
- This section lists a few of them and who to contact to participate
- in the network and ECHOmail conferencing. Each network distributes
- its own nodelist in the "St. Louis" format. After you join a new
- network, use the NODELIST CONFIGURATION screen to add the nodelist
- definition and recompile the nodelist. Here are a few networks that
- are open to new membership:
-
-
-
- Network Contact
- ------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
- FIDONET International FidoNet Association
- P.O. Box 41143
- St. Louis, Missouri 63141
- USA
-
-
- ALTERNET InterGalactic Sysop Alliance (ISA)
- P.O. Box 956
- Springfield, New Jersey 07081
-
-
- EGGNET Ken Shackelford
- EMAIL 99:99/0
- 1-404-928-1876 data
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 189D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBUTIL: The utility program 7.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 7.0 DBUTIL: THE UTILITY PROGRAM
- --------------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge comes with a utility program called DBUTIL; it allows you to
- automate routine file-transfers and maintenance. Typing DBUTIL from
- the DOS prompt will display the following "help" information:
-
-
- C> DBUTIL
-
- D'Bridge Utilities v1.30; Copyright 1988, 1989 by Chris Irwin
-
- Valid commands:
-
- [priority] SEND <Address> <file> ... <file> Transmit file(s)
- [priority] ROUTE <Address> <file> ... <file> Transmit file(s)
- [priority] REQUEST <Address> <file> ... <file> File-request
- [priority] POLL <Address> Poll
- PURGE [areaname] [areaname] ... [areaname] Purge/Archive messages
- SORT AREAS Sort message areas/group
- ERASE QUICKBASE CONFIRM Completely erase Quickbase
-
-
- DBUTIL may be run from any directory providing you have assigned the
- environment variable DBRIDGE and set a DOS PATH for the D'Bridge root
- directory. Put the following in your AUTOEXEC file (or change the PATH
- command you already have:)
-
- PATH C:\DOS;C:\DB
- SET DBRIDGE=C:\DB
-
-
-
- SEND
-
- The DBUTIL SEND command adds TRANSMIT-FILE entries to the disk-based
- queue. Files will be sent directly to the destination system with no
- routing. The syntax for the SEND command is:
-
- C> DBUTIL [priority] SEND <Address> <file> ... <file>
-
- ie.
-
- C> DBUTIL CRASH SEND 18/68.5 HOMEWORK.TXT
- C> DBUTIL HOLD SEND 18/20 DB120*.ZIP DBINST12.ZIP
- C> DBUTIL SEND MYBOSS READTHIS.TXT
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 190D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBUTIL: The utility program 7.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- ROUTE
-
- The DBUTIL ROUTE command does the same thing as the SEND command except
- that it generates a FILE-ATTACH message in the NETMAIL area. Creating
- a message allows the file to be routed if you have specified any file-
- routing in your schedule. If you are not routing files, it is faster
- and better to use the SEND option as it puts entries directly in the
- disk-based queue. The syntax for ROUTE is the same as SEND:
-
- C> DBUTIL [priority] ROUTE <Address> <file> ... <file>
-
- ie.
-
- C> DBUTIL CRASH ROUTE 18/68.5 HOMEWORK.TXT
- C> DBUTIL HOLD ROUTE 18/20 DB120*.ZIP DBINST12.ZIP
- C> DBUTIL ROUTE MYBOSS READTHIS.TXT
-
-
-
- REQUEST
-
- The DBUTIL REQUEST command adds FILE-REQUEST entries to the disk-based
- queue. The file-request will be send immediately or during the next
- applicable mail event, depending on the priority you specify. Following
- is the syntax for REQUEST:
-
- C> DBUTIL [priority] REQUEST <Address> <file> ... <file>
-
- ie.
-
- C> DBUTIL CRASH REQUEST 2:512/1006 FILES ABOUT
- C> DBUTIL REQUEST 135/14 GOODGAME.ARC MONOPOLY.ARC
- C> DBUTIL IMMEDIATE REQUEST MYBOSS UPDATE.ZIP
-
-
-
- POLL
-
- The DBUTIL POLL commands adds a POLL entry to the disk-based queue.
- Depending on the priority, the system will be called either immediately
- or during the next applicable mail event. When you POLL a system,
- D'Bridge will call to see if you have any mail waiting. The syntax for
- POLL is:
-
- C> DBUTIL [priority] POLL <Address>
-
- ie.
-
- C> DBUTIL POLL MYBOSS
- C> DBUTIL IMMEDIATE POLL 1:105/3
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 191D'Bridge Electronic Mail System DBUTIL: The utility program 7.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- PURGE
-
- The DBUTIL PURGE command will purge the specified message areas or all
- of them if you don't list any AREA NAMES. The purge will scan each
- message area and purge (and archive) the messages based on the criteria
- specified in the LOCAL/ECHOMAIL AREAS screen; see SECTION 3.2 for more
- information. The syntax for the PURGE command is:
-
- C> DBUTIL PURGE [areaname] [areaname] ... [areaname]
-
- ie.
-
- C> DBUTIL PURGE
- C> DBUTIL PURGE POLITICS SCIENCE ART
-
-
-
-
- SORT AREAS
-
- If you wish to reorganize the areas in your LOCAL/ECHOMAIL AREAS screen,
- you may use the SORT AREAS command. This will sort and renumber your
- areas by SORT GROUP and TAG. Before using this command, make sure that
- you specify SORT GROUPS for all the areas and group them together in a
- logical manner. The syntax is:
-
- C> DBUTIL SORT AREAS
-
-
-
-
- ERASE QUICKBASE
-
- If you want to completely destroy and re-create your QuickBBS message
- base, you may do it with this command. You really had better be SURE
- that you want to do this or you could lose thousands of EMAIL messages
- with this single command. The syntax is:
-
- C> DBUTIL ERASE QUICKBASE CONFIRM
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 192D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Storage: Fido, QuickBBS 7.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 7.1 STORAGE: FIDO, QUICKBBS
- ----------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge currently supports two methods for storing EMAIL messages on
- disk. These particular methods were chosen for compatibility with
- some popular bulletin board systems:
-
-
- FIDO Using the FIDO storage method, each message is stored in
- a separate ".MSG" file in a certain directory. Each fido-
- style local or ECHOmail area will have a unique sub-
- directory. This method is compatible with Fido and Opus,
- as well as many message handling utilities. FIDO storage
- usually takes the most disk space and is the slowest method
- available.
-
-
-
- QuickBBS The QUICKBBS storage method stores all messages in five data
- files: MSGHDR.BBS, MSGTXT.BBS, MSGIDX.BBS, MSGTOIDX.BBS and
- MSGINFO.BBS, all stored in the specified QuickBBS directory.
- Using this method, up to 200 message areas may be defined.
- This method is fast and doesn't use too much disk space; it
- is provided for compatibility with the QuickBBS bulletin
- board system by Adam Hudson.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 193D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using the scripting language 7.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 7.2 USING THE SCRIPTING LANGUAGE
- ---------------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge includes a powerful scripting language that allows it to use
- alternate carriers such as packet-switched networks rather than using
- normal telephone connections. This can be used with any carrier such
- as Telenet's PC-Pursuit or your private Satellite uplink service. Any
- data carrier that is capable of 8-bit, no parity, full duplex commun-
- ication can be used with D'Bridge. The reason for using an alternate
- carrier is usually to save money on your phone bill.
-
- The scripting language connects two D'Bridge systems through any form
- of data link that is compatible. In the U.S., the most common example
- for using scripts is PC-Pursuit, so I'll use that as an example. Script
- files are text-files created by any standard text editor and contains
- keywords that tell D'Bridge exactly what to do. It is important to
- have a good understanding of the carrier you intend to use before
- designing your script file; this will understand a good understanding
- of all the terms used here - it's not that simple.
-
- To use a script file, you will need to have a PHONE NUMBER TRANSLATION
- or OVERRIDE for each area code or system you intend to use. With PC-
- Pursuit, this currently requires 40 translation strings, one for each
- city served. I intend to use an indexed database in a future release
- to eliminate this necessity, but that's later. For now, use a trans-
- lation in the following format:
-
- cc-aaa- "script.fil"xxxxx-
-
- Where "cc" is the COUNTRY CODE, "aaa" is the AREA CODE, and "xxxxx" is
- the translated AREA CODE (or in the case of PC-Pursuit, the city des-
- ignator.) As an example, use the following PHONE NUMBER TRANSLATION to
- reach the Miami, Florida area:
-
- 1-305- "PCP.SCR"FLMIA-
-
- This will translate ALL 305 area codes to use the script file. Needless
- to say, not all of area code 305 is PC-Pursuitable, so if you need to
- contact other cities in our area code, you will need to specify previous
- translation or override strings. (The upcoming index file will eliminate
- the need for these translations altogether.)
-
- Assuming you now have 305 translated to use the PCP.SCR script file,
- you now must create this file and put it in your defined SCRIPT PATH.
- (SCRIPT PATH is defined on the DIRECTORY PATHS setup screen.) With
- D'Bridge, it is possible to use one script file for ALL the "pursuitable"
- cities, though you will need one for each baud rate desired. Following
- is a detailed description of the scripting language keywords and their
- meaning. (See the next chapter for a specific example and explanation
- using PC-Pursuit.)
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 194D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using the scripting language 7.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- Syntax: ABORT <start_time> <end_time>
-
- Example: ABORT 6:00 18:00
-
- The ABORT keyword causes the script to abort immediately if the time is
- between the <start_time> and <end_time> specified. This is handy for
- making sure that no script calls are made outside predefined hours.
-
-
-
- Syntax: AREACODE
-
- The AREACODE keyword causes D'Bridge to transmit the AREA CODE field of
- the phone number. This is separated from the PHONE NUMBER by a dash "-"
- and is sent with no carriage return or other characters. For PC-Pursuit,
- this is usually substituted with the city code. (such as FLMIA)
-
-
-
- Syntax: BAUD <baud_rate>
-
- Example: BAUD 1200
-
- The BAUD keyword overrides the changes the current baud rate to the
- specified value. By default, it will be the baud rate of the destin-
- ation system.
-
-
-
- Syntax: CARRIER
-
- When the CARRIER keyword is encountered, the script file is aborted
- unless a carrier is detected at this point. This is handy for ensuring
- that you have a carrier when you think you should.
-
-
-
- Syntax: COMM <config_characters>
-
- Example: COMM 7E1
-
- The COMM keyword configures the communication port for the setting
- specified. In this example, it is set for 7 data bits, even parity
- and 1 stop bit. The following <config_characters> are supported:
-
- 1 - 1 stop bit N - No parity
- 2 - 2 stop bits E - Even parity
- 7 - 7 data bits O - Odd parity
- 8 - 8 data bits
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 195D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using the scripting language 7.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- Syntax: CONNECT
-
- The CONNECT keyword sets the CONNECT count for the given packet is
- increased by one. This is used in conjunction with the maximum
- connects limit defined for the current mail event.
-
-
-
- Syntax: DIAL <phone_number>
-
- Example: DIAL 555-2939
-
- The DIAL keyword causes D'Bridge to dial the <phone_number> specified
- and wait for a CONNECT, BUSY or NO CARRIER field just like when dialing
- normally. If a non-connect message is received, the script is aborted.
-
-
-
- Syntax: DIRECT <start_time> <end_time>
-
- Example: DIRECT 6:00 18:00
-
- The DIRECT keyword will cause D'Bridge to abort the script file and dial
- direct (using your phone company) between the times specified. This is
- useful for switching between script and telephone company use depending
- on the time of day.
-
-
-
- Syntax: DOS <DOS_command>
-
- Example: DOS ibm_uucp 2400
-
- The DOS keyword is seldom used, but it enables you to execute any DOS
- command from within a script file. In this example, the program
- "IBM_UUCP" is executed with a parameter of 2400.
-
-
-
- Syntax: GOTO <label>
-
- Example: GOTO LOOP-1
-
- The GOTO keyword transfers control to another point within the script
- file. The <label> must exist and start with a colon ":" just like DOS
- batch files. Caution should be used in not creating "endless loops"
- without a TIMER statement proceeding it.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 196D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using the scripting language 7.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Syntax: IF <pattern_number> <label>
-
- Example: IF 2 GOTO SUCCESS
-
- The IF keyword transfers control to another point in the script file
- if a previously defined pattern has been detected. This is used in
- conjunction with the PATTERN keyword and uses the same label structure
- as the GOTO keyword. It is also possible for IF to cause "endless loops"
- if your script is not designed correctly, so use of the TIMER keyword
- is highly desirable.
-
-
-
- Syntax: INIT
-
- The INIT keyword causes D'Bridge to send it's standard initialization
- string to the modem. This is normally done at the beginning of every
- script, but may not be necessary.
-
-
-
- Syntax: PATTERN <pattern_number> <string>
-
- Example: PATTERN 0 BUSY
-
- The PATTERN keyword defines a pattern to look for from the remote system
- or modem. It is used in conjunction with the WAIT and IF keywords to
- act based on the response received. The <pattern_number> must be from
- 0 to 9 and the <string> may be up to 20 characters. If "PATTERN 0" is
- specified with no characters after it, pattern 0 is disabled.
-
-
-
- Syntax: PHONE
-
- The PHONE keyword causes D'Bridge to transmit the PHONE NUMBER field.
- This is sent with no additional characters such as carriage return, so
- if you want to send one, use the XMIT keyword after the PHONE keyword.
-
-
-
- Syntax: SESSION
-
- Example: SESSION
-
- The SESSION keyword is used to begin the mail session. When it is
- encountered, the script file terminates and D'Bridge starts trying
- to sync with the destination system. If there is no carrier detected
- at this point, the session will be aborted. Make sure that this is
- only used once a "CONNECT" signal is received from the remote modem.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 197D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using the scripting language 7.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- Syntax: TIMER <seconds>
-
- Example: TIMER 300
-
- The TIMER keyword sets an overriding timeout on the execution of the
- script file. This is especially handy when you have created "endless
- loops" for re-dialing within your script file. If no TIMER value is
- specified, D'Bridge will keep dialing "forever" until it gets through.
- Every time the TIMER keyword is encountered, the timer is cleared. For
- this reason, care should be taken to ensure that it is not with an
- "endless loop."
-
-
-
- Syntax: WAIT <seconds>
-
- Example: WAIT 20
-
- The WAIT keyword causes the script to wait for the specified number of
- seconds for one of the patterns (previously defined) to be received.
- If none of the patterns are received within <seconds> seconds, the
- script is aborted. The PATTERN keyword defines the pattern(s) to wait
- for.
-
-
-
- Syntax: XMIT <string>
-
- Example: XMIT HELLO|~~~52937,334|
-
- The XMIT keyword causes D'Bridge to transmit characters to the remote
- system (or your modem if not currently connected to anything.) This
- command is executed literally and there must be only one space between
- XMIT and <string> or the spaces will also be sent. There are two
- special characters used in the XMIT keyword:
-
- "|" causes a carriage return (CR) to be sent
- "~" causes a one-second delay in execution
-
-
- The script file is executed much like a program, sequentially. The
- only exception is when control is transferred to another part by using
- an IF or GOTO keyword. Any errors in the script file will only be
- found when the keyword is executed. Use the script debugging windows
- while testing scripts; these will display the communications plus what
- keywords are being executed. Activate these windows by answering YES
- to the DIAGNOSTICS? question on the BASIC CONFIGURATION screen.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 198D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Example script file 7.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- 7.3 EXAMPLE SCRIPT FILE
- ------------------------
-
-
- The following example script file is the one that Tony Wagner wrote for
- use with the PC-Pursuit service. It is currently used by a fair number
- of people with success. You will need to customize it somewhat to work
- in your city and use your own password.
-
-
- INIT
- TIMER 600
- BAUD 2400
- DIAL XXX-XXXX
- XMIT @~D~|~D1|
- :RETRY
- PATTERN 0 @
- WAIT 30
- XMIT C D/
- AREACODE
- XMIT /24,YOUR ID#|
- XMIT PASSWORD|
- PATTERN 0 CONNECT
- PATTERN 1 ONLINE
- PATTERN 2 BUSY
- PATTERN 3 RE-ENTER
- PATTERN 4 MANUAL
- PATTERN 5 NOT
- WAIT 30
- IF 2 RETRY
- IF 3 RETRY
- IF 5 RETRY
- TIMER 600
- XMIT ~|~@~|
- XMIT ~SET 1:0,7:0|
- XMIT CONT|
- XMIT |~I~|~ATZ|
- :CITY_CONNECT
- XMIT ~ATDT
- PHONE
- XMIT |
- WAIT 45
- IF 2 CITY_CONNECT
- IF 4 CITY_CONNECT
- SESSION
-
-
- The above script is a rapid-dial script that tries for a maximum of
- five minutes to connect with the desired city. Once in the city, it
- then re-dials the destination system for a maximum of five minutes.
- In theory, this script could run for a total of ten minutes.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 199D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Bulletin board systems 8.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 8.0 BULLETIN BOARD SYSTEMS
- ---------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge is designed to act as a FRONT-END for "online" programs such as
- BBS (bulletin board systems) and database systems. D'Bridge will answer
- the phone and determine in an incoming call is EMAIL or HUMAN. If it is
- an EMAIL call, D'Bridge automatically receives the mail and/or files and
- returns to the idle state. If a HUMAN call is detected, control may be
- transferred to another program such as a bulletin board system. It will
- take about 10 seconds for D'Bridge to decide a caller is HUMAN; this
- time-period can be increased if desired. If the caller presses the ESC
- key twice, D'Bridge will assume the call is HUMAN and transfers control
- immediately to the BBS.
-
-
-
- Every BBS software package is configured slightly differently, therefore
- D'Bridge needs to be flexible in the way it transfers control while the
- caller remains online. There are three basic ways of invoking your BBS
- program:
-
-
-
-
- PUSH Using the PUSH method, you simply specify a series of DOS
- commands to be executed. You may even invoke a batch file
- in this method. Only the memory that D'Bridge is not using
- will be available for the BBS. The PUSH method is designated
- by simply typing the commands in the DOS BBS COMMANDS window.
-
- ie. CD \OPUS
- OPUS OPUS -B*B -T*T
-
-
-
-
-
- DROP The DROP method is similar to the PUSH method, except that
- all available memory (except 15K) is freed, leaving almost
- all system memory free for the BBS to use. This is handy
- if you have a large D'Bridge configuration or your BBS has
- a lot of "door" programs that it spawns. The DROP method is
- designated by typing a plus sign "+" in front of the commands
- in the DOS BBS COMMANDS window.
-
- ie. CD \OPUS
- +OPUS OPUS -B*B -T*T
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 200D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Bulletin board systems 8.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- EXIT With the EXIT method, D'Bridge completely terminates, exiting
- with an errorlevel that designates the baud rate. If you use
- this method, you must be running the mailer from a batch file
- that is set up to trap the various errorlevels. To configure
- the EXIT method, specify *X on a line by itself in your DOS
- BBS COMMANDS window.
-
- ie. *X
-
- An example of a simple batch file that would work with the
- EXIT method demonstrates the setup for a 2400 baud modem.
- Note that the errorlevel returned by D'Bridge is equal to
- the BAUD RATE / 100.
-
-
- :TOP
-
- DB
-
- IF ERRORLEVEL 24 GOTO 2400BAUD
- IF ERRORLEVEL 12 GOTO 1200BAUD
- IF ERRORLEVEL 3 GOTO 300BAUD
-
- GOTO END
-
- :2400BAUD
-
- CD\OPUS
- OPUS OPUS -B2400
- GOTO TOP
-
-
- :1200BAUD
-
- CD\OPUS
- OPUS OPUS -B1200
- GOTO TOP
-
-
- :300BAUD
-
- CD\OPUS
- OPUS OPUS -B300
- GOTO TOP
-
-
- If you are not familiar with batch files and you must use
- them, see SECTION 7-26 of the IBM DOS manual.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 201D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Bulletin board systems 8.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- Every time a BBS call is detected, control is transferred to your BBS
- software by executing the commands located in the DOS BBS COMMANDS
- window. You may specify any number of DOS commands in this window that
- will be executed in sequence.
-
- Each line must contain a valid DOS command, or a D'Bridge "directive."
- If an entry begins with a plus sign, "+" the command will executed using
- the DROP method rather than the PUSH method. If you use DROP, D'Bridge
- will be entirely swapped out of memory (except 15K) allowing the called
- program almost all the free memory in the environment. This is nice for
- running BBS programs that have "door" utilities. The DROP method takes
- longer to execute than the PUSH method. D'Bridge memory is swapped to
- either EMS or DISK.
-
- Following is an example of how I run the QuickBBS bulletin board:
-
- CD \QUICKBBS
- +QUICKBBS -b*b -t*t -e0
-
- Any entries with an asterisk "*" will be treated as D'Bridge directives
- or substitutions. When the above DOS BBS COMMANDS are executed, the
- following is an example of the actual DOS commands issued:
-
- CD \QUICKBBS
- QUICKBBS -b2400 -t126 -e0
-
-
- Following is a description of the D'Bridge directives available:
-
- *B Substituted with the actual BAUD RATE of the connection.
-
- *C Substituted with the actual connect string returned from
- the modem. This may be translated to any string you wish
- by using the "CONNECT" COMMANDS field of the COMMUNICATION/
- MODEM SETUP screen.
-
- *H If specified, leaves the FOSSIL "HOT" or initialized.
-
-
- *P Returns the COMM PORT that D'Bridge is currently using.
- This may be from 1 to 7.
-
- *R Causes a NETMAIL rescan to occur after each BBS call.
-
- *S Causes an ECHOmail scan to occur after each BBS call.
-
- *T Substituted by the number of minutes until the next event.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 202D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Bulletin board systems 8.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- *X Exit D'Bridge with an errorlevel of the baud rate divided
- by 100. (3,12,24,48,96) If you use this method, (which is
- not suggested,) you will need to write a batch file like
- the one described on the preceding page.
-
- *Xnnn Exit D'Bridge with the specified errorlevel. If you use
- this method, you must be using some alternate method to
- pass the baud rate to the system.
-
-
-
- Any DOS command with the exception of EXIT, PROMPT and SET will work
- in the DOS BBS COMMANDS window. Changing directories is allowed;
- D'Bridge will automatically switch back to the DB root directory
- when the commands are finished. You do not have to specifically
- change directories after the BBS call.
-
-
- In the following SECTIONS, setups for certain popular bulletin board
- systems are described in detail. If you see any problems with the
- configurations we have set up, please let us know so that we can
- make a correction in future versions of this manual. As always,
- your suggestions are welcomed in order to make D'Bridge a better
- product for all its users.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 203D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using Wildcat BBS 8.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 8.1 USING WILDCAT BBS
- ----------------------
-
-
- Wildcat bulletin board system is available from Mustang Software; it is
- an excellent menu-driven BBS that runs well with D'Bridge. In order to
- configure Wildcat and D'Bridge together, follow these steps:
-
-
-
- 1) Configure Wildcat's MODEM INFORMATION screen as follows. This uses
- the US Robotics HST as an example. If you use a different modem,
- the parameters may vary. Leave all the initialization fields blank
- or Wildcat will send the strings to the modem. Wildcat receives the
- caller already online after D'Bridge answers the call.
-
-
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | MODEM INFORMATION - Part 1 Frame 3 |
- | |
- | 1. Which Communications Port do you want to use [ 1 .. 4 ] ? 1 |
- | 2. Maximum # of seconds to wait for carrier [ S7 Register ] ? 1 |
- | 3. Enter the string to reset your modem: |
- | 4. Enter Modem Startup String #1: |
- | |
- | 5. Enter Modem Startup String #2: |
- | |
- | 6. Enter Modem Startup String #3: |
- | |
- | 7. Enter the string to reinitialize your modem after every call: |
- | |
- | 8. Modem Delays in Milliseconds: |
- | #1: 1 #2: 1 #3: 1 |
- | 9. Initialize your modem port at which baud rate [ 300..19200 ] ? 19200 |
- | 10. Lock the DTE setting at the initialized baud rate [Y/N] ? Y |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 204D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using Wildcat BBS 8.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 2) Wildcat has certain protocols that may only be used if there is an
- error-correcting connection. If you have a modem with MNP, it should
- return a different response string such as MNP, ARQ or RELIABLE.
- D'Bridge needs to translate this code into a string that Wildcat
- will understand. Again, this example uses the HST modem; if you
- do not have an error-correcting modem, this setup is acceptable.
- Configure the "CONNECT" COMMANDS field on the COMMUNICATION MODEM
- SETUP screen:
-
- /-------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | "CONNECT" commands: 9600 CONNECT 9600|9600 |
- | 2400 CONNECT 2400|2400 |
- | 1200 CONNECT 1200|1200 |
- | 300 CONNECT|300 |
- | 9600 CONNECT 9600/ARQ|9600MNP |
- | 2400 CONNECT 2400/ARQ|2400MNP |
- | 1200 CONNECT 1200/ARQ|1200MNP |
- \-------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- 3) There are two ways to setup Wildcat under D'Bridge:
-
-
- OPTION "A" - Spawn a batch file using the DROP method
-
- With the DROP method, D'Bridge swaps almost all its used RAM to
- EMS or disk, then "spawns" a batch file that invokes Wildcat.
- If you have available EMS or a fast disk, this is a good method
- to use:
-
-
- a) Enter the following in the DOS BBS COMMANDS window on the
- BBS CONFIGURATION screen:
-
- /--------------------------------------------------------\
- | DOS commands for BBS: +CAT.BAT *C |
- | |
- | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- b) Create a batch file called CAT.BAT in the D'Bridge root
- directory. Use the following as an example:
-
- IF 1==%live% GOTO RETURNCAT
-
- :WILDCAT
- SET LIVE=
- C:
- CD \WC
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 205D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using Wildcat BBS 8.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
- REM If you want to pass the time to the next event to
- REM Wildcat add a %2 after the %1
- Wildcat /B %1
- IF ERRORLEVEL 60 GOTO END
- IF ERRORLEVEL 35 goto QBBSMAIL
- GOTO END
-
- :RETURNCAT
- C:
- CD \WC
- SET live=
- Wildcat
- IF ERRORLEVEL 60 GOTO END
- IF ERRORLEVEL 35 goto QBBSMAIL
- GOTO END
-
- :QBBSMAIL
- C:
- CD \QUICKBBS
- WC2QBBS C:\WC\CALLINFO.BBS
- QUICKBBS -R -e0
- GOTO RETURNCAT
-
- END:
- EXIT
-
-
-
-
- OPTION "B" - Run D'Bridge from a batch file and EXIT
-
- With the EXIT method, D'Bridge is completely removed from memory
- when Wildcat takes control. This method requires that D'Bridge
- be run from a batch file. Following is a description of how to
- configure the software for this method:
-
-
-
- a) Enter the following in the DOS BBS COMMANDS window on the
- BBS CONFIGURATION screen:
-
- /--------------------------------------------------------\
- | DOS commands for BBS: ECHO SET baud=*C >BBS.BAT |
- | ECHO SET live=2 >>BBS.BAT |
- | ECHO RUN-DB.BAT >>BBS.BAT |
- | *X96 |
- \--------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 206D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using Wildcat BBS 8.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- b) Create a batch file called RUN-DB.BAT using the following
- model as an example. Start D'Bridge by using this batch
- file, most-likely by calling it directly from AUTOEXEC.BAT:
-
-
- ECHO OFF
- :START
- CLS
-
- IF 1==%live% GOTO RETURNCAT
- IF 2==%live% GOTO WILDCAT
- SET LIVE=
- SET BAUD=
- C:
- CD \DB
- DB
- IF ERRORLEVEL 96 GOTO LOADBBS
- GOTO END
-
- :WILDCAT
- SET live=
- C:
- CD \WC
- Wildcat /B %baud%
- IF ERRORLEVEL 35 GOTO QBBSMAIL
- GOTO START
-
- :LOADBBS
- BBS.BAT
-
- :RETURNCAT
- C:
- CD \WC
- SET live=
- Wildcat
- IF ERRORLEVEL 35 GOTO QBBSMAIL
- GOTO START
-
- :QBBSMAIL
- C:
- CD \QUICKBBS
- WC2QBBS C:\WC\CALLINFO.BBS
- QUICKBBS -R -e0
- GOTO RETURNCAT
-
- END:
- EXIT
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 207D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using TBBS 8.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- 8.2 USING TBBS
- ---------------
-
-
- TBBS is a very popular commercial bulletin board system available from
- eSoft.
-
- Current versions of TBBS are designed to work with the SEAdog electronic
- mail system by System Enhancement Associates. For TBBS users to enter
- NETmail, a SEAdog-style nodelist is required; D'Bridge does not create
- a compatible nodelist format. You must either use SEAdog's utilities or
- a third-party nodelist processor to create this list. It is not our
- intention of supporting multiple nodelist formats.
-
- There are two versions of TBBS: Single- and multi-line. Both versions
- use the same file formats, but only the Single-line version is capable
- of using D'Bridge as a front-end mailer. If you wish to use the multi-
- line version of TBBS, you will have to run D'Bridge for nightly mail
- events and transfer mail only during designated times. The configuration
- of D'Bridge is different for bother versions of TBBS.
-
-
- We'll describe the configuration, step-by-step:
-
-
- If you are using the TBBS MULTI-LINE version perform the following
- steps:
-
-
- a) Using a standard text editor such as EDLIN, create a
- batch file similar to the following:
-
- :TOP
- C:
- CD \TBBS
- MLTBBS /U
- IF ERRORLEVEL 25 GOTO MAILER
- GOTO END
-
- :MAILER
- CD \DB
- DB
- GOTO TOP
-
- :END
- EXIT
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 208D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using TBBS 8.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- b) Using the CEDIT program, set an external event at the time
- that you want to run D'Bridge, by exiting with errorlevel
- 25. For more details about CEDIT, see Chapter 5 of your
- TBBS manual.
-
-
- c) Using the D'Bridge SCHEDULE MAINTENANCE screen, create the
- desired MAIL events plus an EXIT event directly following
- with an errorlevel of 10. In the above batch file, error-
- level 10 means to re-load TBBS.
-
-
- d) To run the system, just start the batch file. TBBS will
- execute and run D'Bridge at the designated time.
-
-
-
-
- If you are using the TBBS SINGLE-LINE version perform the following
- steps:
-
-
- a) Rename DBMAILER.EXE to MAILER.EXE using the DOS "REN" command:
-
- C> REN DBMAILER.EXE MAILER.EXE
-
- If you are upgrading from a previous version, you might have
- to delete MAILER.EXE before doing this. Make sure that you
- always rename this file when you upgrade to a new D'Bridge
- version; The DB.EXE shell program will run MAILER.EXE if the
- DBMAILER.EXE program is not found in the current path.
-
-
-
- b) With a standard text editor, create a batch file similar to
- the following:
-
-
- :TOP
- C:
- CD \TBBS
- TBBSDVR
- TBBS /M
- IF ERRORLEVEL 30 GOTO ECHOSCAN
- GOTO END
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 209D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using TBBS 8.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- :ECHOSCAN
- DB UNPACK
- (Put your ECHOmail processing commands here)
- .
- .
- .
- GOTO TOP
-
- :END
- EXIT
-
-
- c) When D'Bridge is loaded in this manner, odds are there's not
- enough memory free to process ECHOmail, so unpacking should
- be done from on a batch basis.a batch basis; disable the
- internal unpacker by answering "NO" to the UNPACK MAIL field
- on the PACKET/MAIL CONTROL screen.
-
-
- d) For D'Bridge to unpack mail, you must specify DOS COMMANDS
- on the ADVANCED ROUTING screen of the SCHEDULE MAINTENANCE
- system. In each mail event that you want mail unpacked plus
- the UNEVENT, specify the following for DOS COMMANDS:
-
- *X30
-
- After mail is received, D'Bridge will exit with an errorlevel
- of 30; with the above batch file, this will cause TBBS to be
- unloaded and the DB UNPACK option to be run. If you only
- want to unpack mail on a periodic basis, you may accomplish
- this by using "EXIT" events with errorlevel 30 when you want
- the unpacker to be run.
-
-
-
- e) Finally, for D'Bridge to exit to TBBS when a bulletin board
- call is received, specify the following in the DOS BBS
- COMMANDS field on the BBS CONFIGURATION screen:
-
- /--------------------------------------------------------\
- | DOS commands for BBS: *X |
- | |
- | |
- \--------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 210D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using Opus 8.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- 8.3 USING OPUS
- ---------------
-
-
- D'Bridge is completely compatible with the Opus CBBS (Conversational
- bulletin board system.) In order to configure D'Bridge with Opus, follow
- this simple steps:
-
-
- 1) Edit your OPUS.CTL file to include the following line:
-
- Exit 15
-
- This tells Opus to exit after each call with an errorlevel of 15;
- when this happens, control is returned to D'Bridge.
-
-
- 2) Recompile your OPUS.PRM file by using the OPUSCTL command. See the
- Opus DOCs for more information.
-
-
- 3) There are three methods for running Opus from D'Bridge:
-
-
- a) Using the PUSH method, D'Bridge "spawns" the Opus program; this
- is the fastest way, but requires the most memory. To configure
- this, specify the following in the DOS BBS COMMANDS window:
-
-
- /---------------------------------------------------------\
- | DOS commands for BBS: CD \OPUS |
- | OPUS OPUS -B*B -T*T |
- | |
- \---------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- b) Using the DROP method is almost identical. This way, D'Bridge
- swaps its memory to EMS or disk, then runs Opus. Simply put a
- plus sign "+" in front of the opus command like this:
-
-
- /---------------------------------------------------------\
- | DOS commands for BBS: CD \OPUS |
- | +OPUS OPUS -B*B -T*T |
- | |
- \---------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 211D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using Opus 8.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- c) Using the EXIT method, D'Bridge must be run from a batch file.
- This requires some understanding of DOS, since your system will
- be setup slightly different than our example. Put the following
- in the DOS BBS commands field:
-
-
- /---------------------------------------------------------\
- | DOS commands for BBS: ECHO CD \OPUS >BBS.BAT |
- | ECHO OPUS OPUS -B*B -T*T >>BBS.BAT|
- | ECHO CD \DB >>BBS.BAT |
- | ECHO RUN-DB.BAT >>BBS.BAT |
- | *X20 |
- \---------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- Create a batch file called RUN-DB.BAT that contains at least
- the following:
-
-
- ECHO OFF
- :START
- C:
- CD \DB
- DB
- IF ERRORLEVEL 20 GOTO LOADBBS
- GOTO END
-
- :LOADBBS
- BBS.BAT
-
- :END
- EXIT
-
-
- To start D'Bridge, simply type RUN-DB from the D'Bridge root
- directory.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 212D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using QuickBBS 8.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 8.4 USING QUICKBBS
- -------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge has specific support for QuickBBS that allows both NETmail and
- ECHOmail operation smoothly and efficiently. Follow these simple steps
- to configure QuickBBS and D'Bridge together:
-
-
-
- 1) If you wish to the QuickBBS format for your NETmail area, specify
- the QuickBBS message area number to use on the DIRECTORY PATHS
- screen.
-
-
- 2) Define a QuickBBS path in the DIRECTORY PATHS screen. This path
- should be set to the directory that QuickBBS uses for its message
- base files.
-
-
- 3) Define all your local and ECHOmail areas using the LOCAL/ECHOMAIL
- AREAS screen. Make sure that you define ALL areas, or D'Bridge
- could auto-assign a new ECHO using an already existing message
- area number.
-
-
- 4) There are three methods for running QuickBBS under D'Bridge:
-
-
- a) Using the PUSH method, D'Bridge "spawns" the QuickBBS program;
- this is the fastest way, but requires the most memory. To
- configure this, specify the following in the DOS BBS COMMANDS
- window:
-
- /---------------------------------------------------------\
- | DOS commands for BBS: CD \QUICKBBS |
- | QUICKBBS -B*B -T*T -E0 |
- | |
- \---------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
- b) Using the DROP method is almost identical. This way, D'Bridge
- swaps its memory to EMS or disk, then runs QuickBBS. Simply put
- a plus sign "+" in front of the QuickBBS command like this:
-
- /---------------------------------------------------------\
- | DOS commands for BBS: CD \QUICKBBS |
- | +QUICKBBS -B*B -T*T -E0 |
- | |
- \---------------------------------------------------------/
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 213D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using QuickBBS 8.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- c) Using the EXIT method, D'Bridge must be run from a batch file.
- This requires some understanding of DOS, since your system will
- be setup slightly different than our example. Put the following
- in the DOS BBS commands field:
-
-
- /------------------------------------------------------------\
- | DOS commands for BBS: ECHO CD \QUICKBBS >BBS.BAT |
- | ECHO QUICKBBS -B*B -T*T -E0 >>BBS.BAT|
- | ECHO CD \DB >>BBS.BAT |
- | ECHO RUN-DB.BAT >>BBS.BAT |
- | *X20 |
- \------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- Create a batch file called RUN-DB.BAT that contains at least
- the following:
-
-
- ECHO OFF
- :START
- C:
- CD \DB
- DB
- IF ERRORLEVEL 20 GOTO LOADBBS
- GOTO END
-
- :LOADBBS
- BBS.BAT
-
- :END
- EXIT
-
-
- To start D'Bridge, simply type RUN-DB from the D'Bridge root
- directory.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 214D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using PC-BOARD 8.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 8.5 USING PC-BOARD
- -------------------
-
-
- PCBoard is available from Clark Development Company. It is another
- excellent BBS package with particularly strong support for DOORs, and
- it runs very well with D'Bridge. In order to configure PCBoard with
- D'Bridge, follow these steps:
-
-
- Note that since this method uses DOS 3.3's CALL command, it will not
- work with earlier versions of DOS. It should work with DOS 4.x.
-
-
- 1) Configure PCBoard's MODEM INFORMATION screen as shown below. The
- example shown is for a US Robotics HST 9600 bps modem, with the comm
- port locked at 19200. If you are using a different modem, you will
- need to make some adjustments to the parameters. PCBoard will
- receive the caller online after D'Bridge answers the call.
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | Modem Information |
- | |
- | Seconds to wait for carrier : 60 |
- | Comm Port (COM1,COM2,NONE) : COM2 |
- | Opening Baud Rate (300-38400) : 19200 |
- | Lock in Opening Baud Rate : Y |
- | Modem Initialization String : ATE0M1H0 |
- | Modem Off-Hook String : ATE0M0H1 |
- | Disable CTS/RTS checking : N |
- | Using a Hayes V-Series 9600 : N |
- | Using a FastComm 9600 : N |
- | Reset Modem During Recycle : N |
- | Modem Off-Hook During Recycle : N |
- | Packet-Switch Network : N |
- | Answer on True Ring Detect : N |
- | Allow Callers at 7,E,1 : N |
- | Allow 300 Baud Callers : N |
- | Allow 300 Baud Start Time : 00:01 |
- | Allow 300 Baud Stop Time : 24:00 |
- | |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 215D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using PC-BOARD 8.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 2) In PCBoard's OPTIONS #1 screen, set PCBoard to drop to DOS after
- each call:
-
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | Options #1 |
- | |
- | Exit to DOS After Each Call : Y |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- 3) In D'Bridge's COMM PORT / MODEM SETUP screen, set it up as shown
- below (again, this is for a USR 9600 HST). Modify to suit your
- modem. The "CONNECT" commands are very important. You must use
- the appropriate translations so that PCBoard will understand the
- connect codes later in the batch files.
-
-
- /-------------------------------------------------------------------\
- | Modem port: COM2 (COM1-COM7 or NONE) |
- | Baud rate: 19200 |
- | Locked? Yes |
- | Use RTS-CTS? Yes |
- | Initialize: ATE0F1M1X6Q0V1&K0&B1H0S0=0 |
- | Offline: ATE0M0H1 |
- | Drop DTR? Yes |
- | Answer: ATA |
- | Dial 300: ATDT |
- | " 1200: ATDT |
- | " 2400: ATDT |
- | " 4800: ATDT |
- | " 9600: ATDT |
- | " 19200: ATDT |
- | Specific dial: |
- | "RING" commands: RING |
- | "CONNECT" commands: 300 CONNECT|/C:0 |
- | 1200 CONNECT 1200|/C:2 |
- | 2400 CONNECT 2400|/C:3 |
- | 2400 CONNECT 2400/ARQ|/C:3 /ERR |
- | 9600 CONNECT 9600/ARQ|/C:5 /ERR |
- | "ABORT" commands: VOICE |
- | Char delay: 15 (milliseconds) |
- | Modem timeout: 45 (seconds) |
- | Carrier detect mask: 128 (almost always 128) |
- | Auto-init modem? Yes |
- \-------------------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 216D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using PC-BOARD 8.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 4) In D'Bridge's BBS CONFIGURATION screen, set the "DOS commands for
- BBS:" as shown below:
-
-
- /-----------------------------------------------------------\
- | DOS commands for BBS: ECHO PCBOARD *C > C:\PCB\PCBBAT.BAT |
- | *X20 |
- \-----------------------------------------------------------/
-
-
-
- 5) If you run in a DESQview environment, create a batch file called
- "PrepDb.bat". I keep mine in my C:\Batch directory, which is in
- my DOS path. In your DESQview "Add a program" screen, you will run
- this batch file to run D'Bridge. It sets up the stuff for the DB
- window that only needs to be done once, instead of doing it every
- time the board recycles.
-
- @Echo Off
- REM PrepDb.bat file to start D'Bridge from DESQview
- Dnansi
- RunDB
-
-
- 6) If you are not running in DESQview, make sure you have ANSI.SYS
- loaded in your config.sys file. In either case, make sure X00.SYS
- is loaded in CONFIG.SYS.
-
-
- 7) The main batch file that runs D'Bridge is RunDb.bat... If you are
- running in DESQview, PrepDb.bat will run RunDb.bat as the last item,
- if not, you will run it directly from DOS using the RunDB.bat file.
-
- REM Rem Main Batch file to run D'Bridge
- @Echo Off
- C:\CAPTURE
- E:
- CD \DB
- DB
- If ErrorLevel 90 Goto Maint
- If ErrorLevel 20 Board
- Goto END
- :MAINT
- Call Maint
-
- :END
- Exit
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 217D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Using PC-BOARD 8.5
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 8) Modify your PCBoard BOARD.BAT file so it looks like the example
- below.
-
- @Echo off
- C:
- Cd\Pcb
- If Exist Remote.bat Rename Remote.bat Remote.sys
- If Exist Event.bat Rename Event.bat Event.sys
- If Exist Door.bat Del Door.bat
- If Exist Endpcb del Endpcb
-
- Call PCBBAT
-
- If Exist Remote.bat Remote
- If Exist Door.bat Door
- If Exist Event.bat Event
- Cls
- RunDB
-
-
- 9) Now, when a BBS caller calls, D'Bridge will copy the translated
- connect code to a batch file it creates called "PCBBAT.BAT," exit
- with errorlevel 20, and run PCBoard's Board.bat file. When Board.bat
- gets to the "Call PCBBAT" line, it will run PCBBAT, which, if a 2400
- bps MNP caller is online will contain the following command:
-
- PCBOARD /C:3 /ERR
-
- ...which tells pcboard that the caller is connected at 2400 bps, and
- is using an error-corrected (MNP) modem. This will allow the caller
- to use protocols such as YModem-G. After the caller exits from
- PCBoard, PCBBAT will return to BOARD.BAT.
-
- Well, that's it! Really fairly simple, and it works very reliably.
-
-
-
-
-
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
- Our thanks for this section go to Michael Nelson, Fidonet 1:125/20
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 218D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge technical information 9.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 9.0 D'BRIDGE TECHNICAL INFORMATION
- -----------------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge is a complex program that uses quite a few control, storage
- and history files to store system information. This section documents
- these file structures so that programmers may access them in utility
- programs.
-
- Structures will be listed in the following sections, but here is a brief
- summary of all files used directly by D'Bridge:
-
-
- Filename Description
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
- CALLER.INF Function-request caller information file
- DB.EXE D'Bridge shell program (executable)
- DBCOSTL.DAT Costing data file
- DBCOSTL.IX Costing index file
- DBEDIT.DRO Memory "swap file" for DBEDIT
- DBEDIT.EXE D'Bridge editor (executable)
- DBEDIT.OVR D'Bridge editor (overlay)
- DBFAXL.DAT FAX directory data file
- DBFAXL.IX FAX directory index file
- DBMAILER.EXE D'Bridge mailer (executable)
- DBMAILER.OVR D'Bridge mailer (overlay)
- DBNODEL.DAT NODELIST data file
- DBNODEL.IX NODELIST index file
- DBQUEUE.DAT Outbound queue data file
- DBQUEUE.IX Outbound queue index file
- DBRIDGE.AA1 Local/ECHOmail area header file
- DBRIDGE.AA2 Local/ECHOmail area detail file
- DBRIDGE.AUT Automatic exported configuration
- DBRIDGE.CON Keeps track of what systems were called during an event
- DBRIDGE.DB$ Stores defaults for the INSTALL program
- DBRIDGE.DBI Stores CRCs of current software version (for INSTALL)
- DBRIDGE.DL1 Inbound EMAIL history file
- DBRIDGE.DL2 Outbound EMAIL history file
- DBRIDGE.DL3 Received ECHOmail history file
- DBRIDGE.DL4 AREAFIX history file
- DBRIDGE.DOC D'Bridge user's manual
- DBRIDGE.DRO Memory "swap file" for DBMAILER
- DBRIDGE.DUP QuickBBS ECHOmail duplicate-prevention file
- DBRIDGE.FRS File-request limit file (Stores 24-hour limits)
- DBRIDGE.HIS Outbound XMAIL control file (tracks filenames)
- DBRIDGE.LRQ QuickBBS lastread pointers (for DBEDIT)
- DBRIDGE.PRM D'Bridge parameter file
- DBRIDGE.PTR QuickBBS EMAIL pointer file
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 219D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge technical information 9.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- Filename Description
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
- DBRIDGE.R$$ Received files (internal control file)
- DBRIDGE.REG Registration file (DEMO version only)
- DBRIDGE.RSE ECHOmail scan activation file
- DBRIDGE.RSN NETmail scan activation file
- DBRIDGE.SCH Schedule control file
- DBRIDGE.SIF System information file
- DBRIDGE.TRM Terminal-mode parameter file
- DBRIDGE.XMA Outbound XMAIL control file (tracks outbound packets)
- DBUTIL.EXE D'Bridge utilities (executable)
- ECHOMAIL.CTL ECHOmail scan control file
- INSTALL.EXE D'Bridge installation program (executable)
- LASTREAD.DBR D'Bridge/Fido-style lastread pointers (for DBEDIT)
- LASTREAD SEAdog-style lastread pointers (for compatibility)
- MSGHDR.BBS QuickBBS message header file
- MSGIDX.BBS QuickBBS message index file
- MSGINFO.BBS QuickBBS message summary file
- MSGTOIDX.BBS QuickBBS message-to index
- MSGTXT.BBS QuickBBS message text file
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 220D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Parameter file 9.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 9.1 PARAMETER FILE
- -------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge uses a text-file called DBRIDGE.PRM to store its parameters.
- The structure of this file will remain undocumented except for the first
- few fields; DBRIDGE.PRM is subject to change without notice except for
- the following "static" information:
-
-
-
- Field Line/Column Description
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
- PARAMETER FILE VERSION 1/1 Current software version
- NETWORK MAIL STORAGE 2/1 NETmail storage method: F, T or Q
- DBMAILER OVERLAY EMS? 2/2 Copy DBMAILER.OVR to EMS? 1 or 0
- DBEDIT OVERLAY EMS? 2/3 Copy DBEDIT.OVR to EMS? 1 or 0
- DBMAILER PROGRAM SIZE 2/4 Total memory (in K)
- DBMAILER WORKRAM SIZE 2/11 WorkRAM (in K)
- NETWORK MAIL DIRECTORY 3/1 Fido-style NETmail directory path
- INBOUND FILES DIRECTORY 4/1 Inbound files directory path
- PACKET DIRECTORY 5/1 Temporary packet directory path
- QUEUE DIRECTORY 6/1 Disk-based queue directory path
- SCRIPT DIRECTORY 7/1 Script file directory path
- BADECHO DIRECTORY 8/1 BADECHO directory path (Fido-style)
- NEWECHO DIRECTORY 9/1 New ECHOmail base directory path
- QUICKBBS DIRECTORY 10/1 QuickBBS directory path
- SJF DIRECTORY 11/1 SJF directory path
- DOWNLOAD DIRECTORY 12/1 Terminal download directory path
- OUTBOUND MAIL ARCHIVE 13/1 Outbound NETmail archive filename
- NETWORK MAIL ARCHIVE 14/1 NETmail archive filename
- SYSTEM NAME 15/1 Primary system name
- OPERATOR NAME 16/1 Primary operator name
- ZONE 17/1 Zone address
- NET 17/8 Net address
- NODE 17/15 Node address
- POINT 17/22 Point address
-
-
-
- The other fields in DBRIDGE.PRM will be changed without documentation
- in future releases. If you are writing a utility program for D'Bridge,
- only the above documented fields are guaranteed to remain unchanged.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 221D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Message storage structures 9.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 9.2 MESSAGE STORAGE STRUCTURES
- -------------------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge can use three completely different storage methods to store
- EMAIL messages on disk. These particular methods were chosen for
- compatibility with popular bulletin board systems. Following are
- the file-structures used by D'Bridge for EMAIL message storage:
-
-
-
- FIDO
-
- When Fido-style storage is chosen for an area, a dedicated sub-
- directory will be created. This directory will contain one file
- for each message stored. The format for the filenames is:
-
- <message#>.MSG ie. 1.MSG, 2.MSG ... 9999.MSG
-
-
- Following is the Turbo-Pascal definition of the .MSG file format:
-
-
- FIDO_message = record
- msg_from,
- msg_to : array [1..36] of char;
- subj : array [1..72] of char;
- msg_date : array [1..20] of char;
- times_read,
- dest_node,
- orig_node,
- cost,
- orig_net,
- dest_net : integer;
- date_written,
- date_arrived : longint;
- reply : integer;
- attributes : word;
- (* Bit 0 Private
- 1 Crash
- 2 Message read
- 3 Message sent
- 4 File-attach
- 5 Forwarded
- 6 Orphan
- 7 Kill/sent
- 8 Local message
- 9 Hold
- 10 ???
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 222D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Message storage structures 9.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- 11 File-request
- 12 Return-receipt requested
- 13 Return-receipt
- 14 Audit-trail requested
- 15 Update-request *)
- unreply : integer;
- message_text : array [1..???] of char;
- (* The message text field contains text of
- any length, terminated with a null (0) byte *)
- end;
-
-
-
-
-
- QUICKBBS
-
- When QuickBBS-style storage is chosen for an area, messages are stored
- in a 5-file database designed by Adam Hudson. The file-formats are
- defined in the following Turbo-Pascal definition:
-
-
- MSGHDR.BBS QuickBBS message header file
-
- QuickBBS_header = record
- message_number,
- reply,
- unreply,
- times_read,
- starting_record,
- number_of_records,
- dest_net,
- dest_node,
- orig_net,
- orig_node : integer;
- dest_zone,
- orig_zone : byte;
- cost : integer;
- msg_attributes, (* Bit 0 Deleted
- 1 Outbound NETmail message
- 2 NETmail message
- 3 Private
- 4 Received
- 5 Outbound ECHOmail message
- 6 Local
- 7 Reserved *)
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 223D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Message storage structures 9.2
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- net_attributes, (* Bit 0 Kill/sent
- 1 Sent
- 2 File-attach
- 3 Crash
- 4 Request-receipt requested
- 5 Audit requested
- 6 Return receipt
- 7 Reserved *)
- area : byte;
- message_time : string[5];
- message_date : string[8];
- msg_to,
- msg_from : string[35];
- subj : string[72];
- end;
-
-
- MSGIDX.BBS QuickBBS message index file
-
- QuickBBS_index = record
- message_number : integer;
- area : byte
- end;
-
-
- MSGINFO.BBS QuickBBS message summary file
-
- QuickBBS_info = record
- low_message,
- high_message,
- total_messages : integer;
- active_messages : array [1..200] of integer
- end;
-
-
- MSGTOIDX.BBS QuickBBS message-to index file
-
- QuickBBS_to_index = string[35];
-
-
- MSGTXT.BBS QuickBBS message text file
-
- QuickBBS_text = string[255];
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 224D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 9.3 D'BRIDGE FILE STRUCTURES
- -----------------------------
-
-
- Following are Turbo-Pascal or text-file definitions of the data, history
- and control files used by D'Bridge. These structures are subject to
- change in future releases...
-
-
-
-
-
- CALLER.INF
-
- When D'Bridge receives a function-request, it writes a text file
- called CALLER.INF in the current directory. This file contains
- the following information about the caller online:
-
- <address>
- <system name>
- <system operator>
- <inbound files directory>
-
-
-
-
- DBCOSTL.DAT/IX
-
- The DBCOSTL files are created and maintained by the B-TREE FILER
- routines available from Turbo-Power Software. They contain the
- cost and control data from the ACCOUNTING/TRANSLATION screen.
-
- costlist_structure = record
- del : longint;
- prefix : string[20];
- dial_as : string[30];
- location : string[20];
- start_time,
- end_time : array [1..5] of string[4];
- weekdays : array [1..5] of string[7];
- time_increment : array [1..5] of word;
- nci : array [1..5] of string[3];
- cost_per_increment : array [1..5] of (* down *)
- cost_array
- end;
-
- The database key for the file is the PREFIX field.
-
- Key 1: PREFIX (20, non-duplicatable)
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 225D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- DBFAXL.DAT/IX
-
- The DBFAXL files are created and maintained by the B-TREE FILER
- routines available from Turbo-Power Software. They contain the
- FAX directory, maintained by the FAXLIST MAINTENANCE option in
- DBEDIT.
-
- faxlist_structure = record
- del : longint;
- faxname : string[8];
- name,
- operator,
- city,
- phone : string[36];
- hours_from,
- hours_to : string[4];
- end;
-
-
- The database key for the file is the FAXNAME field; all characters
- in this field must be uppercase for a record to be accessed.
-
- Key 1: FAXNAME (8, non-duplicatable)
-
-
- DBNODEL.DAT/IX
-
- The DBNODEL files are created and maintained by the B-TREE FILER
- routines available from Turbo-Power Software. They contain the
- compiled nodelist database.
-
- nodelist_structure = record
- del : longint;
- zone,
- net,
- node,
- point : integer;
- nodelist_CRC : word;
- nodelist_offset : longint;
- route_to_node : integer;
- reserved : array [1..6] of byte;
- end;
-
- There are two database keys for the nodelist file:
-
- Key 1: ZONE+NET+NODE+POINT (8,non-duplicatable)
- Key 2: USERNAME+SEQ (17,non-duplicatable)
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 226D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- DBQUEUE.DAT/IX
-
- The DBQUEUE files are created and maintained by the B-TREE FILER
- routines available from Turbo-Power Software. They contain the
- current outbound queue. This file is not critical. It can be
- rebuilt at any time if it is deleted.
-
- outbound_queue = record
- zone,
- net,
- node,
- point : integer;
- faxname : string[8];
- evl_rec,
- connect_time : longint;
- time_increment,
- tries,
- sessions,
- bad_sessions : integer;
- nocost,
- cost_hold,
- schedule_hold,
- send_everything,
- needs_work,
- unlisted,
- temporary_hold,
- forced : boolean;
- forced_priority : char;
- status : string[18];
- costlist_key : string[20];
- kinds : array [1..6] of
- char; (* RTFPXM *)
- priorities : array [1..4] of
- char; (* ICNH *)
- NCI,
- was_reset : string[3];
- next_decision : string[4];
- phone_number : string[60];
- system_name : string[31];
- system_city : string[31];
- baud_rate : word;
- end;
-
- There is one database key for this record:
-
- Key 1: ZONE+NET+NODE+POINT+FAXNAME (16,non-duplicatable)
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 227D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.AA1/AA2
-
- D'Bridge uses two files to maintain the internal area list. This is
- used in the LOCAL/ECHOMAIL AREAS screen. When an area is added, one
- record is added to each of the two files. The files should always
- contain the same number of records.
-
-
- area_header = record (* DBRIDGE.AA1 *)
- allocated : boolean;
- tag : string[16];
- ECHOmail_tag : string[56];
- end;
-
-
- area_detail = record (* DBRIDGE.AA2 *)
- description : string[40];
- group : integer;
- storage : char;
- directory_path : string[48];
- kind : char;
- Quick_area : integer;
- default_private,
- tiny_seenbys : boolean;
- origin_line : string[56];
- default_priority : char;
- alias_zone,
- alias_net,
- alias_node,
- alias_point,
- area_purge,
- area_preserve,
- area_security : integer;
- area_archive : string[56];
- forward_to : array [1..5] of string[56]
- end;
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 228D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.CON
-
- This file keeps track of what systems have been called during
- a mail event, so D'Bridge keeps track of all the limits for the
- entire event. This is a relative-record file where the first
- record is a control-record and not the same as the rest...
-
- event_limits = record
- case zone : integer of
- 0 : (dt : date;
- event : string[8]);
- 1 : (verification,
- net,
- node,
- point : integer;
- faxname : string[8];
- tries,
- connects,
- bad : integer;
- priorities : pritype;
- send_everything : boolean;
- connect_time : longint;
- was_reset : string[3];
- status : string[18])
- end;
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.DB$
-
-
- This text file stores defaults for the INSTALL program. The format
- for this file is:
-
- <unZIP command>
- <release directory>
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.DBI
-
- This file stores CRCs of current software version so that INSTALL may
- later be asked to "Verify software integrity." For internal security
- reasons, the CRC32s listed here are scrambled. This information is
- provided for your information only; we don't expect users to be able
- to decode this confidential information.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 229D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- security = record
- lowest_install_vsn,
- install_vsn : integer;
- CRC32a,
- CRC32b : array [1..8] of longint;
- end;
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.DL1
-
- This is the inbound EMAIL history file:
-
- inbound_EMAIL_history = record
- log_date : string[6];
- log_time : string[4];
- zone,
- net,
- node,
- point : integer;
- bytes_out,
- bytes_in,
- time : longint
- end;
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.DL2
-
- This is the outbound EMAIL history file:
-
- outbound_EMAIL_history = record
- log_date : string[6];
- log_time : string[4];
- zone,
- net,
- node,
- point : integer;
- bytes_out,
- bytes_in,
- time,
- cost : longint
- end;
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 230D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.DL3
-
- This is the received ECHOmail history file:
-
- received_ECHOmail_history = record
- log_date : string[6];
- log_time : string[4];
- area_name : string[16];
- zone,
- net,
- node,
- point,
- dups,
- received : integer
- end;
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.DL4
-
- This is the AREAFIX history file:
-
- AREAFIX_history = record
- log_date : string[6];
- log_time : string[4];
- zone,
- net,
- node,
- point : integer;
- area_name : string[16];
- action : (added,added_scanned,removed,
- security_violation,area_list)
- end;
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.DUP
-
- The QuickBBS duplicate-prevention file contains from 0-200 of the
- following records:
-
- duplicate_prevention = array [1..1024] of record
- date_CRC,
- header_CRC : integer
- end;
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 231D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.FRS
-
- The file-request limit file tracks file-requests for a 24-hour period.
- DBRIDGE.FRS is a text file with one line per record in the following
- format:
-
- Field Starting column
- ------------------------------------------------
-
- ADDRESS 1
- UNIX TIME STAMP 21
- FILE-REQUEST TIME USED 37
- FILE-REQUEST BYTES USED 47
- FILE-REQUEST COUNT 57
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.HIS
-
- D'Bridge uses this file to track outbound XMAIL filenames:
-
- daily_XMAIL_control = record
- zone,
- net,
- node,
- point : integer;
- updated : string[6];
- xmail_number,
- reserved : integer
- end;
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.LRQ
-
- For QuickBBS, DBEDIT stores the LASTREAD pointers in this file:
-
- Quickbbs_lastread = record
- username : string[36];
- last_read : array [1..200] of record
- message,
- rec : integer
- end
- end;
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 232D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.PTR
-
- Both the ECHOmail and NETmail scanners update this file for QuickBBS
- storage method. In order for D'Bridge to know where it left-off
- scanning, the following text file is used:
-
- <high QuickBBS record> <first QuickBBS NETmail message>
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.REE
-
- This file tells the ECHOmail scanner which conferences and systems
- to use for a RESCAN of designated conferences. This text file has
- the following format:
-
- <ECHO tag> <address> <priority>
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.RSE
-
- If this control file exists, ECHOmail will be scanned when D'Bridge
- is activated the next time. It doesn't matter what's in the file.
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.RSN
-
- If this control file exists, NETmail will be scanned when D'Bridge
- is activated the next time. It doesn't matter what's in the file.
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.SCH
-
- This file controls the D'Bridge scheduling system. If it used to keep
- track of what events were executed, aborted, etc. The format of this
- text file is:
-
- <date>
- <event tag> <start time> <end time> <status>
- .
- .
- <event tag> <start time> <end time> <status>
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 233D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.SIF
-
- This file tracks summary information displayed by the DISPLAY SYSTEM
- INFORMATION SYSTEM option.
-
- system_information = record
- purge_date : string[6];
- stats : array [1..20] of
- array [1..5] of real;
- (* 1-5 is TODAY, YESTERDAY, WTD, MTD, YTD
- [1] Calls received
- [2] EMAIL calls
- [3] BBS calls
- [4] GATEWAY calls
- [5] Aborted calls
- [6] Calls placed
- [7] Connections made
- [8] Failed connects
- [9] Total cost
- [10] Data sent bytes
- [11] Data received bytes
- [12] EMAIL messages rcvd
- [13] ECHOmail messages
- [14] BAD/DUP messages
- [15] Total forwarded
- [16..20] unused *)
- extra : array [1..256] of byte
- end;
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.TRM
-
- The terminal-mode parameters are stored in this file.
-
- terminal_config = record
- baud_rate : word;
- duplex,
-
- parity,
- databits,
- stopbits : char;
- comport : byte;
- emulation : char;
- directory : array [1..100] of
- record
- name : string[25];
- baud_rate : word;
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 234D'Bridge Electronic Mail System D'Bridge file structures 9.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- parity,
- databits,
- stopbits : char;
- phone : string[30];
- end;
- capture_strip,
- auto_download : boolean
- end;
-
-
-
-
- DBRIDGE.XMA
-
- This text file contains a list of packets that need to be compressed
- by the XMAIL processor. Each line is in the following format:
-
- <queue name> <packet name>
- <queue name> <packet name>
- .
- .
- <queue name> <packet name>
-
-
-
-
- ECHOMAIL.CTL
-
- If this text file exists, D'Bridge will only scan the ECHOmail areas
- listed within. If it doesn't exist, all ECHOmail areas are scanned.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 235D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Disk-based queue 9.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 9.4 DISK-BASED QUEUE
- ---------------------
-
-
- D'Bridge has a disk-based queue for XMAIL, file-transfer and AREAFIX
- requests. This queue works independently of the NETmail area and may
- be accessed by user-written programs. All queue entries reside as files
- in the specified "queue" directory; the address is encoded in the file-
- name as base-36 numbers.
-
-
- The filenames of queue entries use the following format:
-
- t-zzzNNN.nnn H-00102X.00G
- -or- -or-
- t-POINT-ppp H-POINT.005
-
-
- Where: t is the entry type (A/B/C/H/I/N/Q)
- zzz is the base-36 ZONE address
- NNN is the base-36 NET address
- nnn is the base-36 NODE address
- ppp is the base-36 POINT address
-
-
-
- Base-36 numbers use the digits 0-Z to represent the numbers. You will
- notice from the structure that the address is either 3-dimensional (ZONE,
- NET and NODE) or a POINT-address. It is impossible to have a queue entry
- for a point of another system.
-
-
- The following queue entry-types are currently defined:
-
-
- A - AREAFIX request packet
-
- An "A" queue entry is an outbound AREAFIX request; this is a NETmail
- message that is destined for the specified system. It must always be
- associated with a "Q" entry-type that designates the packet priority.
- This packet is generated by using the REQUEST ECHOMAIL LINK, ALT-R
- option of D'Bridge.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 236D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Disk-based queue 9.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- B - Inbound AREAFIX request/New ECHOmail link control file
-
- The "B" queue entry indicates either an inbound AREAFIX request or
- a request issued using the NEW ECHOMAIL LINK, ALT-N command. These
- requests are usually processed immediately, but if there is a hold
- on ECHOmail forwarding because of a disk-space limit, these files may
- accumulate. The "B" queue entries are text files in the following
- format:
-
- <priority><rescan><area listing><manual override>
- <area name>
- .
- .
- <area name>
-
-
- <priority> is either N, I, C or H
- <rescan> Should the area be rescanned? Y or N
- <area listing> Should an area listing be sent? Y or N
- <manual override> Is this a manual (ALT-N) entry? Y or N
- <area name> Either + or - then the ECHOmail tags to add
- or remove from your LOCAL/ECHOMAIL AREAS screen.
-
- "B" queue entries are processed when an ECHOmail scan is done; any
- external program may add entries to the disk-based queue.
-
-
- C - Crash priority XMAIL
-
- "C" queue entries are XMAIL (compressed mail) packets with CRASH
- priority. These will be sent during any event including the UNEVENT
- to the specified system. This file contains any number of outbound
- mail packets.
-
-
- H - Hold priority XMAIL
-
- "H" queue entries are XMAIL packets with HOLD priority. These will
- never be sent unless there is a forced priority override or the
- operator uses the VIEW/MODIFY QUEUE command to force D'Bridge to call
- the specified system. Typically, HOLD priority XMAIL is picked up
- by a "poll" from the destination system.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 237D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Disk-based queue 9.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- I - Immediate priority XMAIL
-
- "I" queue entries are XMAIL packets with IMMEDIATE priority. These
- will be sent immediately during any event; this priority overrides
- crash and all immediate queue entries will be sent before any other
- outbound traffic.
-
-
-
- N - Normal priority XMAIL
-
- "N" queue entries are XMAIL packets with NORMAL priority. They will
- never be transmitted during the UNEVENT unless a forced priority has
- been specified or the operator uses the VIEW/MODIFY QUEUE command to
- force it to send.
-
-
-
- Q - General purpose outbound queue
-
- A "Q" queue entry is a text file that contains any number of lines,
- each of which contains one of the following formats:
-
-
- <priority> P
-
- A "P" entry indicates a "poll" with the specified priority.
-
-
- <priority> T <file path> <transmit filename>
-
- A "T" entry indicates an outbound file transmission. Wildcards
- are not allowed here; all entries must specify full filenames and
- whatever programs add entries to the queue must do the wildcard
- expansion themselves. This queue structure requires that both the
- full path of the file be specified as well as the transmitted file-
- name; this allows files to be transmitted different filenames than
- they have on disk.
-
-
- <priority> F <filename>
-
- A "F" entry indicates a file request. Filenames may include a
- path, but the file will be received into the inbound files
- directory unless you are requesting from a SEAdog or "Bark-style"
- system. If the file exists in the specified path, an update-
- request will be generated, only receiving the file if a newer
- version exists.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 238D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Disk-based queue 9.4
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- <priority> R <packet path> <transmit packet name>
-
- An "R" entry indicates an outbound AREAFIX request. This is always
- associated with an "A" queue entry which contains an actual NETmail
- packet.
-
-
-
-
- The disk-based queue was designed to allow user-written programs to
- transmit files and XMAIL easily without using the DBUTIL program.
- Following is a sample routine to generate the queue entry filenames
- based on kind, ZONE, NET, NODE and POINT:
-
-
- function qname(kind : char;
- zone,
- net,
- node,
- point : integer) : string;
-
- function base36(n : integer) : maxstring;
- var d36 : string[36];
- i,j,k : integer;
- begin
- d36:='0123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ';
- i:=n div 1296;
- j:=n mod 1296;
- k:=n mod 36;
- j:=j div 36;
- base36:=d36[i+1]+d36[j+1]+d36[k+1]
- end;
-
- begin
- if point<>0 then
- qname:=kind+'-POINT.'+base36(point)
- else
- qname:=kind+'-'+base36(zone)+base36(net)+'.'+base36(node)
- end;
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 239D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Trouble? 10.0
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- 10.0 TROUBLE?
- --------------
-
-
- D'Bridge is a complex program and it is possible that you may experience
- some trouble that requires technical support. We have a technical-
- support number that you may call anytime from 9:00AM until 5:00PM,
- Monday through Friday. Please remember that we are in Miami, Florida
- and use EASTERN STANDARD TIME (half the year...)
-
- 305-232-5245
-
- Miami is the primary customer-support center for D'Bridge. If you
- bought D'Bridge from a dealer or distributor, you might be able to
- get technical assistance from them. In any case, we are always here
- during the day to answer your questions, regarless of where you have
- purchased the product.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 240D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- For your information, we have included the following glossary of
- EMAIL terms that you might not find in your normal dictionary.
- Please let us know if any of these definitions confuse you or there
- are other terms that you would like to see defined in future versions
- of this documentation.
-
-
-
- ADDRESS An ADDRESS normally specifies where you want to send
- EMAIL or files. D'Bridge uses the Fidonet addressing
- structure; this consists of four numbers: ZONE, NET,
- NODE and POINT. For example, my ADDRESS is 1:135/68.
- This means ZONE 1, NET 135, NODE 68 and POINT 0. The
- format for a Fidonet ADDRESS is: ZONE:NET/NODE.POINT.
-
- ALIAS An ALIAS is simply another ADDRESS or USER NAME that
- you are using at any given time. Your system will
- have a primary ADDRESS and OPERATOR, but you may also
- specify a list of AKA (Also known as) ADDRESSES and
- USER NAMES that may be selected while using DBEDIT,
- the message editor. ALIAS ADDRESSES and handy when
- you are part of more than one network.
-
- AREAFIX AREAFIX is a subsystem with D'Bridge that allows remote
- systems to add and delete ECHOmail conferences from your
- forwarding list. This eliminates the need for routine
- maintenance by the operator of an ECHOmail hub.
-
- BAUD RATE The BAUD RATE represents the speed of a serial communi-
- cation line. BAUD RATE actually means BITS PER SECOND
- and dictates how fast data can be transferred. Since
- normal data communications takes 10 bits per character,
- a 1200 baud modem can transmit and receive data at a
- maximum of 120 characters (bytes) per second.
-
- BBS An acronym for "Bulletin Board System."
-
- BIOS An acronym for "Basic Input/Output Services." This is
- a program that is built-in the ROM (Read Only Memory)
- of your computer and controls functions such as keyboard
- and screen I/O. D'Bridge gives you the option of using
- direct-memory screen writes or BIOS I/O. (Usually much
- slower.)
-
- BOSS A BOSS refers to the administrator of a "point" network.
- For example, if your address is 1:135/50.6, then your
- BOSS' address is 1:135/50 (or point zero) Since points
- are not in the nodelist, the BOSS will normally receive
- and forward all mail that is addressed for a point.
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 241D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- BULLETIN BOARD SYSTEM Usually called a BBS, a BULLETIN BOARD SYSTEM, is a
- program which allows "human" callers to connect using
- a terminal program and directly access messages, files
- and other online services. Many BULLETIN BOARDS are
- public access systems which allow people to use them
- for free providing they follow the "rules." Many
- manufacturers and software companies have set up a BBS
- to handle support and distribute product information.
- D'Bridge is capable of acting as a "front-end" to most
- BULLETIN BOARD SYSTEMS, determining if a call is an EMAIL
- session or if a "human" is on the line.
-
- CARRIER CARRIER refers to the connection of two modems. When you
- dial a modem (with your telephone) you will hear a high-
- pitched tone; this is called the CARRIER SIGNAL. When
- a modem calls another system, the calling modem detects
- this tone and they automatically "synchronize" and
- determine the baud rate of the connection. Once this
- is accomplished, you are said to have CARRIER. If the
- connection is terminated, or the CARRIER signal is lost,
- the modems are no longer communicating and will hang up.
-
- CD An acronym for "Carrier Detect," CD refers to the
- circuits within the modem that monitor the connection
- and detect when a carrier is lost. Most external modems
- have a CD light that will tells the operator the status
- of the connection. Once carrier is detected, D'Bridge
- can initiate an EMAIL session. CD also refers to the
- signal that the modem sends to the computer telling it
- that another modem is connected. This signal is required
- for D'Bridge to operate.
-
- COMPILE In D'Bridge, COMPILE means to translate the raw nodelist
- into its internal database. This must be done every time
- a new nodelist is available. When D'Bridge is run, it
- checks the data and time associated with each nodelist
- file you are using with the last known values. If they
- differ, D'Bridge automatically RE-COMPILES the nodelist
- database.
-
- CONNECT CONNECT refers to D'Bridge receiving a carrier detect
- signal from the modem along with a "CONNECT" message
- generated by HAYES-compatible modems. When D'Bridge
- is CONNECTED to another system, it can send and receive
- EMAIL and files. When placing a long-distance call,
- your phone company will bill you for the actual CONNECT
- TIME, usually rounded up to the next minute.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 242D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- CM An acronym for "Continuous mail," all D'Bridge systems
- are capable of this. Continuous mail means that a
- Fidonet-based EMAIL system is capable of receiving mail
- 24-hours per day and not just during a scheduled event.
- Some EMAIL systems are still not capable of this, so
- the nodelist has a "CM" flag that can be used to only
- send to CM systems. (This is configurable on the
- ADVANCED ROUTING screen of SCHEDULE MAINTENANCE.)
-
- CRC CRC is an acronym for "Cyclic Redundancy Check." This
- is how D'Bridge (and all other EMAIL systems) ensure
- that data is received the same way it is transmitted.
- It is much like a "checksum" attached to a block of
- data; A mathematical formula (a polynomial) is used to
- compare a block of data with its CRC value. If there
- is a difference, then the data is not valid and must
- be retransmitted. You, as the user, do not need to
- concern yourself with this as it happens automatically.
-
- CRASH In D'Bridge (and most other Fidonet-based systems,) CRASH
- refers to a high-priority message. It is an "attribute"
- that may be associated with a message to tell D'Bridge to
- send the mail immediately and to override any routing and
- call the destination system directly. Using DBEDIT, the
- message editor, you can specify any message to have CRASH
- priority.
-
- CRASHMAIL You may notice that when D'Bridge first starts, (assuming
- that no scheduled event is active,) it says "Scanning for
- outbound CRASHMAIL." What this means is that any EMAIL
- messages that have CRASH priority will be sent directly
- to the destination as soon as possible. It is important
- to make sure that the destination system will be online
- and ready to receive the mail; some systems may only
- operate at night because the computer is used for other
- purposes during the day. You should only send CRASHMAIL
- to those systems that can accept it.
-
- CTS An acronym for "Clear To Send," CTS is a signal generated
- by the receiving system or modem telling D'Bridge that it
- may transmit data. This is normally used only when a
- modem is using a higher baud rate than it is capable of
- sending (or receiving.) The CTS signal is used in
- conjunction with the RTS (Request To Send) signal and is
- sent from the modem to the computer. (on some modems)
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 243D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- DATA DATA simply means any form of information that can be
- stored in a computer in the form of a file. DATA could
- be a message, spreadsheet file, graphics image or
- anything else in your computer. Any form of DATA may be
- sent by D'Bridge.
-
- DATA BITS When D'Bridge is communicating with another EMAIL system,
- it uses 8 DATA BITS in the transmission. IBM computers
- are only capable of using 7 or 8 DATA BITS in their
- communications. The D'Bridge "terminal mode" allows you
- to select either 7 or 8 DATA bits when communicating with
- online services such as Bulletin Boards.
-
- DEFAULT A DEFAULT refers to a predefined or normal value for
- something. When you first install D'Bridge, you will
- notice that many of the configuration screens already
- have answers to questions even though you didn't enter
- them. This is because these values or answers will be
- used by most systems, so they are the DEFAULTS.
-
- DOMESTIC DOMESTIC refers to any communications within a given
- country. In the case of the U.S., D'Bridge considers
- any system that has a phone number beginning with "1"
- to be a DOMESTIC call. (This includes Canada, the
- Bahamas and possibly some other neighboring countries.
-
- DOS DOS, an acronym for "Disk Operating System," is the
- program (written by MicroSoft) that controls your
- computer's basic functions. D'Bridge requires DOS to
- operate and odds are (99.99% of the time) you already
- have this program. Other operating systems are available
- such as PC-MOS and XENIX, but D'Bridge will not function
- while using these.
-
- DOS EVENT A DOS EVENT is a scheduled event (defined by SCHEDULE
- MAINTENANCE) that will execute any number of DOS commands
- or programs, providing that you have enough memory to
- "spawn" these tasks. DOS EVENTS can be used for any
- function that you wish to have automatically performed on
- a scheduled basis. DOS EVENTS must only run programs
- that require no human intervention (keyboard I/O.)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 244D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- DOWNLOAD DOWNLOAD means to receive a file from a remote computer.
- The D'Bridge "terminal mode" supports downloads with
- XMODEM, SEAlink and ZMODEM protocols. When you DOWNLOAD
- a file, you are basically copying it over the telephone
- from the remote computer to yours. Because these
- protocols all use CRC error-checking, the files should
- arrive on your computer exactly like they are on the
- remote system.
-
- DROP In D'Bridge, DROP means to execute another program (or
- DOS access) by swapping all memory to EMS or disk, then
- executing another program. This method (as compared to
- PUSH) frees all available memory so that the executed
- program has the maximum memory available for its use.
-
- DUPLEX DUPLEX is used only in the D'Bridge "terminal mode" and
- refers to an operating characteristic of the remote
- computer that you are calling. These days, almost all
- computers and online services operate in FULL DUPLEX
- mode; this means that every time you type a character,
- the remote computer "echos" is back to you and it is
- displayed on your screen. Some systems, however, do not
- "echo" the characters you type; that is called HALF
- DUPLEX operation. If you set D'Bridge to HALF DUPLEX,
- then every character you type will be displayed on your
- screen. If you experience a double echo, (two characters
- for every one you type,) you should change to FULL DUPLEX
- mode.
-
- DTR An acronym for "Data Terminal Ready," DTR is the signal
- your computer sends to your modem telling it that it
- should accept commands from the computer or, if enabled,
- answer the phone. D'Bridge requires that this signal
- function properly; that's how it hangs-up the phone.
- When your computer "lowers" DTR, your modem should hang-
- up the phone if connected with a remote system, or not
- answer the phone (if so enabled.) Most external modems
- have a DTR light that will tell you the status of this
- signal.
-
- ECHOMAIL ECHOmail is a method of conferencing or sharing a message
- base between two or more systems. D'Bridge has internal
- ECHOmail processing, eliminating the need for external
- utilities.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 245D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- EDITOR An EDITOR is any program which allows you to read, enter
- respond to EMAIL messages. DBEDIT is the message EDITOR
- provided with D'Bridge. It may be run by selecting the
- EDIT/READ EMAIL option from the EDITOR menu.
-
- EMAIL As abbreviation for "Electronic Mail," EMAIL generally
- describes any form of electronic communication. This
- could include D'Bridge mail, FAX or TELEX communication.
-
- ERROR LEVEL An ERROR LEVEL is an "exit code" sent by D'Bridge to DOS
- describing an "exit condition." D'Bridge uses ERROR
- LEVELS in EXIT events so that a DOS batch file can detect
- what to do. Unless you already understand ERROR LEVELS,
- you most likely won't need to use them. For further
- information, consult your DOS manual in the section that
- describes BATCH FILES.
-
- EVENT A EVENT is simply something that happens. In D'Bridge,
- EVENTS are scheduled by using the SCHEDULE MAINTENANCE
- screen. Four types of EVENTS are supported by D'Bridge:
- MAIL, DOS, EXIT and SLEEP.
-
- EXIT EVENT An EXIT EVENT is defined by using the SCHEDULE MAINT-
- ENANCE screen. When an EXIT EVENT occurs, D'Bridge will
- actually terminate completely providing DOS with a pre-
- specified ERROR LEVEL. This is almost always used in
- conjunction with batch files.
-
- EXPORT In D'Bridge, EXPORT means to save your current config-
- uration in a text file for inspection or later use by
- the IMPORT command. All of the parameters that are in
- the setup screens may be written to a standard text file.
- This is handy for configuring a remote system and
- required when upgrading between major revisions of the
- D'Bridge software.
-
- EXTERNAL GATEWAY In D'Bridge, an EXTERNAL GATEWAY is a program that can
- be automatically run to receive incoming mail from other,
- non-compatible EMAIL systems. For example, there is a
- UUCP EMAIL receiver available for the IBM PC that will
- allow you to receive mail from UNIX and XENIX systems.
- A unique feature of D'Bridge allows it to recognize when
- non-compatible EMAIL systems are calling and transfer
- control to an external EMAIL receiver.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 246D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- FIDONET FIDONET means two things really: First, it defines the
- protocol that D'Bridge uses when communicating with other
- Fidonet-based systems. This protocol is described in
- detail in certain documents written and maintained by the
- FTSC (Fidonet Technical Standards Committee.) Second, it
- is the name of the largest Fidonet-based EMAIL network.
- Both the network and the protocol were created by Tom
- Jennings of Fido Software. His initiative and early
- efforts is what made the Fidonet network possible. Our
- sincere thanks goes to Tom for making this all possible.
-
- FILE A FILE is an organized collection of information, usually
- similar in nature. When you type "DIR" in DOS, you
- receive a listing of all the files in the current
- directory. (Almost) any of these FILES may be trans-
- mitted via EMAIL to another D'Bridge or Fidonet system.
-
- FILE-ATTACH FILE-ATTACH means to send a file or list of files with
- an EMAIL message. This is normally done with DBEDIT,
- the message editor. FILE-ATTACH is an "attribute" that
- is associated with a given message. If a message has
- the FILE-ATTACH attribute, all the files listed in the
- SUBJECT line will be transmitted with the message.
-
- FILE-REQUEST FILE-REQUEST is similar to FILE-ATTACH, except is works
- in reverse. The files specified are "requested" from
- the specified system; when the call is placed, if those
- files exist and you have specified the right password,
- if any, they will be immediately sent to you. FILE-
- REQUEST is both a message "attribute" and a menu option.
-
- FORWARD FORWARDING means to send an EMAIL message that neither
- originated from or is destined for your system.
- FORWARDING is used in conjunction with ROUTING to send
- mail through HOST systems, usually to save phone
- calls and costs. For example, if you wish to send a
- message to a system outside of your NET, the message is
- normally routed to that city's HOST and then will be
- FORWARDED automatically to the destination. This way,
- if you have several messages to go to different
- destinations in one city, only one phone call needs to
- be made, saving several phone calls.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 247D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- FOSSIL An acronym for "Fido/Opus/SEAdog Standard Interface
- Layer," FOSSIL refers to a common communications
- interface that is common to many Fidonet-based systems.
- If a FOSSIL driver is installed on your computer,
- D'Bridge will use it instead of its internal communi-
- cation routines. This is required by D'Bridge; The X00
- FOSSIL driver is supplied.
-
- FRONT-END FRONT-END is a generic term for programs like D'Bridge,
- FrontDoor and BinkleyTerm when they are used in to run
- a combination BBS/EMAIL system. This simply means that
- D'Bridge acts as a FRONT-END, answering the phone and
- transferring control to a BBS or external EMAIL receiver.
-
- FUNCTION-REQUEST A feature unique to UltraTek<TM> EMAIL systems, FUNCTION
- REQUESTS allow a calling system access to predefined
- DOS functions or programs. This is a rather advanced
- feature and can only be used in conjunction with external
- programs (not included with D'Bridge.)
-
- GMT An acronym for "Greenwich Mean Time," GMT is a universal
- time standard that many EMAIL systems use internally for
- converting dates and times in a consistent manner.
-
- HOLD HOLD means NOT to send mail, but rather to wait until
- the destination system calls and picks it up. Normally,
- D'Bridge will put all mail on HOLD 24-hours a day that
- does not have CRASH priority. This way, a system that
- calls to send you mail can always get any mail that is
- waiting for them, saving a phone call.
-
- HOST Every NET has a HOST; a HOST acts as a consolidation
- point for inbound mail that comes from outside of your
- NET. A host is designated by having a NODE and POINT
- number of zero. By default, all mail sent to systems
- outside of your NET will be routed to a HOST or a HUB.
- The exception to this is if you have specified CRASH
- priority or have attached or requested a file. Usually,
- the NET host acts as the administrator for his NET,
- maintaining the nodelist and distributing updates to all
- his NODES.
-
- HUB A HUB is functionally identical to a HOST; it is usually
- only used when a NET is very large or spans more than one
- local calling area. In D'Bridge, HUB and HOST ROUTING
- are treated the same. Messages addressed to a NODE
- outside of your network are ROUTED through the HUB if one
- exists.
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 248D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- IFNA IFNA stands for the International FidoNet Association.
- It is "allegedly" the governing body of Fidonet, a public
- amateur EMAIL network. While only a small percentage of
- the people in Fidonet are IFNA members, their policy and
- technical standards affect all systems in the "IFNA"
- nodelist.
-
- IMPORT In D'Bridge, the term IMPORT is used when upgrading
- between major releases of the software or anytime that you
- wish to transfer or restore an EXPORTED configuration.
-
- INBOUND INBOUND simply mail that arrives at your system from a
- remote site; opposite of OUTBOUND.
-
- INITIALIZE In D'Bridge, INITIALIZE is used to describe sending
- commands to your modem that INITIALIZE it, setting it
- for the correct settings to operate. Normally, your
- MODEM INITIALIZATION STRING tell your modem to answer
- the phone and report the connection back to D'Bridge.
- For specific information on this, read the section on
- COMM/MODEM SETUP.
-
- INTERNATIONAL INTERNATIONAL refers to any communications outside of
- your country. In D'Bridge, this is determined by the
- first part of a phone number as it appears in the node-
- list. For the U.S., Canada, the Bahamas and several
- other neighboring countries that share a country code
- of "1," communications is not considered INTERNATIONAL
- unless calling Europe or Australia; anytime the COUNTRY
- CODE in the nodelist differs, that is an INTERNATIONAL
- call and the predefined INTERNATIONAL DIALING PREFIX
- will be used.
-
- LOCAL LOCAL refers to any call where D'Bridge simply strips
- off the COUNTRY CODE and AREA CODE. It is still possible
- that there is a charge for the call, but in most cases
- there is no charge.
-
- LOG D'Bridge keeps three kinds of LOGS: INBOUND, OUTBOUND and
- DETAILED. The inbound LOG lists all EMAIL calls received
- within the last "n" days; the outbound LOG lists all EMAIL
- calls that went out and the detailed LOG is a text file
- that displays chronological information about system
- activity, errors, etc.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 249D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- MACRO In DBEDIT, the message editor, KEYBOARD MACROS are
- supported. What this means is that you can program
- function keys (ALT F1-F10 and CTL F1-F10) to substitute
- preprogrammed text of any length while editing messages.
- This is handy for signatures and any other text that you
- find yourself constantly typing. Words, sentences or
- even paragraphs can be programmed into the MACRO keys.
-
- MAIL MAIL simply refers to messages or files sent or received.
-
- MAIL EVENT A MAIL EVENT is a predefined period of time that D'Bridge
- is allowed to send mail. During this time, all messages
- will be sent unless otherwise specified in the ADVANCED
- ROUTING screen. It is important that all systems in the
- network use the same time for MAIL EVENTS. Remember that
- if a west-coast system starts a mail event at 1:00,
- systems on the east-coast must start the same event at
- 4:00, the same physical time.
-
- MESSAGE In D'Bridge, a MESSAGE is prepared by DBEDIT and contains
- text that is to be sent to another location conveying a
- thought or idea. Messages are the basis for more EMAIL
- systems.
-
- MODEM An acronym for "MODulator/DEModulator," a modem is the
- device that allows computers to communicate by converting
- electrical impulses to audio tones and back. Obviously,
- you have a modem or you would not have purchased D'Bridge,
- so we'll assume that this will suffice.
-
- NET Defines the second number in a Fidonet address. NET
- typically defines a geographical region or local calling
- area. In the case of a private network with few systems,
- all systems (regardless of location) could use the same
- NET number.
-
- NETWORK NETWORK refers collectively to all the systems listed
- in your nodelist. You should be able to send an EMAIL
- message to anyone in your NETWORK. Sometimes, NETWORK
- is used in the same way as NET, the second number in
- a Fidonet address, but they really mean two different
- things.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 250D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- NETWORK Every NETWORK has an ADMINISTRATOR; without one, anarchy
- ADMINISTRATOR would prevail. There is a section devoted entirely to
- the duties and responsibilities that rest with a NETWORK
- ADMINISTRATOR. If you are such a person, I would strongly
- suggest reading it. Basically, he is simply responsible
- for the overall operation of the network and for keeping
- the nodelist up-to-dat and accurate.
-
- NODE A NODE is the third number in a Fidonet address; NODE
- specifies an individual system. Each NODE has an entry
- in the NODELIST that lists it's information such as name,
- phone number and baud rate.
-
- NODELIST Every NETWORK has a NODELIST; maintained by the NETWORK
- ADMINISTRATOR, the NODELIST is a text file that lists
- all the systems, their phone numbers, baud rates, cities
- and operator names. This list is identical on each system
- in the NETWORK and is updated whenever a new system is
- added or an existing one leaves or has information to
- change. In the case of the large amateur networks, the
- NODELIST is updated and distributed weekly.
-
- NULL MESSAGE A NULL MESSAGE is simply one that has to text. Often,
- these messages are used to send or request a file and
- if meaningless otherwise. D'Bridge gives you the option
- to automatically erase these NULL MESSAGES when they
- arrive.
-
- OFFLINE In D'Bridge, OFFLINE has two meanings: First, it means
- that the phone is not being answered, most-likely because
- you are using your computer for something else. Second,
- it means what commands you want to give to the modem when
- D'Bridge is "down" because you are using the editor or
- exit the program. Some systems are configured so that
- the phone is off-hook when D'Bridge is OFFLINE.
-
- ONLINE The opposite of OFFLINE, ONLINE means that D'Bridge is
- up and ready to accept commands and/or incoming EMAIL.
-
- OUTBOUND Outbound refers to EMAIL or files that are ready to be
- sent to a remote system. Mail that is on "HOLD" is also
- called OUTBOUND. In fact, everything in the QUEUE window
- is OUTBOUND mail.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 251D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- OUTBOUND GATEWAY Some NETs have an OUTBOUND GATEWAY - A system that sends
- all mail destined for systems outside of your NET. This
- is often done to save money by consolidating all the
- OUTBOUND traffic into one outgoing system. (Perhaps the
- OGATE (OUTBOUND GATEWAY) has a WATS line and is able to
- make long-distance calls much cheaper. In any case,
- OUTBOUND GATEWAYS forward mail for anyone within their
- NET.
-
- PACKET When D'Bridge sends EMAIL, it is put into packets that
- consolidate all messages into one file or PACKET. When
- D'Bridge connects with a system, it sends one packet
- instead of one file for each message. A packet could
- contain one or thousands of EMAIL messages.
-
- PARITY PARITY is a term only used in the D'Bridge "terminal
- mode." It is either NONE, EVEN or ODD and refers to a
- bit that follows the DATA BITS and comes before the STOP
- BIT. D'Bridge allows you to configure the PARITY any of
- these three ways to facilitate communication with
- different systems. Most BULLETIN BOARD SYSTEMS use no
- PARITY "NONE," but you might need to change that.
-
- PASSWORD A PASSWORD is the basis for the D'Bridge security system.
- If you wish to have a secure link between two systems,
- you choose an 8-letter PASSWORD that is mutually agree-
- able to both operators. Once these PASSWORDS are in
- place, it is impossible to communicate with the other
- system (using your address) unless that PASSWORD is
- specified. This is primarily designed to discourage
- "hackers" from infiltrating your network and stealing
- EMAIL that you may have on hold.
-
- PATH PATH normally refers to the name of a DOS directory
- that you wish to store files. A path consists of
- the drive name (C:) plus the name of a specific
- subdirectory. See your DOS manual for further infor-
- mation on directory PATHS.
-
- PICKUP PICKUP means to call another system and receive EMAIL
- they have on HOLD for you. Every time D'Bridge connects
- with another system, it asks it if there is any mail
- waiting. If so and you have the proper PASSWORD, if
- required, you will receive all your mail immediately
- after D'Bridge sends the outbound mail. By default,
- PICKUP is not a secure way to handle mail; make sure
- that you use a SESSION PASSWORD if you require high-
- security in your network.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 252D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- POINT A POINT is the forth part of a Fidonet address. A POINT
- system is one that is not listed in the NODELIST.
- Normally, POINTS are not public access systems, but
- personal EMAIL systems used to communicate with the
- network through their BOSS NODE. For complete infor-
- mation on POINTS, see the section on setting up a POINT
- system.
-
- POINTLIST The POINTLIST is just like the nodelist but is specifies
- a list of POINTS associated with a given BOSS NODE.
- Again, this is only applicable for a POINT system and
- complete information is available in the section on
- setting up a point system.
-
- POLL POLLING means to call a system to see if there is mail
- waiting even though you have nothing to send. For
- example, if you don't have a permanent phone number for
- your system or run a private node or point, you will
- need to poll your HOST or BOSS on a periodic basis in
- order to receive your mail. The perfect example of
- someone who needs to poll is a salesman who uses a
- portable PC to communicate with the main office.
-
- PORT PORT refers to the serial I/O card used by D'Bridge to
- communicate with the modem. Internal modems have a
- built-in serial PORT but are used the same way. Your
- modem PORT is most likely called either COM1 or COM2.
-
- QUEUE D'Bridge has a QUEUE window which lists all of the
- outbound packets at any given time. A QUEUE is simply a
- list of things to do, or in this case packets to send.
-
- RAW NODELIST The RAW NODELIST simply refers to the nodelist when it
- is in the form of a text file, before it is compiled.
- D'Bridge only processes RAW NODELISTS and requires no
- external pre-processor like many other Fidonet EMAIL
- systems require.
-
- ROUTING D'Bridge has a great deal of flexibility in the way that
- it can ROUTE messages. In simple networks, messages can
- simply be sent directly from the sender to the receiver.
- Actually, this can be done in any network, but in many
- cases it is more desirable to use ROUTING because it can
- save money and cut the number of phone calls. Used in
- conjunction with FORWARDING, ROUTING simply means to send
- a message somewhere other than the final destination.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 253D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- For example, if I wish to send a message to someone in
- Cincinnati, it will be sent during my nightly mail event
- to the HOST or HUB in Cincinnati. The message is then
- FORWARDED to the final destination automatically.
- Obviously, with just one message there is no savings and
- actually the message will take longer to get there
- because it has to be FORWARDED to its destination. But
- let's say I want to send messages to three different
- systems in Cincinnati - this time, there is a savings
- because D'Bridge only makes one call instead of three.
-
- RTS An acronym for "Request To Send," RTS is the companion
- signal to Clear to Send, CTS. This is sometimes referred
- to as "flow control" and allows the computer to communi-
- cate with the modem at a higher baud rate that the modem
- can actually send.
-
- SCAN When D'Bridge says that it's SCANNING for outbound mail,
- it actually looks at each message to see if it needs to
- be sent. As it SCANS, it creates packets that are added
- the outbound queue.
-
- SCHEDULE In D'Bridge, the SCHEDULE is a list of pre-programmed
- events that should be executed at the specified times.
- It uses a weekly schedule to determine when to send mail,
- execute DOS commands, terminate with an errorlevel and
- when to "sleep." The SCHEDULE MAINTENANCE screen is used
- to add, change and remove events from the schedule. The
- lower-right window of D'Bridge always displays the
- schedule for the current day; this is advanced auto-
- matically at midnight.
-
- SCRIPT D'Bridge normally uses your telephone to connect with
- other EMAIL systems to transfer EMAIL. Sometimes it
- is desirable to use other carriers such as packet-
- switched networks to communicate. The D'Bridge scripting
- language allows you to communicate using other systems
- such as TELENET'S PC-PURSUIT. Many system operators in
- the U.S. subscribe to this low-cost data transmission
- service and D'Bridge is able to take full advantage of
- it by using its SCRIPTING language. This is a rather
- advanced feature, so please read the section about script
- files for more information.
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 254D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- SEALINK SEAlink is one of the four file-transfer protocols that
- D'Bridge uses to communicate with other Fidonet-based
- EMAIL systems. SEAlink was developed by Thom Henderson
- of System Enhancements Associates. It was derived from
- the XMODEM protocol but has the clear advantage of
- eliminating propagation (satellite) delays so common in
- long-distance communications. D'Bridge will use this
- protocol when communicating with some EMAIL systems.
-
- SECURITY D'Bridge has a password-based security system to protect
- EMAIL sessions. By default, no security is used and
- anyone with a compatible EMAIL system could send you mail
- and request files. The D'Bridge security system allows
- you many different options to improve security. See the
- section called SECURITY/MISCELLANEOUS SETUP for more
- information.
-
- SESSION A SESSION or MAIL SESSION simply refers to the period of
- time when two EMAIL systems are communicating with each
- other.
-
- SLEEP EVENT A SLEEP EVENT is one of the four basic event types.
- During a SLEEP EVENT, D'Bridge becomes inactive and will
- neither make outgoing calls nor accept incoming calls.
- The primary purpose for SLEEP EVENTS is to facilitate
- the shared use of a phone line as a VOICE/DATA line.
- Normally during the day, the line would be used for
- voice communications, so D'Bridge is programmed to
- "SLEEP" during the day so it won't answer the phone.
-
- SPAWN SPAWN refers to the method of executing another program
- while keeping the calling program in memory. An example
- of this is DOS EVENTS. All commands issued in DOS
- EVENTS are SPAWNED; this means that D'Bridge is still in
- memory resumes operation as soon as the SPAWNED task is
- complete. This method can only be used if there is
- enough free memory to load the SPAWNED program after
- D'Bridge.
-
- STOP BITS STOP BITS is a parameter only found in the D'Bridge
- "terminal mode." On an IBM computer, it may have a
- value of either 1 or 2. Most systems use 1 stop bit
- without exception, but it is left to your control for
- maximum flexibility.
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 255D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- TELINK TELINK is one of the four file-transfer protocols used by
- D'Bridge. It is a batch protocol that consists of
- XMODEM file-transfers proceeded by MODEM7 filename
- headers. This is the standard protocol defined by the
- Fidonet Technical Standards Committee as a "fallback"
- protocol for Fidonet. D'Bridge will use this protocol
- when communicating with some EMAIL systems.
-
- TERMINAL D'Bridge has a "TERMINAL MODE" that makes D'Bridge
- a teletype or video display terminal. (VDT) When
- using TERMINAL MODE, you can connect with other online
- services such as bulletin board systems and commercial
- systems such as CompuServe<TM>.
-
- TIMEOUT A TIMEOUT ERROR is a condition when the remote system
- fails to respond within an allotted period of time. The
- cause of such an error can be hardware trouble, poor line
- conditions or a software error. If a TIMEOUT ERROR
- happens consistently when calling a certain system, you
- might want to follow up with a voice call to the system
- operator.
-
- TRIES The number of TRIES refers to the number of times
- dials another system without getting a connection.
- During mail events, D'Bridge defaults to a maximum of
- 30 TRIES, but you may change this to any number you wish
- by using the ADVANCED ROUTING screen of the SCHEDULE
- MAINTENANCE screen.
-
- UN-EVENT The UN-EVENT refers to the "event" that is running when
- there is no scheduled event active. The UN-EVENT config-
- uration (found in SCHEDULE MAINTENANCE) controls how
- crashmail is handled and how mail is routed outside other
- events.
-
- UNPACK When EMAIL arrives from another system, it is in the form
- of PACKETS. Unless otherwise specified, D'Bridge will
- UNPACK these packets into messages when they arrive.
-
- UPDATE-REQUEST When communicating with other D'Bridge systems, all FILE-
- REQUESTS are really UPDATE-REQUESTS. The UPDATE-REQUEST
- option is provided only for compatibility with the SEA-
- dog<TM> EMAIL system.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 256D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- UPLOAD When using the D'Bridge "terminal mode," there is an
- UPLOAD option that allows you to transmit file(s) to
- a remote computer. You can use the XMODEM, SEAlink or
- ZMODEM protocols for this function.
-
- WAZOO An acronym for "WArp Zillion Opus-to-Opus," (I think,)
- WaZOO is one of the EMAIL protocols that D'Bridge
- supports. WaZOO sessions begin with a YOOHOO packet
- exchange then usually send mail and files with either
- SEAlink or ZMODEM protocols, depending on the cap-
- abilities of the communicating systems. WaZOO was
- designed by Wynn Wagner, III and is the EMAIL protocol
- used by most of Fidonet-compatible mailers currently
- available: D'Bridge, FrontDoor, Opus, BinkleyTerm and
- Dutchie.
-
- WINDOW A Window is simply an area on the screen that D'Bridge
- uses to display information. When I refer to a window,
- I simply mean a section of the screen.
-
- XMAIL XMAIL is simply a term that means "compressed mail."
- An XMAIL packet contains any number of mail packets and
- may be created using the ARC, ZIP, PAK or LHARC formats.
-
- XMODEM XMODEM is one of the most universal communications
- protocols available. Most people credit Ward Christian-
- son with coding and documenting the first XMODEM com-
- munications program, but I can't say for sure. XMODEM
- is the basis for Fidonet communications for sending the
- initial mail packet. D'Bridge will use this protocol
- when talking to some EMAIL systems.
-
- YOOHOO YOOHOO is the name of the handshaking protocol that
- D'Bridge uses when talking with other WaZOO-based
- systems. The YOOHOO/2U2 handshake passes such infor-
- mation as your address, system and operator name as
- well as password information. YOOHOO and YOOHOO/2U2
- was designed by Wynn Wagner, III.
-
- ZMODEM ZMODEM is the protocol that D'Bridge uses when com-
- unicating with other "HiTek" systems. Most WaZOO-
- based EMAIL systems are capable of ZMODEM file-trans-
- fers, but not all. D'Bridge will automatically select
- this protocol if the other system is compatible with
- it. The advantage ZMODEM has over the other protocols
- is the ability to dynamically adjust the block size for
- the line conditions. D'Bridge can send and accept any
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 257D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Glossary of EMAIL terms Appendix A
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- block size between 64 and 8192 providing a fairly wide
- tolerance for poor line conditions. D'Bridge ZMODEM
- also has 32-bit CRCs for high data integrity and the
- ability to continue an aborted transfer at the point
- it left off. Chuck Forsberg is generally credited for
- documenting ZMODEM and promoting its popularity.
-
- ZONE A ZONE is the first number in a Fidonet address and
- generally specifies the continent where the system
- is located. Some other networks have started using a
- different ZONE to separate them from the Fidonet amateur
- network.
-
- ZONEGATE When communicating with other ZONES, it is possible to
- cut your communication costs by sending your EMAIL
- through the ZONEGATE. For example, if I wish to send a
- message to my friend in Europe, I can tell D'Bridge to
- route the message through the ZONEGATE and I can send
- the message with just an inexpensive domestic call to
- the European ZONEGATE. From there, he pays the bill to
- forward the message to the American ZONEGATE in Europe
- who in turn forwards it on to its destination. The
- only drawback to this approach is that it is fairly slow
- getting to its final destination and your message can be
- read by every system operator along the way. Personally,
- I am willing to pay the direct connection charges to
- ensure that the message arrives quickly and privately.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 258D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Credits / Acknowledgements Appendix B
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
-
- D'Bridge would not be what it is today without the ideas and inventions
- of others. I feel that they all deserve credit for their work, so I am
- including this section. I have built on the ideas of many other soft-
- ware developers and I want to thank them all for their efforts.
-
-
-
- TOM JENNINGS
-
- Tom is the creator and "mastermind" of the entire Fidonet concept. In
- 1984, he created a bulletin board system called Fido that had the unique
- ability to communicate with other Fidos overnight sending electronic
- mail and files. Starting very simple, Fido grew and his software became
- more advanced adding features such as forwarding and routing. Fido is
- still widely used today by many individuals and corporations that have
- a need to communicate via EMAIL. Thank you, Tom, for creating a system
- and a standard that has spawned the largest public amateur EMAIL network
- is the world today. Where would we be without you?
-
-
-
- JOAQUIM HOMRIGHAUSEN and PETER STEWART
-
- "Joe" and Peter have been a constant source of inspiration and ideas
- for D'Bridge. In case you don't know, they are the authors of another
- EMAIL system called FrontDoor. D'Bridge and FrontDoor have a lot in
- common because we live just a few miles apart and share ideas and code.
- I first saw FrontDoor at the 1987 "FidoCon," a convention in Washington
- DC. I was impressed with the way it looked and worked; used to using
- that "other" commercial EMAIL system, I really liked the window-based
- operation and the whole "look and feel" it had. Without Joaquim to others
- provide fresh ideas, D'Bridge would certainly lack some of the nice
- features it has today. Thanks!
-
-
-
- THOM HENDERSON
-
- Thom has been a major factor in the advancement of the Fidonet standard.
- His company, System Enhancements Associates is responsible for developing
- the ARC standard, the SEAlink file-transfer protocol and SEAdog, another
- commercial EMAIL package. About a year ago, I purchased a copy of SEA-
- dog 4.0 and used it until I wrote D'Bridge. SEAdog took the Fidonet
- standards and extended them, supporting such features as file-request
- and crashmail. I wish to thank Thom for all the things he has done to
- help Fidonet and the EMAIL community. His SEAlink protocol has saved
- many people a LOT of money on their phone bill.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 259D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Credits / Acknowledgements Appendix B
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
- WYNN WAGNER III
-
- Wynn is the creator of Opus, "a computer-based conversation system."
- He took all the good ideas in Fidonet and created another EMAIL standard
- called WaZOO. D'Bridge uses the WaZOO standard when communicating with
- other "HiTek" systems. I wish to thank Wynn for making these standards
- available for all to use and creating documentation clear enough to make
- implementation easy.
-
-
-
- CHUCK FORSBERG
-
- Chuck, with his company, Omen Technology is credited with the
- development of the ZMODEM protocol and making it as popular as it is
- today. I used a document that he wrote in August, 1986 that describes
- very clearly how to implement the ZMODEM protocol. Without testing with
- his program, DSZ, it would have been very hard (if not impossible) to
- ensure that our 32-bit CRC logic was working correctly.
-
-
-
- JEFF RUSH
-
- Jeff was responsible for bringing ECHOmail to the Fidonet community.
- He didn't really invent ECHOmail, but set a clear definition in his
- original ECHOmail program (designed for use with Fido and SEAdog) that
- has remained virtually unchanged to date. I think that we should all
- appreciate the initiative that he took in the early days of Fidonet to
- bring conferencing ability to our network.
-
-
-
- GREG DAWSON
-
- Greg designed and wrote a system called AREAFIX which he graciously
- allowed us to incorporate into D'Bridge. His AREAFIX system allows
- ECHOmail distributors to automate the routine maintenance that was
- required when conferences were added and deleted.
-
-
- ADAM HUDSON
-
- Adam wrote the QuickBBS software which is in widespread use today. He
- has been cooperative in helping D'Bridge be compatible with his fine BBS
- program. We thank him for allowing us to use his message base format
- within D'Bridge.
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 260D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Credits / Acknowledgements Appendix B
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- RAY GWINN
-
- We wish to greatly thank Ray Gwinn for allowing us to include his
- excellent FOSSIL driver, X00, with the D'Bridge package. Ray has
- worked many years to bring the X00 driver through many hardware and
- specification changes. We thank him greatly for being kind enough to
- license his software for use with D'Bridge.
-
-
-
- BETA-TEST GROUP
-
- D'Bridge just wouldn't be possible without our Beta-test group which
- put the software "through a ringer" before you ever saw it. I wish to
- thank the following people for their effort and dedication during this
- year's development process:
-
-
- Karim Ashur
- Mehdi Attaran
- Noel Bradford
- Gordon Castle
- Robert Cox
- Les Fenison
- Steve Gabrilowitz
- Terry Garrett
- Floyd Grant
- Arthur Greenberg
- Reinier De Groot
- Richard Hall
- Bernd Hinkman
- A.J. de Jager
- Erich Janssen
- Vernon Merck
- Jim Montgomery
- Mark Moran
- Tom Ordelman
- Stefano Pasquini
- Piet Raa
- John Rafuse
- Theodore M. Rolle
- Gary Roth
- Mike Simkins
- Tony Wagner
- Tim Wool
-
- If anyone was left out, it was an oversight. This list was based on
- participation in the developmental ECHOmail conferences.
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 261D'Bridge Electronic Mail System Credits / Acknowledgements Appendix B
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-
-
-
-
- COPYRIGHT / TRADEMARK ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
-
- - AirMail is a trademark of Joaquim Homrighausen
- - ARC is a trademark of System Enhancement Associates
- - AREAFIX is a trademark of Greg Dawson
- - BinkleyTerm was written by Bob Hartman and Vince Perriello
- - Dutchie was written by Henk Wevers
- - ECHOmail was created by Jeff Rush
- - Fido and Fidonet are trademarks of Tom Jennings (Fido Software)
- - FrontDoor is a trademark of Joaquim Homrighausen
- - LHARC was created by Haruyasu Yoshizaki
- - Opus, WaZOO and YOOHOO are trademarks of Wynn Wagner III
- - PAK was created by NoGate Consulting
- - PC-Pursuit is a servicemark of Telenet
- - QuickBBS is a trademark of the QuickBBS Group
- - SEAdog is a trademark of System Enhancements Associates
- - UltraTEK is a trademark of Joaquim Homrighausen and Chris Irwin
- - Wildcat is a trademark of Mustang Software
- - XMODEM was originally made popular by Ward Christianson
- - ZIP was created by Phil Katz of PKware
- - ZMODEM was documented by Chuck Forsberg
-
-
-
-
-
- "The End."
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Version 1.30, Copyright 1989 by Chris Irwin - ALL RIGHTS RESERVED 262